Companies:
10,793
total market cap:
$134.752 T
Sign In
๐บ๐ธ
EN
English
$ USD
โฌ
EUR
๐ช๐บ
โน
INR
๐ฎ๐ณ
ยฃ
GBP
๐ฌ๐ง
$
CAD
๐จ๐ฆ
$
AUD
๐ฆ๐บ
$
NZD
๐ณ๐ฟ
$
HKD
๐ญ๐ฐ
$
SGD
๐ธ๐ฌ
Global ranking
Ranking by countries
America
๐บ๐ธ United States
๐จ๐ฆ Canada
๐ฒ๐ฝ Mexico
๐ง๐ท Brazil
๐จ๐ฑ Chile
Europe
๐ช๐บ European Union
๐ฉ๐ช Germany
๐ฌ๐ง United Kingdom
๐ซ๐ท France
๐ช๐ธ Spain
๐ณ๐ฑ Netherlands
๐ธ๐ช Sweden
๐ฎ๐น Italy
๐จ๐ญ Switzerland
๐ต๐ฑ Poland
๐ซ๐ฎ Finland
Asia
๐จ๐ณ China
๐ฏ๐ต Japan
๐ฐ๐ท South Korea
๐ญ๐ฐ Hong Kong
๐ธ๐ฌ Singapore
๐ฎ๐ฉ Indonesia
๐ฎ๐ณ India
๐ฒ๐พ Malaysia
๐น๐ผ Taiwan
๐น๐ญ Thailand
๐ป๐ณ Vietnam
Others
๐ฆ๐บ Australia
๐ณ๐ฟ New Zealand
๐ฎ๐ฑ Israel
๐ธ๐ฆ Saudi Arabia
๐น๐ท Turkey
๐ท๐บ Russia
๐ฟ๐ฆ South Africa
>> All Countries
Ranking by categories
๐ All assets by Market Cap
๐ Automakers
โ๏ธ Airlines
๐ซ Airports
โ๏ธ Aircraft manufacturers
๐ฆ Banks
๐จ Hotels
๐ Pharmaceuticals
๐ E-Commerce
โ๏ธ Healthcare
๐ฆ Courier services
๐ฐ Media/Press
๐ท Alcoholic beverages
๐ฅค Beverages
๐ Clothing
โ๏ธ Mining
๐ Railways
๐ฆ Insurance
๐ Real estate
โ Ports
๐ผ Professional services
๐ด Food
๐ Restaurant chains
โ๐ป Software
๐ Semiconductors
๐ฌ Tobacco
๐ณ Financial services
๐ข Oil&Gas
๐ Electricity
๐งช Chemicals
๐ฐ Investment
๐ก Telecommunication
๐๏ธ Retail
๐ฅ๏ธ Internet
๐ Construction
๐ฎ Video Game
๐ป Tech
๐ฆพ AI
>> All Categories
ETFs
๐ All ETFs
๐๏ธ Bond ETFs
๏ผ Dividend ETFs
โฟ Bitcoin ETFs
โข Ethereum ETFs
๐ช Crypto Currency ETFs
๐ฅ Gold ETFs & ETCs
๐ฅ Silver ETFs & ETCs
๐ข๏ธ Oil ETFs & ETCs
๐ฝ Commodities ETFs & ETNs
๐ Emerging Markets ETFs
๐ Small-Cap ETFs
๐ Low volatility ETFs
๐ Inverse/Bear ETFs
โฌ๏ธ Leveraged ETFs
๐ Global/World ETFs
๐บ๐ธ USA ETFs
๐บ๐ธ S&P 500 ETFs
๐บ๐ธ Dow Jones ETFs
๐ช๐บ Europe ETFs
๐จ๐ณ China ETFs
๐ฏ๐ต Japan ETFs
๐ฎ๐ณ India ETFs
๐ฌ๐ง UK ETFs
๐ฉ๐ช Germany ETFs
๐ซ๐ท France ETFs
โ๏ธ Mining ETFs
โ๏ธ Gold Mining ETFs
โ๏ธ Silver Mining ETFs
๐งฌ Biotech ETFs
๐ฉโ๐ป Tech ETFs
๐ Real Estate ETFs
โ๏ธ Healthcare ETFs
โก Energy ETFs
๐ Renewable Energy ETFs
๐ก๏ธ Insurance ETFs
๐ฐ Water ETFs
๐ด Food & Beverage ETFs
๐ฑ Socially Responsible ETFs
๐ฃ๏ธ Infrastructure ETFs
๐ก Innovation ETFs
๐ Semiconductors ETFs
๐ Aerospace & Defense ETFs
๐ Cybersecurity ETFs
๐ฆพ Artificial Intelligence ETFs
Watchlist
Account
Assured Guaranty
AGO
#3638
Rank
$3.67 B
Marketcap
๐ง๐ฒ
Country
$81.87
Share price
0.31%
Change (1 day)
7.36%
Change (1 year)
๐ฆ Insurance
Categories
Market cap
Revenue
Earnings
Price history
P/E ratio
P/S ratio
More
Price history
P/E ratio
P/S ratio
P/B ratio
Operating margin
EPS
Dividends
Dividend yield
Shares outstanding
Fails to deliver
Cost to borrow
Total assets
Total liabilities
Total debt
Cash on Hand
Net Assets
Annual Reports
Annual Reports (10-K)
Assured Guaranty
Quarterly Reports (10-Q)
Submitted on 2016-05-05
Assured Guaranty - 10-Q quarterly report FY
Text size:
Small
Medium
Large
Table of Contents
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
____________________________________________________________________________
FORM 10-Q
ý
QUARTERLY REPORT UNDER SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the Quarterly Period Ended
March 31, 2016
Or
o
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition Period from to
Commission File No. 001-32141
ASSURED GUARANTY LTD.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
Bermuda
98-0429991
(State or other jurisdiction
(I.R.S. employer
of incorporation)
identification no.)
30 Woodbourne Avenue
Hamilton HM 08
Bermuda
(Address of principal executive offices)
(441) 279-5700
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes
x
No
o
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). Yes
x
No
o
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer or a smaller reporting company. See definition of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
Large accelerated filer
x
Accelerated filer
o
Non-accelerated filer
o
Smaller reporting company
o
(Do not check if a smaller reporting company)
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). Yes
o
No
x
The number of registrant’s Common Shares ($0.01 par value) outstanding as of May 2, 2016 was
134,357,143
(includes
62,145
unvested restricted shares).
Table of Contents
ASSURED GUARANTY LTD.
INDEX TO FORM 10-Q
Page
PART I
Financial Information
1
Item 1.
Financial Statements:
1
Consolidated Balance Sheets (unaudited) as of March 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015
1
Consolidated Statements of Operations (unaudited) for the Three Months Ended March 31, 2016 and 2015
2
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (unaudited) for the Three Months Ended March 31, 2016 and 2015
3
Consolidated Statement of Shareholders’ Equity (unaudited) for the Three Months Ended March 31, 2016
4
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows (unaudited) for the Three Months Ended March 31, 2016 and 2015
5
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)
6
1. Business and Basis of Presentation
6
2. Acquisitions
7
3. Rating Actions
8
4. Outstanding Exposure
8
5. Expected Loss to be Paid
19
6. Financial Guaranty Insurance
35
7. Fair Value Measurement
45
8. Financial Guaranty Contracts Accounted for as Credit Derivatives
62
9. Consolidated Variable Interest Entities
67
10. Investments and Cash
70
11. Insurance Company Regulatory Requirements
76
12. Income Taxes
77
13. Reinsurance and Other Monoline Exposures
80
14. Commitments and Contingencies
84
15. Long Term Debt and Credit Facilities
87
16. Earnings Per Share
89
17. Shareholders' Equity
90
18. Subsidiary Information
92
Item 2.
Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
98
Forward Looking Statements
98
Available Information
99
Executive Summary
99
Results of Operations
105
Non-GAAP Financial Measures
116
Insured Portfolio
120
Liquidity and Capital Resources
133
Item 3.
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
146
Item 4.
Controls and Procedures
146
PART II
Other Information
147
Item 1.
Legal Proceedings
147
Item 1A.
Risk Factors
147
Item 2.
Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities and Use of Proceeds
148
Item 6.
Exhibits
148
Table of Contents
PART I. FINANCIAL INFORMATION
ITEM 1.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Assured Guaranty Ltd.
Consolidated Balance Sheets (unaudited)
(dollars in millions except per share and share amounts)
As of
March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
Assets
Investment portfolio:
Fixed-maturity securities, available-for-sale, at fair value (amortized cost of $10,123
a
nd $10,275)
$
10,588
$
10,627
Short-term investments, at fair value
459
396
Other invested assets
167
169
Total investment portfolio
11,214
11,192
Cash
112
166
Premiums receivable, net of commissions payable
662
693
Ceded unearned premium reserve
236
232
Deferred acquisition costs
113
114
Reinsurance recoverable on unpaid losses
72
69
Salvage and subrogation recoverable
206
126
Credit derivative assets
55
81
Deferred tax asset, net
278
276
Current income tax receivable
11
40
Financial guaranty variable interest entities’ assets, at fair value
1,191
1,261
Other assets
302
294
Total assets
$
14,452
$
14,544
Liabilities and shareholders’ equity
Unearned premium reserve
$
3,810
$
3,996
Loss and loss adjustment expense reserve
1,112
1,067
Reinsurance balances payable, net
58
51
Long-term debt
1,302
1,300
Credit derivative liabilities
489
446
Financial guaranty variable interest entities’ liabilities with recourse, at fair value
1,165
1,225
Financial guaranty variable interest entities’ liabilities without recourse, at fair value
119
124
Other liabilities
284
272
Total liabilities
8,339
8,481
Commitments and contingencies (See Note 14)
Common stock ($0.01 par value, 500,000,000 shares authorized; 135,083,637 and 137,928,552 shares issued and outstanding)
1
1
Additional paid-in capital
1,269
1,342
Retained earnings
4,519
4,478
Accumulated other comprehensive income, net of tax of $127 and $104
319
237
Deferred equity compensation (320,193 and 320,193 shares)
5
5
Total shareholders’ equity
6,113
6,063
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
$
14,452
$
14,544
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
1
Table of Contents
Assured Guaranty Ltd.
Consolidated Statements of Operations (unaudited)
(dollars in millions except per share amounts)
Three Months Ended March 31,
2016
2015
Revenues
Net earned premiums
$
183
$
142
Net investment income
99
101
Net realized investment gains (losses):
Other-than-temporary impairment losses
(20
)
(5
)
Less: portion of other-than-temporary impairment loss
recognized in other comprehensive income
(4
)
2
Net impairment loss
(16
)
(7
)
Other net realized investment gains (losses)
3
23
Net realized investment gains (losses)
(13
)
16
Net change in fair value of credit derivatives:
Realized gains (losses) and other settlements
8
21
Net unrealized gains (losses)
(68
)
103
Net change in fair value of credit derivatives
(60
)
124
Fair value gains (losses) on committed capital securities
(16
)
2
Fair value gains (losses) on financial guaranty variable interest entities
18
(7
)
Other income (loss)
34
(9
)
Total revenues
245
369
Expenses
Loss and loss adjustment expenses
90
18
Amortization of deferred acquisition costs
4
4
Interest expense
26
25
Other operating expenses
60
56
Total expenses
180
103
Income (loss) before income taxes
65
266
Provision (benefit) for income taxes
Current
30
13
Deferred
(24
)
52
Total provision (benefit) for income taxes
6
65
Net income (loss)
$
59
$
201
Earnings per share:
Basic
$
0.43
$
1.29
Diluted
$
0.43
$
1.28
Dividends per share
$
0.13
$
0.12
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
2
Table of Contents
Assured Guaranty Ltd.
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (unaudited)
(in millions)
Three Months Ended March 31,
2016
2015
Net income (loss)
$
59
$
201
Unrealized holding gains (losses) arising during the period on:
Investments with no other-than-temporary impairment, net of tax provision (benefit) of $31, and $1
95
18
Investments with other-than-temporary impairment, net of tax provision (benefit) of $(10) and $(2)
(17
)
(2
)
Unrealized holding gains (losses) arising during the period, net of tax
78
16
Less: reclassification adjustment for gains (losses) included in net income (loss), net of tax provision (benefit) of $(4) and $6
(6
)
10
Change in net unrealized gains on investments
84
6
Other, net of tax provision
(2
)
(6
)
Other comprehensive income (loss)
$
82
$
0
Comprehensive income (loss)
$
141
$
201
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
3
Table of Contents
Assured Guaranty Ltd.
Consolidated Statement of Shareholders’ Equity (unaudited)
For the
Three Months Ended March 31,
2016
(dollars in millions, except share data)
Common Shares Outstanding
Common Stock Par Value
Additional
Paid-in
Capital
Retained Earnings
Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive Income
Deferred
Equity Compensation
Total
Shareholders’ Equity
Balance at December 31, 2015
137,928,552
$
1
$
1,342
$
4,478
$
237
$
5
$
6,063
Net income
—
—
—
59
—
—
59
Dividends ($0.13 per share)
—
—
—
(18
)
—
—
(18
)
Common stock repurchases
(3,038,928
)
0
(75
)
—
—
—
(75
)
Share-based compensation and other
194,013
0
2
—
—
—
2
Other comprehensive income
—
—
—
—
82
—
82
Balance at March 31, 2016
135,083,637
$
1
$
1,269
$
4,519
$
319
$
5
$
6,113
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
4
Table of Contents
Assured Guaranty Ltd.
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows (unaudited)
(in millions)
Three Months Ended March 31,
2016
2015
Net cash flows provided by (used in) operating activities
$
(90
)
$
23
Investing activities
Fixed-maturity securities:
Purchases
(296
)
(448
)
Sales
162
841
Maturities
301
155
Net sales (purchases) of short-term investments
(63
)
420
Net proceeds from paydowns on financial guaranty variable interest entities’ assets
66
30
Other
2
3
Net cash flows provided by (used in) investing activities
172
1,001
Financing activities
Dividends paid
(18
)
(19
)
Repurchases of common stock
(75
)
(152
)
Share activity under option and incentive plans
0
(5
)
Net paydowns of financial guaranty variable interest entities’ liabilities
(42
)
(39
)
Repayment of long-term debt
0
(1
)
Other
(1
)
4
Net cash flows provided by (used in) financing activities
(136
)
(212
)
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes
0
(2
)
Increase (decrease) in cash
(54
)
810
Cash at beginning of period
166
75
Cash at end of period
$
112
$
885
Supplemental cash flow information
Cash paid (received) during the period for:
Income taxes
$
1
$
17
Interest
$
7
$
7
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
5
Table of Contents
Assured Guaranty Ltd.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)
March 31, 2016
1.
Business and Basis of Presentation
Business
Assured Guaranty Ltd. (“AGL” and, together with its subsidiaries, “Assured Guaranty” or the “Company”) is a Bermuda-based holding company that provides, through its operating subsidiaries, credit protection products to the United States (“U.S.”) and international public finance (including infrastructure) and structured finance markets. The Company applies its credit underwriting judgment, risk management skills and capital markets experience to offer financial guaranty insurance that protects holders of debt instruments and other monetary obligations from defaults in scheduled payments. If an obligor defaults on a scheduled payment due on an obligation, including a scheduled principal or interest payment (“Debt Service”), the Company is required under its unconditional and irrevocable financial guaranty to pay the amount of the shortfall to the holder of the obligation. The Company markets its financial guaranty insurance directly to issuers and underwriters of public finance and structured finance securities as well as to investors in such obligations. The Company guarantees obligations issued principally in the U.S. and the United Kingdom ("U.K."), and also guarantees obligations issued in other countries and regions, including Australia and Western Europe.
In the past, the Company sold credit protection by issuing policies that guaranteed payment obligations under credit derivatives, primarily credit default swaps ("CDS"). Financial guaranty contracts accounted for as credit derivatives are generally structured such that the circumstances giving rise to the Company’s obligation to make loss payments are similar to those for financial guaranty insurance contracts. The Company’s credit derivative transactions are governed by International Swaps and Derivative Association, Inc. (“ISDA”) documentation. The Company has not entered into any new CDS in order to sell credit protection since the beginning of 2009, when regulatory guidelines were issued that limited the terms under which such protection could be sold. The capital and margin requirements applicable under the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act also contributed to the Company not entering into such new CDS since 2009. The Company actively pursues opportunities to terminate existing CDS, which have the effect of reducing future fair value volatility in income and/or reducing rating agency capital charges.
Basis of Presentation
The unaudited interim consolidated financial statements have been prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“GAAP”) and, in the opinion of management, reflect all adjustments that are of a normal recurring nature, necessary for a fair statement of the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the Company and its consolidated variable interest entities (“VIEs”) for the periods presented. The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities as of the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates. These unaudited interim consolidated financial statements are as of
March 31, 2016
and cover the three-month period ended
March 31, 2016
("
First Quarter 2016
") and the three-month period ended
March 31, 2015
("
First Quarter 2015
"). Certain financial information that is normally included in annual financial statements prepared in accordance with GAAP, but is not required for interim reporting purposes, has been condensed or omitted. The year-end balance sheet data was derived from audited financial statements.
The unaudited interim consolidated financial statements include the accounts of AGL, its direct and indirect subsidiaries (collectively, the “Subsidiaries”), and its consolidated VIEs. Intercompany accounts and transactions between and among all consolidated entities have been eliminated. Certain prior year balances have been reclassified to conform to the current year's presentation.
These unaudited interim consolidated financial statements should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements included in AGL’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended
December 31, 2015
, filed with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”).
6
Table of Contents
The Company's principal insurance company subsidiaries are:
•
Assured Guaranty Municipal Corp. ("AGM"), domiciled in New York;
•
Municipal Assurance Corp. ("MAC"), domiciled in New York;
•
Assured Guaranty Corp. ("AGC"), domiciled in Maryland;
•
Assured Guaranty (Europe) Ltd. ("AGE"), organized in the United Kingdom; and
•
Assured Guaranty Re Ltd. (“AG Re”), domiciled in Bermuda.
The Company’s organizational structure includes various holding companies,
two
of which - Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc. (“AGUS”) and Assured Guaranty Municipal Holdings Inc. (“AGMH”) - have public debt outstanding. See Note 15, Long-Term Debt and Credit Facilities and Note 18, Subsidiary Information.
Future Application of Accounting Standards
Share-Based Payments
In March 2016, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued Accounting Standards Update ("ASU") 2016-09,
Compensation - Stock Compensation (Topic 718) - Improvements to Employee Share-Based Payment
, which simplifies several aspects of the accounting for employee share-based payment transactions, including the accounting for income taxes, forfeitures, and statutory tax withholding requirements, as well as classification in the statement of cash flows. The new guidance will require all income tax effects of awards to be recognized in the income statement when the awards vest or are settled. It also will allow an employer to repurchase more of an employee’s shares than it can today for tax withholding purposes without triggering liability accounting and to make a policy election to account for forfeitures as they occur. The ASU is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2016, including interim periods within those fiscal years, and early adoption is permitted. The Company is currently evaluating the effect of adopting this ASU on its Consolidated Financial Statements.
2.
Acquisitions
Consistent with one of its key business strategies of supplementing its book of business through acquisitions, the Company has acquired or agreed to acquire
two
financial guaranty companies within the last 12 months.
CIFG Holding Inc.
On April 12, 2016, AGC entered into an agreement and plan of merger to acquire CIFG Holding Inc. ("CIFG"), the parent of financial guaranty insurer CIFG Assurance North America, Inc. ("CIFG NA"). AGC expects to pay
$450 million
in cash to acquire CIFG, subject to adjustments as contemplated in the agreement, and the acquisition is expected to be completed mid-2016, subject to receipt of anti-trust and insurance regulatory approvals as well as satisfaction of customary closing conditions. CIFG’s stockholders have already approved the acquisition. As part of the transaction, CIFG NA will merge into AGC, which will be the surviving entity. As of December 31, 2015, CIFG had a consolidated insured portfolio of
$5.6 billion
of net par and approximately
$637 million
of consolidated qualified statutory capital.
Radian Asset Assurance Inc.
On April 1, 2015 (“Acquisition Date”), AGC completed the acquisition (“Radian Asset Acquisition”) of all of the issued and outstanding capital stock of financial guaranty insurer Radian Asset Assurance Inc. (“Radian Asset”) for
$804.5 million
. Radian Asset was merged with and into AGC, with AGC as the surviving company of the merger. The Radian Asset Acquisition added
$13.6 billion
to the Company's net par outstanding on April 1, 2015.
Please refer to Note 2, Acquisition of Radian Asset Assurance Inc., in Part II, Item 8. “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of AGL’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2015 for additional information on the acquisition of Radian Asset including the purchase price and the allocation of the purchase price to net assets acquired and the resulting bargain purchase gain and the gains on settlement of pre-existing relationships.
7
Table of Contents
3. Rating Actions
When a rating agency assigns a public rating to a financial obligation guaranteed by one of AGL’s insurance company subsidiaries, it generally awards that obligation the same rating it has assigned to the financial strength of the AGL subsidiary that provides the guaranty. Investors in products insured by AGL’s insurance company subsidiaries frequently rely on ratings published by the rating agencies because such ratings influence the trading value of securities and form the basis for many institutions’ investment guidelines as well as individuals’ bond purchase decisions. Therefore, the Company manages its business with the goal of achieving strong financial strength ratings. However, the methodologies and models used by rating agencies differ, presenting conflicting goals that may make it inefficient or impractical to reach the highest rating level. The methodologies and models are not fully transparent, contain subjective elements and data (such as assumptions about future market demand for the Company’s products) and change frequently. Ratings are subject to continuous review and revision or withdrawal at any time. If the financial strength ratings of one (or more) of the Company’s insurance subsidiaries were reduced below current levels, the Company expects it could have adverse effects on the impacted subsidiary's future business opportunities as well as the premiums the impacted subsidiary could charge for its insurance policies.
The Company periodically assesses the value of each rating assigned to each of its companies, and as a result of such assessment may request that a rating agency add or drop a rating from certain of its companies. For example, the Kroll Bond Rating Agency ("KBRA") ratings were first assigned to MAC in 2013 and to AGM in 2014 and the A.M. Best Company, Inc. ("Best") rating was first assigned to Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd. ("AGRO") in 2015, while a Moody's Investors Service, Inc. ("Moody's") rating was never requested for MAC and was dropped from AG Re and AGRO in 2015.
In the last several years, Standard & Poor's Ratings Services ("S&P") and Moody's have changed, multiple times, their financial strength ratings of AGL's insurance subsidiaries, or changed the outlook on such ratings. More recently, KBRA and Best have assigned financial strength ratings to some of AGL's insurance subsidiaries. The rating agencies' most recent actions related to AGL's insurance subsidiaries are:
•
On December 8, 2015 Moody's published credit opinions maintaining its existing insurance financial strength ratings of A2 (stable outlook) on AGM and AGE and A3 (negative outlook) on AGC and AGC's subsidiary Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. ("AGUK"). Effective April 8, 2015, at the Company's request, Moody’s withdrew the financial strength ratings it had assigned to AG Re and AGRO.
•
On August 3, 2015 and December 10, 2015, KBRA affirmed the AA+ (stable outlook) financial strength ratings of MAC and AGM, respectively.
•
On June 29, 2015, S&P affirmed the AA (stable) financial strength ratings of all of AGL's insurance subsidiaries.
•
On May 5, 2015, Best assigned to AGRO a financial strength rating of A+ (Stable), which is their second highest rating.
There can be no assurance that any of the rating agencies will not take negative action on their financial strength ratings of AGL's insurance subsidiaries in the future.
For a discussion of the effects of rating actions on the Company, see the following:
•
Note 6, Financial Guaranty Insurance
•
Note 8, Financial Guaranty Contracts Accounted for as Credit Derivatives
•
Note 13, Reinsurance and Other Monoline Exposures
•
Note 15, Long-Term Debt and Credit Facilities
4.
Outstanding Exposure
The Company’s financial guaranty contracts are written in either insurance or credit derivative form, but collectively are considered financial guaranty contracts. The Company seeks to limit its exposure to losses by underwriting obligations that it views as investment grade at inception, although, as part of its loss mitigation strategy for existing troubled credits, it may underwrite new issuances that it views as below-investment-grade ("BIG"). The Company diversifies its insured portfolio across asset classes and, in the structured finance portfolio, requires rigorous subordination or collateralization requirements. Reinsurance may be used in order to reduce net exposure to certain insured transactions.
8
Table of Contents
Public finance obligations insured by the Company consist primarily of general obligation bonds supported by the taxing powers of U.S. state or municipal governmental authorities, as well as tax-supported bonds, revenue bonds and other obligations supported by covenants from state or municipal governmental authorities or other municipal obligors to impose and collect fees and charges for public services or specific infrastructure projects. The Company also includes within public finance obligations those obligations backed by the cash flow from leases or other revenues from projects serving substantial public purposes, including utilities, toll roads, health care facilities and government office buildings. The Company also includes within public finance similar obligations issued by territorial and non-U.S. sovereign and sub-sovereign issuers and governmental authorities.
Structured finance obligations insured by the Company are generally issued by special purpose entities, including VIEs, and backed by pools of assets having an ascertainable cash flow or market value or other specialized financial obligations. Some of these VIEs are consolidated as described in Note 9, Consolidated Variable Interest Entities. Unless otherwise specified, the outstanding par and Debt Service amounts presented in this note include outstanding exposures on VIEs whether or not they are consolidated.
Surveillance Categories
The Company segregates its insured portfolio into investment grade and BIG surveillance categories to facilitate the appropriate allocation of resources to monitoring and loss mitigation efforts and to aid in establishing the appropriate cycle for periodic review for each exposure. BIG exposures include all exposures with internal credit ratings below BBB-. The Company’s internal credit ratings are based on internal assessments of the likelihood of default and loss severity in the event of default. Internal credit ratings are expressed on a ratings scale similar to that used by the rating agencies and are generally reflective of an approach similar to that employed by the rating agencies, except that the Company's internal credit ratings focus on future performance rather than lifetime performance.
The Company monitors its investment grade credits to determine whether any need to be internally downgraded to BIG and refreshes its internal credit ratings on individual credits in quarterly, semi-annual or annual cycles based on the Company’s view of the credit’s quality, loss potential, volatility and sector. Ratings on credits in sectors identified as under the most stress or with the most potential volatility are reviewed every quarter. The Company’s credit ratings on assumed credits are based on the Company’s reviews of low-rated credits or credits in volatile sectors, unless such information is not available, in which case, the ceding company’s credit rating of the transactions are used.
Credits identified as BIG are subjected to further review to determine the probability of a loss. See Note 5, Expected Loss to be Paid, for additional information. Surveillance personnel then assign each BIG transaction to the appropriate BIG surveillance category based upon whether a future loss is expected and whether a claim has been paid. For surveillance purposes, the Company calculates present value using a constant discount rate of
4%
or
5%
depending on the insurance subsidiary. (Risk-free rates are used for calculating the expected loss for financial statement measurement purposes.)
More extensive monitoring and intervention is employed for all BIG surveillance categories, with internal credit ratings reviewed quarterly. The Company expects “future losses” on a transaction when the Company believes there is at least a
50%
chance that, on a present value basis, it will pay more claims in the future of that transaction than it will have reimbursed. The three BIG categories are:
•
BIG Category 1: Below-investment-grade transactions showing sufficient deterioration to make future losses possible, but for which none are currently expected.
•
BIG Category 2: Below-investment-grade transactions for which future losses are expected but for which no claims (other than liquidity claims, which are claims that the Company expects to be reimbursed within
one
year) have yet been paid.
•
BIG Category 3: Below-investment-grade transactions for which future losses are expected and on which claims (other than liquidity claims) have been paid.
Components of Outstanding Exposure
Unless otherwise noted, ratings disclosed herein on the Company's insured portfolio reflect its internal ratings. The Company classifies those portions of risks benefiting from reimbursement obligations collateralized by eligible assets held in trust in acceptable reimbursement structures as the higher of 'AA' or their current internal rating.
9
Table of Contents
The Company purchases securities that it has insured, and for which it has expected losses to be paid, in order to
mitigate the economic effect of insured losses ("loss mitigation securities"). The Company excludes amounts attributable to loss mitigation securities (unless otherwise indicated) from par and Debt Service outstanding, because it manages such securities as investments and not insurance exposure. The following table presents the gross and net debt service for all financial guaranty contracts.
Financial Guaranty
Debt Service Outstanding
Gross Debt Service
Outstanding
Net Debt Service
Outstanding
March 31,
2016
December 31,
2015
March 31,
2016
December 31,
2015
(in millions)
Public finance
$
496,630
$
515,494
$
476,362
$
494,426
Structured finance
42,012
43,976
40,037
41,915
Total financial guaranty
$
538,642
$
559,470
$
516,399
$
536,341
In addition to the amounts shown in the table above, the Company’s net mortgage guaranty insurance debt service was approximately
$107 million
as of
March 31, 2016
and
$102 million
as of
December 31, 2015
, related to loans originated in Ireland. The increase in the net mortgage guaranty insurance debt service is due to exchange rate fluctuations.
Financial Guaranty Portfolio by Internal Rating
As of March 31, 2016
Public Finance
U.S.
Public Finance
Non-U.S.
Structured Finance
U.S
Structured Finance
Non-U.S
Total
Rating
Category
Net Par
Outstanding
%
Net Par
Outstanding
%
Net Par
Outstanding
%
Net Par
Outstanding
%
Net Par
Outstanding
%
(dollars in millions)
AAA
$
2,541
0.9
%
$
688
2.3
%
$
13,953
45.8
%
$
2,529
49.4
%
$
19,711
5.7
%
AA
65,310
23.2
1,969
6.7
7,505
24.7
154
3.0
74,938
21.6
A
145,515
51.6
6,695
22.8
2,584
8.5
551
10.8
155,345
44.7
BBB
60,736
21.5
18,622
63.4
1,279
4.2
1,267
24.7
81,904
23.6
BIG
7,953
2.8
1,411
4.8
5,131
16.8
622
12.1
15,117
4.4
Total net par outstanding (1)
$
282,055
100.0
%
$
29,385
100.0
%
$
30,452
100.0
%
$
5,123
100.0
%
$
347,015
100.0
%
_____________________
(1)
Excludes
$1.5 billion
of loss mitigation securities insured and held by the Company as of
March 31, 2016
, which are primarily BIG.
10
Table of Contents
Financial Guaranty Portfolio by Internal Rating
As of December 31, 2015
Public Finance
U.S.
Public Finance
Non-U.S.
Structured Finance
U.S
Structured Finance
Non-U.S
Total
Rating
Category
Net Par
Outstanding
%
Net Par
Outstanding
%
Net Par
Outstanding
%
Net Par
Outstanding
%
Net Par
Outstanding
%
(dollars in millions)
AAA
$
3,053
1.1
%
$
709
2.4
%
$
14,366
45.2
%
$
2,709
50.6
%
$
20,837
5.8
%
AA
69,274
23.7
2,017
6.8
7,934
25.0
177
3.3
79,402
22.1
A
157,440
53.9
6,765
22.9
2,486
7.8
555
10.3
167,246
46.7
BBB
54,315
18.6
18,708
63.2
1,515
4.8
1,365
25.5
75,903
21.2
BIG
7,784
2.7
1,378
4.7
5,469
17.2
552
10.3
15,183
4.2
Total net par outstanding (1)
$
291,866
100.0
%
$
29,577
100.0
%
$
31,770
100.0
%
$
5,358
100.0
%
$
358,571
100.0
%
_____________________
(1)
Excludes
$1.5 billion
of loss mitigation securities insured and held by the Company as of
December 31, 2015
, which are primarily BIG.
In addition to amounts shown in the tables above, the Company had outstanding commitments to provide guaranties of
$240 million
for public finance obligations as of
March 31, 2016
. The expiration dates for the public finance commitments range between
April 1, 2016
and
February 25, 2017
, with
$66 million
expiring prior to the date of this filing and an additional
$110 million
expiring prior to December 31, 2016. The commitments are contingent on the satisfaction of all conditions set forth in them and may expire unused or be canceled at the counterparty’s request. Therefore, the total commitment amount does not necessarily reflect actual future guaranteed amounts.
Components of BIG Portfolio
Components of BIG Net Par Outstanding
(Insurance and Credit Derivative Form)
As of March 31, 2016
BIG Net Par Outstanding
Net Par
BIG 1
BIG 2
BIG 3
Total BIG
Outstanding
(in millions)
U.S. public finance
$
4,608
$
3,191
$
154
$
7,953
$
282,055
Non-U.S. public finance
882
529
—
1,411
29,385
Structured finance:
First lien U.S. residential mortgage-backed securities ("RMBS"):
Prime first lien
192
32
24
248
425
Alt-A first lien
125
66
507
698
1,238
Option ARM
50
7
78
135
235
Subprime
82
281
866
1,229
3,305
Second lien U.S. RMBS
225
47
1,100
1,372
1,474
Total U.S. RMBS
674
433
2,575
3,682
6,677
Triple-X life insurance transactions
—
—
216
216
2,650
Trust preferred securities (“TruPS”)
650
127
—
777
4,296
Student loans
—
68
81
149
1,815
Other structured finance
743
147
39
929
20,137
Total
$
7,557
$
4,495
$
3,065
$
15,117
$
347,015
11
Table of Contents
Components of BIG Net Par Outstanding
(Insurance and Credit Derivative Form)
As of December 31, 2015
BIG Net Par Outstanding
Net Par
BIG 1
BIG 2
BIG 3
Total BIG
Outstanding
(in millions)
U.S. public finance
$
4,765
$
2,883
$
136
$
7,784
$
291,866
Non-U.S. public finance
875
503
—
1,378
29,577
Structured finance:
First lien U.S. RMBS:
Prime first lien
225
34
25
284
445
Alt-A first lien
119
73
601
793
1,353
Option ARM
39
12
90
141
252
Subprime
146
228
930
1,304
3,457
Second lien U.S. RMBS
491
50
910
1,451
1,560
Total U.S. RMBS
1,020
397
2,556
3,973
7,067
Triple-X life insurance transactions
—
—
216
216
2,750
TruPS
679
127
—
806
4,379
Student loans
12
68
83
163
1,818
Other structured finance
672
151
40
863
21,114
Total
$
8,023
$
4,129
$
3,031
$
15,183
$
358,571
BIG Net Par Outstanding
and Number of Risks
As of March 31, 2016
Net Par Outstanding
Number of Risks(2)
Description
Financial
Guaranty
Insurance(1)
Credit
Derivative
Total
Financial
Guaranty
Insurance(1)
Credit
Derivative
Total
(dollars in millions)
BIG:
Category 1
$
6,585
$
972
$
7,557
202
12
214
Category 2
4,015
480
4,495
86
7
93
Category 3
2,938
127
3,065
129
12
141
Total BIG
$
13,538
$
1,579
$
15,117
417
31
448
12
Table of Contents
BIG Net Par Outstanding
and Number of Risks
As of December 31, 2015
Net Par Outstanding
Number of Risks(2)
Description
Financial
Guaranty
Insurance(1)
Credit
Derivative
Total
Financial
Guaranty
Insurance(1)
Credit
Derivative
Total
(dollars in millions)
BIG:
Category 1
$
7,019
$
1,004
$
8,023
202
12
214
Category 2
3,655
474
4,129
85
8
93
Category 3
2,900
131
3,031
132
12
144
Total BIG
$
13,574
$
1,609
$
15,183
419
32
451
_____________________
(1)
Includes net par outstanding for VIEs.
(2)
A risk represents the aggregate of the financial guaranty policies that share the same revenue source for purposes of making Debt Service payments.
Exposure to Puerto Rico
The Company has insured exposure to general obligation bonds of the Commonwealth of Puerto Rico and various obligations of its related authorities and public corporations aggregating
$5.1 billion
net par as of
March 31, 2016
, all of which are rated BIG.
Puerto Rico has experienced significant general fund budget deficits in recent years. In addition to high debt levels, Puerto Rico faces a challenging economic environment.
In June 2014, the Puerto Rico legislature passed the Puerto Rico Public Corporation Debt Enforcement and Recovery Act (the "Recovery Act") in order to provide a legislative framework for certain public corporations experiencing severe financial stress to restructure their debt, including Puerto Rico Highway and Transportation Authority ("PRHTA") and Puerto Rico Electric Power Authority ("PREPA"). Subsequently, the Commonwealth stated PREPA might need to seek relief under the Recovery Act due to liquidity constraints. Investors in bonds issued by PREPA filed suit in the United States District Court for the District of Puerto Rico challenging the Recovery Act. On February 6, 2015, the U.S. District Court for the District of Puerto Rico ruled the Recovery Act is preempted by the U.S. Bankruptcy Code and is therefore void. On July 6, 2015, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the First Circuit upheld that ruling, and on December 4, 2015, the U.S. Supreme Court granted petitions for writs of certiorari relating to that ruling. Oral arguments were held on March 22, 2016. Typical Supreme Court practice suggests a decision could be announced in June 2016, but there is no assurance that an opinion will be announced at such time, especially in light of the Supreme Court vacancy.
On June 28, 2015, Governor García Padilla of Puerto Rico (the "Governor") publicly stated that the Commonwealth’s public debt, considering the current level of economic activity, is unpayable and that a comprehensive debt restructuring may be necessary, and he has made similar statements since then.
On September 9, 2015, the Working Group for the Fiscal and Economic Recovery of Puerto Rico (“Working Group”) established by the Governor published its “Puerto Rico Fiscal and Economic Growth Plan” (the “FEGP”). The FEGP included a recommendation that the Commonwealth’s advisors begin to work on a voluntary exchange offer to its creditors as part of the FEGP.
On November 30, 2015, and December 8, 2015, the Governor issued executive orders (“Clawback Orders”) directing the Puerto Rico Department of Treasury and the Puerto Rico Tourism Company to retain or transfer certain taxes pledged to secure the payment of bonds issued by PRHTA, PRIFA and Puerto Rico Convention Center District Authority ("PRCCDA"). On January 7, 2016 the Company sued various Puerto Rico governmental officials in the United States District Court, District of Puerto Rico asserting that this attempt to “claw back” pledged taxes is unconstitutional, and demanding declaratory and injunctive relief. The Puerto Rico credits insured by the Company impacted by the Clawback Orders are shown in the table “Puerto Rico Net Par Outstanding” below.
13
Table of Contents
On January 1, 2016 Puerto Rico Infrastructure Finance Authority ("PRIFA") defaulted on payment of a portion of the interest due on its bonds on that date. For those PRIFA bonds the Company had insured, the Company paid approximately
$451 thousand
of claims for the interest payments on which PRIFA had defaulted.
On April 6, 2016 the Governor signed into law the Puerto Rico Emergency Moratorium & Financial Rehabilitation Act (the “Moratorium Act”). The Moratorium Act purportedly empowers the Governor to declare a moratorium, entity by entity, on debt service payments on debt of the commonwealth and its related authorities and public corporations, as well as instituting a stay against related litigation, among other things. It is possible that a court may find any attempt to exercise the power to declare a moratorium on debt service payments purportedly granted by the Moratorium Act to be unconstitutional, and the impact of any attempt to exercise such power on the Puerto Rico credits insured by the Company is uncertain. Shortly after signing it into law, the Governor used the authority of the Moratorium Act to declare an emergency period with respect to the Government Development Bank (the “GDB”), placing restrictions on its disbursements and certain of its other activities and moving the clearing of payroll of Commonwealth and GDB employees from the GDB.
On April 30, 2016, the Governor signed an order under the Moratorium Act ordering a moratorium on the debt service payment of approximately
$422 million
due to be made by the GDB on May 2, 2016. On May 1, 2016, the GDB announced a tentative agreement with a group of creditors of the GDB (the “Ad Hoc Group”) for a restructuring of GDB’s notes and that the GDB would pay the interest due on May 2, 2016. According to the announcement, the Ad Hoc Group agreed to forbear from initiating litigation for
30
days during the pendency of negotiations. The GDB noted in its May 1 announcement that the tentative agreement requires
100%
participation of the GDB’s creditors and that it would be unlikely to reach that level of participation without a restructuring law enabling it to bind non-consenting creditors. The Company does not insure any debt issued by the GDB.
There have been a number of other proposals, plans and legislative initiatives offered in Puerto Rico and in the United States aimed at addressing Puerto Rico’s fiscal issues. Among the responses proposed is a federal financial control board and access to bankruptcy courts or another restructuring mechanism. In addition, the Working Group has made several proposals for voluntary exchanges that include terms such as discounts, extensions and subordination. The final shape and timing of responses to Puerto Rico’s distress eventually enacted or implemented by Puerto Rico or the United States, if any, and the impact of any such actions on obligations insured by the Company, is uncertain and may differ substantially from the recommendations of the Working Group or any other proposals or plans described in the press or offered to date or in the future.
S&P, Moody’s and Fitch Ratings have lowered the credit rating of the Commonwealth’s bonds and on its public corporations several times over the past approximately two years, and the Commonwealth has disclosed its liquidity has been adversely affected by rating agency downgrades and by the limited market access for its debt, and also noted it has relied on short-term financings and interim loans from the GDB and other private lenders, which reliance has constrained its liquidity and increased its near-term refinancing risk.
PREPA
As of
March 31, 2016
, the Company had
$744 million
insured net par outstanding of PREPA obligations. On July 1, 2015, PREPA made full payment of the
$416 million
of principal and interest due on its bonds, including bonds insured by AGM and AGC. However, that payment was conditioned on and facilitated by AGM and AGC agreeing, also on July 1, to purchase a portion of
$131 million
of interest-bearing bonds to help replenish certain of the operating funds PREPA used to make the
$416 million
of principal and interest payments. On July 31, 2015, AGM and AGC purchased
$74 million
aggregate principal amount of those bonds; the bonds were repaid in full in 2016.
On December 24, 2015, AGM and AGC entered into a Restructuring Support Agreement (“RSA”) with PREPA, an ad hoc group of uninsured bondholders and a group of fuel-line lenders that would, subject to certain conditions, result in, among other things, modernization of the utility and a restructuring of current debt. Upon finalization of the contemplated restructuring transaction, insured PREPA revenue bonds (with no reduction to par or stated interest rate or extension of maturity) will be supported by securitization bonds issued by a special purpose corporation and secured by a transition charge assessed on ratepayers. To facilitate the securitization transaction, which enables PREPA to achieve debt relief and more efficient capital markets financing, Assured Guaranty will issue surety insurance policies in an aggregate amount not expected to exceed
$113 million
in exchange for a market premium and to support a portion of the reserve fund for the securitization bonds. Certain of the creditors also agreed, subject to certain conditions, to participate in a bridge financing. The Company’s share of the bridge financing is approximately
$15 million
. Legislation meeting the requirements of the RSA was enacted on February 16, 2016. The closing of the restructuring transaction, the issuance of the surety bonds and the closing of the bridge financing are subject
14
Table of Contents
to certain conditions, including confirmation that the enacted legislation meets all requirements of the RSA and execution of acceptable documentation and legal opinions.
There can be no assurance that the conditions in the RSA will be met or that, if the conditions are met, the RSA's other provisions, including those related to the restructuring of the insured PREPA revenue bonds, will be implemented. In addition, the impact of the Moratorium Act or any attempt to exercise the power purportedly granted by the Moratorium Act on the implementation of the RSA is uncertain. PREPA, during the pendency of the agreements, has suspended deposits into its debt service fund.
PRHTA
As of
March 31, 2016
, the Company had
$910 million
insured net par outstanding of PRHTA (Transportation revenue) bonds and
$369 million
net par of PRHTA (Highway revenue) bonds. The Clawback Orders cover Commonwealth-derived taxes that are allocated to PRHTA. The Company believes that such sources represented a substantial majority of PRHTA’s revenues in 2015.
Puerto Rico Sales Tax Financing Corporation (“COFINA”)
As of
March 31, 2016
, the Company had
$270 million
insured net par outstanding of junior COFINA bonds, which are secured by a lien on certain sales and use taxes. There have been proposals from both the Commonwealth and from holders of certain senior COFINA bonds to restructure COFINA debt.
Puerto Rico Convention Center District Authority
As of March 31, 2016, the Company had
$164 million
insured net par outstanding of PRCCDA bonds, which are secured by certain hotel tax revenues. These revenues are sensitive to the level of economic activity in the area and are subject to the Clawback Orders.
Puerto Rico Aqueduct and Sewer Authority (“PRASA”)
As of March 31, 2016, the Company had
$388 million
insured par outstanding to PRASA bonds, which are secured by the gross revenues of the system. On September 15, 2015, PRASA entered into a settlement with the U.S. Justice Department and the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency that requires it to spend
$1.6 billion
to upgrade and improve its sewer system island-wide. According to a material event notice PRASA filed on March 4, 2016, it owed its contractors
$140 million
.
Municipal Finance Agency ("MFA")
As of
March 31, 2016
, the Company had
$387 million
net par outstanding of bonds issued by MFA secured by a pledge of local property tax revenues. On October 13, 2015, the Company filed a motion to intervene in litigation between Centro de Recaudación de Ingresos Municipales (“CRIM”) and the GDB in which CRIM was seeking to ensure that the pledged tax revenues are, and will continue to be, available to support the MFA bonds. While the Company’s motion to intervene was denied, the GDB and CRIM have reported that they executed a new deed of trust that requires the GDB, as fiduciary, to keep the pledged tax revenues separate from any other GDB monies or accounts and that governs the manner in which the pledged revenues may be invested and dispersed.
15
Table of Contents
The following tables show the Company’s insured exposure to general obligation bonds of Puerto Rico and various obligations of its related authorities and public corporations.
Puerto Rico
Gross Par and Gross Debt Service Outstanding
Gross Par Outstanding
Gross Debt Service Outstanding
March 31,
2016
December 31,
2015
March 31,
2016
December 31,
2015
(in millions)
Previously Subject to the Voided Recovery Act (1)
$
2,965
$
2,965
$
5,090
$
5,162
Not Previously Subject to the Voided Recovery Act
2,791
2,790
4,398
4,470
Total
$
5,756
$
5,755
$
9,488
$
9,632
____________________
(1)
On February 6, 2015, the U.S. District Court for the District of Puerto Rico ruled that the Recovery Act is preempted by the U.S. Bankruptcy Code and is therefore void. On July 6, 2015, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the First Circuit upheld that ruling, and on December 4, 2015, the U.S. Supreme Court granted petitions for writs of certiorari relating to that ruling.
16
Table of Contents
Puerto Rico
Net Par Outstanding
As of
March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
Total
Internal Rating
Total
Internal Rating
(in millions)
Exposures Previously Subject to the Voided Recovery Act:
PRHTA (Transportation revenue) (1)
$
910
CCC-
$
909
CCC-
PREPA
744
CC
744
CC
PRASA
388
CCC
388
CCC
PRHTA (Highway revenue)(1)
369
CCC
370
CCC
PRCCDA (1)
164
CCC-
164
CCC-
Total
2,575
2,575
Exposures Not Previously Subject to the Voided Recovery Act:
Commonwealth of Puerto Rico - General Obligation Bonds
1,615
CCC
1,615
CCC
MFA
387
CCC-
387
CCC-
COFINA
270
CCC+
269
CCC+
Puerto Rico Public Buildings Authority
188
CCC
188
CCC
PRIFA (1) (2)
18
C
18
CCC-
University of Puerto Rico
1
CCC-
1
CCC-
Total
2,479
2,478
Total net exposure to Puerto Rico
$
5,054
$
5,053
____________________
(1)
The Governor issued executive orders on November 30, 2015, and December 8, 2015, directing the Puerto Rico Department of Treasury and the Puerto Rico Tourism Company to retain or transfer certain taxes and revenues pledged to secure the payment of bonds issued by PRHTA, PRIFA and PRCCDA. On January 7, 2016 the Company sued various Puerto Rico governmental officials in the United States District Court, District of Puerto Rico asserting that this attempt to “claw back” pledged taxes and revenues is unconstitutional, and demanding declaratory and injunctive relief.
(2)
On January 1, 2016 PRIFA defaulted on full payment of a portion of the interest due on its bonds on that date. For those PRIFA bonds the Company had insured, the Company paid approximately
$451 thousand
of claims for the interest payments on which PRIFA had defaulted.
17
Table of Contents
The following table shows the scheduled amortization of the insured general obligation bonds of Puerto Rico and various obligations of its related authorities and public corporations. The Company guarantees payments of interest and principal when those amounts are scheduled to be paid and cannot be required to pay on an accelerated basis. In the event that obligors default on their obligations, the Company would only be required to pay the shortfall between the principal and interest due in any given period and the amount paid by the obligors.
Amortization Schedule of Puerto Rico Net Par Outstanding
and Net Debt Service Outstanding
As of
March 31, 2016
Scheduled Net Par Amortization
Scheduled Net Debt Service Amortization
Previously Subject to the Voided Recovery Act
Not Previously Subject to the Voided Recovery Act
Total
Previously Subject to the Voided Recovery Act
Not Previously Subject to the Voided Recovery Act
Total
(in millions)
2016 (April 1 – June 30)
$
0
$
0
$
0
$
2
$
0
$
2
2016 (July 1 – September 30)
98
204
302
161
267
428
2016 (October 1 – December 31)
0
0
0
2
0
2
2017
51
171
222
175
288
463
2018
56
123
179
178
232
410
2019
74
130
204
192
232
424
2020
87
183
270
202
280
482
2021
66
59
125
177
146
323
2022
47
68
115
153
152
305
2023
110
40
150
214
123
337
2024
89
85
174
188
164
352
2025
111
85
196
206
159
365
2026-2030
590
353
943
974
660
1,634
2031-2035
583
548
1,131
838
761
1,599
2036-2040
308
271
579
427
355
782
2041-2045
137
159
296
206
174
380
2046-2047
168
—
168
181
—
181
Total
$
2,575
$
2,479
$
5,054
$
4,476
$
3,993
$
8,469
Exposure to the Selected European Countries
The European countries where the Company has exposure and believes heightened uncertainties exist are: Hungary, Italy, Portugal and Spain (collectively, the “Selected European Countries”). The Company’s direct economic exposure to the Selected European Countries (based on par for financial guaranty contracts and notional amount for financial guaranty contracts accounted for as derivatives) is shown in the following table, net of ceded reinsurance.
18
Table of Contents
Net Direct Economic Exposure to Selected European Countries(1)
As of
March 31, 2016
Hungary
Italy
Portugal
Spain
Total
(in millions)
Sub-sovereign exposure(2)
$
271
$
827
$
84
$
375
$
1,557
Non-sovereign exposure(3)
179
458
—
—
637
Total
$
450
$
1,285
$
84
$
375
$
2,194
Total BIG (See Note 5)
$
379
$
—
$
84
$
375
$
838
____________________
(1)
While the Company’s exposures are shown in U.S. dollars, the obligations the Company insures are in various currencies, primarily Euros.
(2)
Sub-sovereign exposure in Selected European Countries includes transactions backed by receivables from or supported by sub-sovereigns, which are governmental or government-backed entities other than the ultimate governing body of the country.
(3)
Non-sovereign exposure in Selected European Countries includes debt of regulated utilities and RMBS.
The Company has excluded from the exposure tables above its indirect economic exposure to the Selected European Countries through policies it provides on pooled corporate and commercial receivables transactions. The Company calculates indirect exposure to a country by multiplying the par amount of a transaction insured by the Company times the percent of the relevant collateral pool reported as having a nexus to the country. On that basis, the Company has calculated exposure of
$206 million
to Selected European Countries (plus Greece) in transactions with
$4.1 billion
of net par outstanding. The indirect exposure to credits with a nexus to Greece is
$6 million
across several highly rated pooled corporate obligations with net par outstanding of
$231 million
.
5.
Expected Loss to be Paid
Loss Estimation Process
This note provides information regarding expected claim payments to be made under all contracts in the insured portfolio, regardless of the accounting model. The Company’s loss reserve committees estimate expected loss to be paid for all contracts by reviewing analyses that consider various scenarios with corresponding probabilities assigned to them. Depending upon the nature of the risk, the Company’s view of the potential size of any loss and the information available to the Company, that analysis may be based upon individually developed cash flow models, internal credit rating assessments and sector-driven loss severity assumptions or judgmental assessments.
The financial guaranties issued by the Company insure the credit performance of the guaranteed obligations over an extended period of time, in some cases over 30 years, and in most circumstances, the Company has no right to cancel such financial guaranties. The determination of expected loss to be paid is an inherently subjective process involving numerous estimates, assumptions and judgments by management, using both internal and external data sources with regard to frequency, severity of loss, economic projections, governmental actions, negotiations and other factors that affect credit performance. These estimates, assumptions and judgments, and the factors on which they are based, may change materially over a quarter, and as a result the Company’s loss estimates may change materially over that same period.
The Company does not use traditional actuarial approaches to determine its estimates of expected losses. Actual losses will ultimately depend on future events or transaction performance and may be influenced by many interrelated factors that are difficult to predict. As a result, the Company's current projections of probable and estimable losses may be subject to considerable volatility and may not reflect the Company's ultimate claims paid. For information on the Company's loss estimation process, please refer to Note 5, Expected Losses to be Paid, of Part II, Item 8, Financial Statements and Supplementary Data in AGL's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2015.
19
Table of Contents
The following tables present a roll forward of the present value of net expected loss to be paid for all contracts, whether accounted for as insurance, credit derivatives or financial guaranty ("FG") VIEs, by sector, after the benefit for expected recoveries for breaches of representations and warranties ("R&W") and other expected recoveries. The Company used weighted average risk-free rates for U.S. dollar denominated obligations that ranged from
0.0%
to
2.88%
as of
March 31, 2016
and
0.0%
to
3.25%
as of
December 31, 2015
.
Net Expected Loss to be Paid
After Net Expected Recoveries for Breaches of R&W
Roll Forward
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Net expected loss to be paid, beginning of period
$
1,391
$
1,169
Economic loss development due to:
Accretion of discount
9
7
Changes in discount rates
63
7
Changes in timing and assumptions
(13
)
(17
)
Total economic loss development
59
(3
)
Paid losses
(113
)
(12
)
Net expected loss to be paid, end of period
$
1,337
$
1,154
20
Table of Contents
Net Expected Loss to be Paid
After Net Expected Recoveries for Breaches of R&W
Roll Forward by Sector
First Quarter 2016
Net Expected
Loss to be
Paid
(Recovered)
as of
December 31, 2015 (2)
Economic Loss
Development
(Paid)
Recovered
Losses (1)
Net Expected
Loss to be
Paid
(Recovered)
as of
March 31, 2016 (2)
(in millions)
Public Finance:
U.S. public finance
$
771
$
98
$
(5
)
$
864
Non-U.S. public finance
38
1
—
39
Public Finance
809
99
(5
)
903
Structured Finance:
U.S. RMBS:
First lien:
Prime first lien
(2
)
0
1
(1
)
Alt-A first lien
127
(16
)
(75
)
36
Option ARM
(28
)
(21
)
2
(47
)
Subprime
251
1
(12
)
240
Total first lien
348
(36
)
(84
)
228
Second lien
61
5
(1
)
65
Total U.S. RMBS
409
(31
)
(85
)
293
Triple-X life insurance transactions
99
4
(1
)
102
Student loans
54
(14
)
(8
)
32
Other structured finance
20
1
(14
)
7
Structured Finance
582
(40
)
(108
)
434
Total
$
1,391
$
59
$
(113
)
$
1,337
21
Table of Contents
Net Expected Loss to be Paid
After Net Expected Recoveries for Breaches of R&W
Roll Forward by Sector
First Quarter 2015
Net Expected
Loss to be
Paid (Recovered
)
as of
December 31, 2014
Economic Loss
Development
(Paid)
Recovered
Losses
(1)
Net Expected
Loss to be
Paid (Recovered
)
as of
March 31, 2015
(in millions)
Public Finance:
U.S. public finance
$
303
$
9
$
(2
)
$
310
Non-U.S. public finance
45
(3
)
—
42
Public Finance
348
6
(2
)
352
Structured Finance:
U.S. RMBS:
First lien:
Prime first lien
4
0
(1
)
3
Alt-A first lien
304
(5
)
(10
)
289
Option ARM
(16
)
4
(4
)
(16
)
Subprime
303
(1
)
(9
)
293
Total first lien
595
(2
)
(24
)
569
Second lien
(11
)
6
6
1
Total U.S. RMBS
584
4
(18
)
570
Triple-X life insurance transactions
161
5
(1
)
165
Student loans
68
(6
)
—
62
Other structured finance
8
(12
)
9
5
Structured Finance
821
(9
)
(10
)
802
Total
$
1,169
$
(3
)
$
(12
)
$
1,154
____________________
(1)
Net of ceded paid losses, whether or not such amounts have been settled with reinsurers. Ceded paid losses are typically settled
45 days
after the end of the reporting period. Such amounts are recorded in reinsurance recoverable on paid losses included in other assets. The Company paid
$2 million
and
$4 million
in l
oss adjustment expenses ("
LAE") for
First Quarter 2016
and
2015
, respectively.
(2)
Includes expected LAE to be paid of
$9 million
as of
March 31, 2016
and
$12 million
as of
December 31, 2015
.
22
Table of Contents
Future Net R&W Benefit Receivable (Payable)(1)
As of
March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
(in millions)
U.S. RMBS:
First lien
$
(30
)
$
0
Second lien
77
79
Total
$
47
$
79
____________________
(1)
The Company’s agreements with providers of breaches of R&W generally provide for reimbursement to the Company as claim payments are made and, to the extent the Company later receives reimbursements of such claims from excess spread or other sources, for the Company to provide reimbursement to the R&W providers. See the section “Breaches of Representations and Warranties” for information about the R&W agreements and eligible assets held in trust with respect to such agreements. When the Company projects receiving more reimbursements in the future than it projects to pay in claims, the Company will have a net R&W payable.
The following tables present the present value of net expected loss to be paid for all contracts by accounting model, by sector and after the benefit for expected recoveries for breaches of R&W.
Net Expected Loss to be Paid (Recovered)
By Accounting Model
As of March 31, 2016
Financial
Guaranty
Insurance
FG VIEs(1) and Other
Credit
Derivatives(2)
Total
(in millions)
Public Finance:
U.S. public finance
$
864
$
—
$
0
$
864
Non-U.S. public finance
39
—
—
39
Public Finance
903
—
0
903
Structured Finance:
U.S. RMBS:
First lien:
Prime first lien
2
—
(3
)
(1
)
Alt-A first lien
19
18
(1
)
36
Option ARM
(44
)
—
(3
)
(47
)
Subprime
148
55
37
240
Total first lien
125
73
30
228
Second lien
19
43
3
65
Total U.S. RMBS
144
116
33
293
Triple-X life insurance transactions
91
—
11
102
Student loans
32
—
—
32
Other structured finance
40
2
(35
)
7
Structured Finance
307
118
9
434
Total
$
1,210
$
118
$
9
$
1,337
23
Table of Contents
Net Expected Loss to be Paid (Recovered)
By Accounting Model
As of December 31, 2015
Financial
Guaranty
Insurance
FG VIEs(1) and Other
Credit
Derivatives(2)
Total
(in millions)
Public Finance:
U.S. public finance
$
771
$
—
$
0
$
771
Non-U.S. public finance
38
—
—
38
Public Finance
809
—
0
809
Structured Finance:
U.S. RMBS:
First lien:
Prime first lien
2
—
(4
)
(2
)
Alt-A first lien
110
17
0
127
Option ARM
(27
)
—
(1
)
(28
)
Subprime
153
59
39
251
Total first lien
238
76
34
348
Second lien
13
44
4
61
Total U.S. RMBS
251
120
38
409
Triple-X life insurance transactions
88
—
11
99
Student loans
54
—
—
54
Other structured finance
37
16
(33
)
20
Structured Finance
430
136
16
582
Total
$
1,239
$
136
$
16
$
1,391
___________________
(1) Refer to Note 9, Consolidated Variable Interest Entities.
(2) Refer to Note 8, Financial Guaranty Contracts Accounted for as Credit Derivatives.
24
Table of Contents
The following tables present the net economic loss development for all contracts by accounting model, by sector and after the benefit for expected recoveries for breaches of R&W.
Net Economic Loss Development (Benefit)
By Accounting Model
First Quarter
2016
Financial
Guaranty
Insurance
FG VIEs(1) and Other
Credit
Derivatives(2)
Total
(in millions)
Public Finance:
U.S. public finance
$
98
$
—
$
0
$
98
Non-U.S. public finance
1
—
0
1
Public Finance
99
—
0
99
Structured Finance:
U.S. RMBS:
First lien:
Prime first lien
0
—
0
0
Alt-A first lien
(17
)
1
0
(16
)
Option ARM
(19
)
—
(2
)
(21
)
Subprime
3
0
(2
)
1
Total first lien
(33
)
1
(4
)
(36
)
Second lien
2
3
0
5
Total U.S. RMBS
(31
)
4
(4
)
(31
)
Triple-X life insurance transactions
3
—
1
4
Student loans
(14
)
—
—
(14
)
Other structured finance
4
0
(3
)
1
Structured Finance
(38
)
4
(6
)
(40
)
Total
$
61
$
4
$
(6
)
$
59
25
Table of Contents
Net Economic Loss Development (Benefit)
By Accounting Model
First Quarter
2015
Financial
Guaranty
Insurance
FG VIEs(1) and Other
Credit
Derivatives(2)
Total
(in millions)
Public Finance:
U.S. public finance
$
9
$
—
$
—
$
9
Non-U.S. public finance
(3
)
—
—
(3
)
Public Finance
6
—
—
6
Structured Finance:
U.S. RMBS:
First lien:
Prime first lien
1
—
(1
)
0
Alt-A first lien
2
—
(7
)
(5
)
Option ARM
1
—
3
4
Subprime
(4
)
4
(1
)
(1
)
Total first lien
—
4
(6
)
(2
)
Second lien
8
(1
)
(1
)
6
Total U.S. RMBS
8
3
(7
)
4
Triple-X life insurance transactions
4
—
1
5
Student loans
(6
)
—
—
(6
)
Other structured finance
0
(1
)
(11
)
(12
)
Structured Finance
6
2
(17
)
(9
)
Total
$
12
$
2
$
(17
)
$
(3
)
_________________
(1) Refer to Note 9, Consolidated Variable Interest Entities.
(2) Refer to Note 8, Financial Guaranty Contracts Accounted for as Credit Derivatives.
Selected U.S. Public Finance Transactions
The Company insures general obligation bonds of the Commonwealth of Puerto Rico and various obligations of its related authorities and public corporations aggregating
$5.1 billion
net par as of
March 31, 2016
, all of which are BIG. For additional information regarding the Company's exposure to general obligations of Commonwealth of Puerto Rico and various obligations of its related authorities and public corporations, please refer to "Exposure to Puerto Rico" in Note 4, Outstanding Exposure.
On February 25, 2015, a plan of adjustment resolving the bankruptcy filing of the City of Stockton, California under chapter 9 of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code became effective. As of
March 31, 2016
, the Company’s net exposure subject to the plan consists of
$115 million
of pension obligation bonds. As part of the plan settlement, the City will repay the pension obligation bonds from certain fixed payments and certain variable payments contingent on the City's revenue growth.
The Company has approximately
$21 million
of net par exposure as of
March 31, 2016
to bonds issued by Parkway East Public Improvement District, which is located in Madison County, Mississippi. The bonds, which are rated BIG, are payable from special assessments on properties within the District, as well as amounts paid under a contribution agreement with the County in which the County covenants that it will provide funds in the event special assessments are not sufficient to make a debt service payment. The special assessments have not been sufficient to pay debt service in full. In earlier years, the County provided funding to cover the balance of the debt service requirement, but the County now claims that the District’s
26
Table of Contents
failure to reimburse it within the two years stipulated in the contribution agreement means that the County is not required to provide funding until it is reimbursed. On April 27, 2016, the court granted the Company's motion for summary judgment in a declaratory judgment action, agreeing with the Company's interpretation of the County's obligations under the contribution agreement. See "Recovery Litigation" below.
The Company also has
$14.6 billion
of net par exposure to healthcare transactions. The BIG net par outstanding in this sector is
$315 million
.
The Company projects that its total net expected loss across its troubled U.S. public finance credits as of
March 31, 2016
, which incorporated the likelihood of the various outcomes, will be
$864 million
, compared with a net expected loss of
$771 million
as of December 31, 2015. Economic loss development in
First Quarter 2016
was
$98 million
, which was primarily attributable to Puerto Rico exposures.
Certain Selected European Country Sub-Sovereign Transactions
The Company insures and reinsures credits with sub-sovereign exposure to various Spanish and Portuguese issuers where a Spanish and Portuguese sovereign default may cause the sub-sovereigns also to default. The Company's gross exposure to these Spanish and Portuguese credits is
$471 million
and
$90 million
, respectively, and exposure net of reinsurance for Spanish and Portuguese credits is
$375 million
and
$84 million
, respectively. The Company rates most of these issuers in the BB category due to the financial condition of Spain and Portugal and their dependence on the sovereign. The Company's Hungary exposure is to infrastructure bonds dependent on payments from Hungarian governmental entities. The Company's gross exposure to these Hungarian credits is
$274 million
and its exposure net of reinsurance is
$271 million
, all of which is rated BIG. The Company estimated net expected losses of
$36 million
related to these Spanish, Portuguese and Hungarian credits. The economic loss of approximately
$1 million
during
First Quarter 2016
was primarily related to changes in the exchange rate between the Euro and U.S. Dollar.
Approach to Projecting Losses in U.S. RMBS
The Company projects losses on its insured U.S. RMBS on a transaction-by-transaction basis by projecting the performance of the underlying pool of mortgages over time and then applying the structural features (i.e., payment priorities and tranching) of the RMBS and any R&W agreements to the projected performance of the collateral over time. The resulting projected claim payments or reimbursements are then discounted using risk-free rates.
First Quarter 2016 U.S. RMBS Loss Projections
Based on its observation during the period of the performance of its insured transactions (including early stage delinquencies, late stage delinquencies and loss severity) as well as the residential property market and economy in general, the Company chose to use the same general assumptions to project RMBS losses as of
March 31, 2016
as it used as of
December 31, 2015
, but increased severities for specific vintages of Alt-A first lien and subprime transactions based on observed data.
U.S. First Lien RMBS Loss Projections: Alt-A First Lien, Option ARM, Subprime and Prime
The majority of projected losses in first lien RMBS transactions are expected to come from non-performing mortgage loans (those that are or in the past twelve months have been
two
or more payments behind, have been modified, are in foreclosure, or have been foreclosed upon). Changes in the amount of non-performing loans from the amount projected in the previous period are one of the primary drivers of loss development in this portfolio. In order to determine the number of defaults resulting from these delinquent and foreclosed loans, the Company applies a liquidation rate assumption to loans in each of various non-performing categories. The Company arrived at its liquidation rates based on data purchased from a third party provider and assumptions about how delays in the foreclosure process and loan modifications may ultimately affect the rate at which loans are liquidated. Each quarter the Company reviews the most recent twelve months of this data and (if necessary) adjusts its liquidation rates based on its observations. The following table shows liquidation assumptions for various non-performing categories.
27
Table of Contents
First Lien Liquidation Rates
March 31, 2016
December 31, 2015
Current Loans Modified in the Previous 12 Months
Alt A and Prime
25%
25%
Option ARM
25
25
Subprime
25
25
Current Loans Delinquent in the Previous 12 Months
Alt A and Prime
25
25
Option ARM
25
25
Subprime
25
25
30 – 59 Days Delinquent
Alt A and Prime
35
35
Option ARM
40
40
Subprime
45
45
60 – 89 Days Delinquent
Alt A and Prime
45
45
Option ARM
50
50
Subprime
55
55
90+ Days Delinquent
Alt A and Prime
55
55
Option ARM
60
60
Subprime
60
60
Bankruptcy
Alt A and Prime
45
45
Option ARM
50
50
Subprime
40
40
Foreclosure
Alt A and Prime
65
65
Option ARM
70
70
Subprime
70
70
Real Estate Owned
All
100
100
While the Company uses liquidation rates as described above to project defaults of non-performing loans (including current loans modified or delinquent within the last 12 months), it projects defaults on presently current loans by applying a
conditional default rate ("
CDR") trend. The start of that CDR trend is based on the defaults the Company projects will emerge from currently nonperforming, recently nonperforming and modified loans. The total amount of expected defaults from the non-performing loans is translated into a constant CDR (
i.e
., the CDR plateau), which, if applied for each of the next
36
months, would be sufficient to produce approximately the amount of defaults that were calculated to emerge from the various delinquency categories. The CDR thus calculated individually on the delinquent collateral pool for each RMBS is then used as the starting point for the CDR curve used to project defaults of the presently performing loans.
In the base case, after the initial
36
-month CDR plateau period, each transaction’s CDR is projected to improve over
12
months to an intermediate CDR (calculated as
20%
of its CDR plateau); that intermediate CDR is held constant for
36
months and then trails off in steps to a final CDR of
5%
of the CDR plateau. In the base case, the Company assumes the final CDR will be reached
7.5 years
after the initial 36-month CDR plateau period, which is the same assumption used at
December 31, 2015
. Under the Company’s methodology, defaults projected to occur in the first
36
months represent defaults that can be attributed to loans that were modified or delinquent in the last 12 months or that are currently delinquent or in foreclosure, while the defaults projected to occur using the projected CDR trend after the first
36
month period represent defaults attributable to borrowers that are currently performing or are projected to reperform.
28
Table of Contents
Another important driver of loss projections is loss severity, which is the amount of loss the transaction incurs on a loan after the application of net proceeds from the disposal of the underlying property. Loss severities experienced in first lien transactions have reached historically high levels, and the Company is assuming in the base case that these high levels generally will continue for another
18
months. The Company determines its initial loss severity based on actual recent experience. As a result, as of March 31, 2016, the Company updated severities for specific vintages of Alt-A first lien and subprime transactions based on observed data. The Company then assumes that loss severities begin returning to levels consistent with underwriting assumptions beginning after the initial
18
month period, declining to
40%
in the base case over
2.5
years.
29
Table of Contents
The following table shows the range as well as the average, weighted by outstanding net insured par, for key assumptions used in the calculation of expected loss to be paid for individual transactions for direct vintage 2004 - 2008 first lien U.S. RMBS.
Key Assumptions in Base Case Expected Loss Estimates
First Lien RMBS(1)
As of
March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
Range
Weighted Average
Range
Weighted Average
Alt-A First Lien
Plateau CDR
0.9
%
-
27.8%
6.4%
1.7
%
–
26.4%
6.4%
Intermediate CDR
0.2
%
-
5.6%
1.3%
0.3
%
–
5.3%
1.3%
Period until intermediate CDR
48 months
48 months
Final CDR
0.0
%
-
1.4%
0.3%
0.1
%
–
1.3%
0.3%
Initial loss severity:
2005 and prior
60.0%
60.0%
2006
80.0%
70.0%
2007
65.0%
65.0%
Initial conditional prepayment rate ("CPR")
2.7
%
-
31.6%
11.8%
2.7
%
–
32.5%
11.5%
Final CPR(2)
15%
15%
Option ARM
Plateau CDR
3.4
%
-
10.6%
7.8%
3.5
%
–
10.3%
7.8%
Intermediate CDR
0.7
%
-
2.1%
1.6%
0.7
%
–
2.1%
1.6%
Period until intermediate CDR
48 months
48 months
Final CDR
0.2
%
-
0.5%
0.4%
0.2
%
–
0.5%
0.4%
Initial loss severity:
2005 and prior
60.0%
60.0%
2006
70.0%
70.0%
2007
65.0%
65.0%
Initial CPR
2.0
%
-
13.7%
5.5%
1.5
%
–
10.9%
5.1%
Final CPR(2)
15%
15%
Subprime
Plateau CDR
4.2
%
-
14.4%
9.4%
4.7
%
–
13.2%
9.5%
Intermediate CDR
0.8
%
-
2.9%
1.9%
0.9
%
–
2.6%
1.9%
Period until intermediate CDR
48 months
48 months
Final CDR
0.2
%
-
0.7%
0.4%
0.2
%
–
0.7%
0.4%
Initial loss severity:
2005 and prior
80.0%
75.0%
2006
90.0%
90.0%
2007
90.0%
90.0%
Initial CPR
0.3
%
-
9.2%
4.2%
0.0
%
–
10.1%
3.6%
Final CPR(2)
15%
15%
____________________
(1)
Represents variables for most heavily weighted scenario (the “base case”).
(2)
For transactions where the initial CPR is higher than the final CPR, the initial CPR is held constant and the final CPR is not used.
30
Table of Contents
The rate at which the principal amount of loans is voluntarily prepaid may impact both the amount of losses projected (since that amount is a function of the CDR, the loss severity and the loan balance over time) as well as the amount of excess spread (the amount by which the interest paid by the borrowers on the underlying loan exceeds the amount of interest owed on the insured obligations). The assumption for the voluntary CPR follows a similar pattern to that of the CDR. The current level of voluntary prepayments is assumed to continue for the plateau period before gradually increasing over
12
months to the final CPR, which is assumed to be
15%
in the base case. For transactions where the initial CPR is higher than the final CPR, the initial CPR is held constant and the final CPR is not used. These CPR assumptions are the same as those the Company used for
December 31, 2015
.
In estimating expected losses, the Company modeled and probability weighted sensitivities for first lien transactions by varying its assumptions of how fast a recovery is expected to occur. One of the variables used to model sensitivities was how quickly the CDR returned to its modeled equilibrium, which was defined as
5%
of the initial CDR. The Company also stressed CPR and the speed of recovery of loss severity rates. The Company probability weighted a total of
five
scenarios as of
March 31, 2016
. The Company used a similar approach to establish its pessimistic and optimistic scenarios as of
March 31, 2016
as it used as of
December 31, 2015
, increasing and decreasing the periods of stress from those used in the base case.
In a somewhat more stressful environment than that of the base case, where the CDR plateau was extended
six
months (to be
42
months long) before the same more gradual CDR recovery and loss severities were assumed to recover over
4.5
rather than
2.5
years (and subprime loss severities were assumed to recover only to
60%
and Option ARM and Alt A loss severities to only
45%
), expected loss to be paid would increase from current projections by approximately
$12 million
for Alt-A first liens,
$7 million
for Option ARM,
$43 million
for subprime and
$0.1 million
for prime transactions.
In an even more stressful scenario where loss severities were assumed to rise and then recover over
nine
years and the initial ramp-down of the CDR was assumed to occur over
15
months and other assumptions were the same as the other stress scenario, expected loss to be paid would increase from current projections by approximately
$31 million
for Alt-A first liens,
$14 million
for Option ARM,
$59 million
for subprime and
$0.5 million
for prime transactions.
In a scenario with a somewhat less stressful environment than the base case, where CDR recovery was somewhat less gradual, expected loss to be paid would decrease from current projections by approximately
$2 million
for Alt-A first liens,
$19 million
for Option ARM,
$10 million
for subprime and
$19 thousand
for prime transactions.
In an even less stressful scenario where the CDR plateau was
six
months shorter (
30
months, effectively assuming that liquidation rates would improve) and the CDR recovery was more pronounced, (including an initial ramp-down of the CDR over
nine
months), expected loss to be paid would decrease from current projections by approximately
$14 million
for Alt-A first liens,
$31 million
for Option ARM,
$33 million
for subprime and
$0.2 million
for prime transactions.
U.S. Second Lien RMBS Loss Projections
Second lien RMBS transactions include both
home equity lines of credit ("
HELOC") and closed end second lien. The Company believes the primary variable affecting its expected losses in second lien RMBS transactions is the amount and timing of future losses in the collateral pool supporting the transactions. Expected losses are also a function of the structure of the transaction; the voluntary prepayment rate (typically also referred to as CPR of the collateral); the interest rate environment; and assumptions about the draw rate and loss severity.
In second lien transactions the projection of near-term defaults from currently delinquent loans is relatively straightforward because loans in second lien transactions are generally “charged off” (treated as defaulted) by the securitization’s servicer once the loan is
180
days past due. Most second lien transactions report the amount of loans in five monthly delinquency categories (
i.e.
,
30
-
59
days past due,
60
-
89
days past due,
90
-
119
days past due,
120
-
149
days past due and
150
-
179
days past due). The Company estimates the amount of loans that will default over the next
five
months by calculating current representative liquidation rates. A liquidation rate is the percent of loans in a given cohort (in this instance, delinquency category) that ultimately default. Similar to first liens, the Company then calculates a CDR for
six
months, which is the period over which the currently delinquent collateral is expected to be liquidated. That CDR is then used as the basis for the plateau period that follows the embedded five months of losses. Liquidation rates assumed as of
March 31, 2016
, were from
25%
to
100%
.
For the base case scenario, the CDR (the “plateau CDR”) was held constant for
six
months. Once the plateau period has ended, the CDR is assumed to gradually trend down in uniform increments to its final long-term steady state CDR. (The long-term steady state CDR is calculated as the constant CDR that would have yielded the amount of losses originally expected
31
Table of Contents
at underwriting.) In the base case scenario, the time over which the CDR trends down to its final CDR is
28
months. Therefore, the total stress period for second lien transactions is
34
months, comprising
five
months of delinquent data, a
one
month plateau period and
28
months of decrease to the steady state CDR, the same as of
December 31, 2015
.
HELOC loans generally permit the borrower to pay only interest for an initial period (often
ten years
) and, after that period, require the borrower to make both the monthly interest payment and a monthly principal payment, and so increase the borrower's aggregate monthly payment. Some of the HELOC loans underlying the Company's insured HELOC transactions have reached their principal amortization period. The Company has observed that the increase in monthly payments occurring when a loan reaches its principal amortization period, even if mitigated by borrower relief offered by the servicer, is associated with increased borrower defaults. Thus, most of the Company's HELOC projections incorporate an assumption that a percentage of loans reaching their amortization periods will default around the time of the payment increase. These projected defaults are in addition to those generated using the CDR curve as described above. This assumption is similar to the one used as of
December 31, 2015
. For
March 31, 2016
the Company used the same general approach it had refined in the fourth quarter of 2015 to calculate the number of additional delinquencies as a function of the number of modified loans in the transaction and the final steady state CDR.
When a second lien loan defaults, there is generally a very low recovery. The Company had assumed as of
March 31, 2016
that it will generally recover only
2%
of the collateral defaulting in the future and declining additional amounts of post-default receipts on previously defaulted collateral. This is the same assumption used as of
December 31, 2015
.
The rate at which the principal amount of loans is prepaid may impact both the amount of losses projected as well as the amount of excess spread. In the base case, an average CPR (based on experience of the most recent
three
quarters) is assumed to continue until the end of the plateau before gradually increasing to the final CPR over the same period the CDR decreases. The final CPR is assumed to be
15%
for second lien transactions, which is lower than the historical average but reflects the Company’s continued uncertainty about the projected performance of the borrowers in these transactions. For transactions where the initial CPR is higher than the final CPR, the initial CPR is held constant and the final CPR is not used. This pattern is generally consistent with how the Company modeled the CPR as of
December 31, 2015
and March 31, 2015. To the extent that prepayments differ from projected levels it could materially change the Company’s projected excess spread and losses.
The Company uses a number of other variables in its second lien loss projections, including the spread between relevant interest rate indices. These variables have been relatively stable and in the relevant ranges have less impact on the projection results than the variables discussed above. However, in a number of HELOC transactions the servicers have been modifying poorly performing loans from floating to fixed rates, and, as a result, rising interest rates would negatively impact the excess spread available from these modified loans to support the transactions. The Company incorporated these modifications in its assumptions.
In estimating expected losses, the Company modeled and probability weighted
five
possible CDR curves applicable to the period preceding the return to the long-term steady state CDR. The Company used
five
scenarios at
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
. The Company believes that the level of the elevated CDR and the length of time it will persist, the ultimate prepayment rate, and the amount of additional defaults because of the expiry of the interest only period, are the primary drivers behind the likely amount of losses the collateral will suffer. The Company continues to evaluate the assumptions affecting its modeling results.
Most of the Company's projected second lien RMBS losses are from HELOC transactions. The following table shows the range as well as the average, weighted by outstanding net insured par, for key assumptions for the calculation of expected loss to be paid for individual transactions for direct vintage 2004 - 2008 HELOCs.
32
Table of Contents
Key Assumptions in Base Case Expected Loss Estimates
HELOCs (1)
As of
March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
Range
Weighted Average
Range
Weighted Average
Plateau CDR
5.3
%
–
26.1%
11.9%
4.9
%
–
23.5%
10.3%
Final CDR trended down to
0.5
%
–
3.2%
1.2%
0.5
%
–
3.2%
1.2%
Period until final CDR
34 months
34 months
Initial CPR
11.0
%
–
14.9%
11.1%
10.9%
Final CPR(2)
10.0
%
–
15.0%
13.3%
10.0
%
–
15.0%
13.3%
Loss severity
98.0%
98.0%
____________________
(1)
Represents variables for most heavily weighted scenario (the “base case”).
(2)
For transactions where the initial CPR is higher than the final CPR, the initial CPR is held constant and the final CPR is not used.
The Company’s base case assumed a
six
month CDR plateau and a
28
month ramp-down (for a total stress period of
34
months). The Company also modeled a scenario with a longer period of elevated defaults and another with a shorter period of elevated defaults. Increasing the CDR plateau to
eight
months and increasing the ramp-down by
three
months to
31
months (for a total stress period of
39
months), and doubling the defaults relating to the end of the interest only period would increase the expected loss by approximately
$52 million
for HELOC transactions. On the other hand, reducing the CDR plateau to
four
months and decreasing the length of the CDR ramp-down to
25
months (for a total stress period of
29
months), and lowering the ultimate prepayment rate to
10%
would decrease the expected loss by approximately
$31 million
for HELOC transactions.
Breaches of Representations and Warranties
The Company entered into agreements with R&W providers under which those providers made payments to the Company, agreed to make payments to the Company in the future, and / or repurchased loans from the transactions, all in return for releases of related liability by the Company.
The Company has included in its net expected loss estimates as of
March 31, 2016
an estimated net benefit of
$47 million
(net of reinsurance). Most of the amount projected to be received pursuant to agreements with R&W providers benefits from eligible assets placed in trusts to collateralize the R&W provider’s future reimbursement obligation, with the amount of such collateral subject to increase or decrease from time to time as determined by rating agency requirements. Currently the Company has agreements with
three
counterparties where a future reimbursement obligation is collateralized by eligible assets held in trust:
•
Bank of America
. Under the Company's agreement with Bank of America Corporation and certain of its subsidiaries (“Bank of America”), Bank of America agreed to reimburse the Company for
80%
of claims on the first lien transactions covered by the agreement that the Company pays in the future, until the aggregate lifetime collateral losses (not insurance losses or claims) on those transactions reach
$6.6 billion
. As of
March 31, 2016
aggregate lifetime collateral losses on those transactions was
$4.4 billion
, and the Company was projecting in its base case that such collateral losses would eventually reach
$5.2 billion
. Bank of America's reimbursement obligation is secured by
$578 million
of collateral held in trust for the Company's benefit.
•
Deutsche Bank
. Under the Company's agreement with Deutsche Bank AG and certain of its affiliates (collectively, “Deutsche Bank”), Deutsche Bank agreed to reimburse the Company for certain claims it pays in the future on eight first and second lien transactions, including
80%
of claims it pays on those transactions until the aggregate lifetime claims (before reimbursement) reach
$319 million
. As of
March 31, 2016
, the Company was projecting in its base case that such aggregate lifetime claims would remain below
$319 million
. In the event aggregate lifetime claims paid exceed
$389 million
, Deutsche Bank must reimburse the Company for
85%
of such claims paid (in excess of
$389 million
) until such claims paid reach
$600 million
. Deutsche Bank’s reimbursement obligation is secured by
$70 million
of collateral held in trust for the Company’s benefit.
33
Table of Contents
•
UBS.
Under the Company’s agreement with UBS Real Estate Securities Inc. and affiliates (“UBS”), UBS agreed to reimburse the Company for
85%
of future losses on
three
first lien RMBS transactions, and such reimbursement obligation is secured by
$49 million
of collateral held in trust for the Company's benefit.
The Company uses the same RMBS projection scenarios and weightings to project its future R&W benefit as it uses to project RMBS losses on its portfolio. To the extent the Company increases its loss projections, the R&W benefit generally will also increase, subject to the agreement limits and thresholds described above. Similarly, to the extent the Company decreases its loss projections, the R&W benefit generally will also decrease, subject to the agreement limits and thresholds described above.
Triple-X Life Insurance Transactions
The Company had
$2.7 billion
of net par exposure to Triple-X life insurance transactions as of
March 31, 2016
.
Two
of these transactions, with
$216 million
of net par outstanding, are rated BIG. The Triple-X life insurance transactions are based on discrete blocks of individual life insurance business. In older vintage Triple-X life insurance transactions, which include the
two
BIG-rated transactions, the amounts raised by the sale of the notes insured by the Company were used to capitalize a special purpose vehicle that provides reinsurance to a life insurer or reinsurer. The monies are invested at inception in accounts managed by third-party investment managers. In the case of the two BIG-rated transactions, material amounts of their assets were invested in U.S. RMBS. Based on its analysis of the information currently available, including estimates of future investment performance, and projected credit impairments on the invested assets and performance of the blocks of life insurance business at
March 31, 2016
, the Company’s projected net expected loss to be paid is
$102 million
. The economic loss development during
First Quarter 2016
was approximately
$4 million
, which was due primarily to changes in discount rates and updates to the projected life insurance cash flows.
Student Loan Transactions
The Company has insured or reinsured
$1.8 billion
net par of student loan securitizations issued by private issuers and that it classifies as structured finance. Of this amount,
$149 million
is rated BIG. The Company is projecting approximately
$32 million
of net expected loss to be paid on these transactions. In general, the losses are due to: (i) the poor credit performance of private student loan collateral and high loss severities, or (ii) high interest rates on auction rate securities with respect to which the auctions have failed. The economic benefit during
First Quarter 2016
was approximately
$14 million
, which was driven primarily by the commutation of certain assumed student loan exposures.
TruPS and other structured finance
The Company's TruPS sector has BIG par of
$777 million
and all other structured finance BIG par totaled
$929 million
, comprising primarily transactions backed by perpetual preferred securities, commercial receivables and manufactured housing loans. The Company has expected loss to be paid of
$7 million
for TruPS and other structured finance transactions as of
March 31, 2016
. The economic loss development during
First Quarter 2016
was
$1 million
, which was attributable primarily to a commercial receivable transaction downgraded to BIG during First Quarter 2016.
Recovery Litigation
Public Finance Transactions
On January 7, 2016, AGM, AGC and Ambac Assurance Corporation (“Ambac”) commenced an action for declaratory judgment and injunctive relief in the U.S. District Court for the District of Puerto Rico to invalidate the executive orders issued by the Governor on November 30, 2015 and December 8, 2015 directing that the Secretary of the Treasury of the Commonwealth of Puerto Rico and the Puerto Rico Tourism Company retain or transfer (in other words, "claw back") certain taxes and revenues pledged to secure the payment of bonds issued by the Puerto Rico Highways and Transportation Authority, the Puerto Rico Convention Center District Authority and the Puerto Rico Infrastructure Financing Authority. The action is still in its early stages.
34
Table of Contents
On November 1, 2013, Radian Asset commenced a declaratory judgment action in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of Mississippi against Madison County, Mississippi and the Parkway East Public Improvement District to establish its rights under a contribution agreement from the County supporting certain special assessment bonds issued by the District and insured by Radian Asset (now AGC). As of
March 31, 2016
,
$21 million
of such bonds were outstanding. The County maintained that its payment obligation is limited to
two years
of annual debt service, while AGC contended the County’s obligations under the contribution agreement continue so long as the bonds remain outstanding. On April 27, 2016, the Court granted AGC's motion for summary judgment, agreeing with AGC's interpretation of the County's obligations. The Court's action is subject to appeal.
Triple-X Life Insurance Transactions
In December 2008, AGUK filed an action in the Supreme Court of the State of New York against J.P. Morgan Investment Management Inc. (“JPMIM”), the investment manager for a triple-X life insurance transaction, Orkney Re II plc ("Orkney"), involving securities guaranteed by AGUK. The action alleges that JPMIM engaged in breaches of fiduciary duty, gross negligence and breaches of contract based upon its handling of the Orkney investments. After AGUK’s claims were dismissed with prejudice in January 2010, AGUK was successful in its subsequent motions and appeals and, as of December 2011, all of AGUK’s claims for breaches of fiduciary duty, gross negligence and contract were reinstated in full. On January 22, 2016, AGUK filed a motion for partial summary judgment with respect to one of its claims for breach of contract relating to a failure to invest in compliance with the Delaware insurance code. Discovery was completed on February 22, 2016.
6.
Financial Guaranty Insurance
Financial Guaranty Insurance Premiums
The portfolio of outstanding exposures discussed in Note 4, Outstanding Exposure, includes financial guaranty contracts that meet the definition of insurance contracts as well as those that meet the definition of a derivative under GAAP. Amounts presented in this note relate to financial guaranty insurance contracts, unless otherwise noted. See Note 8, Financial Guaranty Contracts Accounted for as Credit Derivatives for amounts that relate to CDS and Note 9, Consolidated Variable Interest Entities for amounts that relate to FG VIEs.
Net Earned Premiums
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Scheduled net earned premiums
$
91
$
96
Acceleration of net earned premiums (1)
89
41
Accretion of discount on net premiums receivable
3
4
Financial guaranty insurance net earned premiums
183
141
Other
0
1
Net earned premiums (2)
$
183
$
142
___________________
(1)
Reflects the unscheduled refunding or termination of the insurance on an insured obligation as well as changes in scheduled earnings due to changes in the expected lives of the insured obligations.
(2)
Excludes
$5 million
and
$5 million
for
First Quarter
2016
and
2015
, respectively, related to consolidated FG VIEs.
35
Table of Contents
Components of Unearned Premium Reserve
As of March 31, 2016
As of December 31, 2015
Gross
Ceded
Net(1)
Gross
Ceded
Net(1)
(in millions)
Deferred premium revenue
3,829
241
3,588
4,008
238
3,770
Contra-paid (2)
(19
)
(5
)
(14
)
(12
)
(6
)
(6
)
Unearned premium reserve
$
3,810
$
236
$
3,574
$
3,996
$
232
$
3,764
____________________
(1)
Excludes
$105 million
and
$110 million
of deferred premium revenue, and
$29 million
and
$30 million
of contra-paid related to FG VIEs as of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, respectively.
(2)
See "Financial Guaranty Insurance Losses– Insurance Contracts' Loss Information" below for an explanation of "contra-paid".
Gross Premium Receivable,
Net of Commissions on Assumed Business
Roll Forward
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Beginning of period, December 31
$
693
$
729
Gross premium written, net of commissions on assumed business
41
36
Gross premiums received, net of commissions on assumed business
(49
)
(36
)
Adjustments:
Changes in the expected term
(22
)
(6
)
Accretion of discount, net of commissions on assumed business
0
5
Foreign exchange translation
(1
)
(25
)
Consolidation/deconsolidation of FG VIEs
0
(4
)
End of period, March 31 (1)
$
662
$
699
____________________
(1)
Excludes
$16 million
and
$22 million
as of
March 31, 2016
and
March 31, 2015
, respectively, related to consolidated FG VIEs. Excludes
$1 million
related to non-financial guaranty line of business as of March 31, 2015.
Foreign exchange translation relates to installment premium receivables denominated in currencies other than the U.S. dollar. Approximately
55%
,
52%
and
49%
of installment premiums at
March 31, 2016
,
December 31, 2015
and March 31, 2015, respectively, are denominated in currencies other than the U.S. dollar, primarily the Euro and British Pound Sterling.
36
Table of Contents
The timing and cumulative amount of actual collections may differ from expected collections in the tables below due to factors such as foreign exchange rate fluctuations, counterparty collectability issues, accelerations, commutations and changes in expected lives.
Expected Collections of
Financial Guaranty Insurance Gross Premiums Receivable,
Net of Commissions on Assumed Business
(Undiscounted)
As of March 31, 2016
(in millions)
2016 (April 1 – June 30)
$
31
2016 (July 1 – September 30)
18
2016 (October 1 – December 31)
17
2017
66
2018
58
2019
55
2020
55
2021-2025
222
2026-2030
147
2031-2035
103
After 2035
82
Total(1)
$
854
____________________
(1)
Excludes expected cash collections on FG VIEs of
$20 million
.
Scheduled Financial Guaranty Insurance Net Earned Premiums
As of March 31, 2016
(in millions)
2016 (April 1 – June 30)
$
92
2016 (July 1 – September 30)
89
2016 (October 1 – December 31)
85
2017
313
2018
290
2019
264
2020
245
2021-2025
955
2026-2030
610
2031-2035
363
After 2035
282
Net deferred premium revenue(1)
3,588
Future accretion
179
Total future net earned premiums
$
3,767
____________________
(1)
Excludes scheduled net earned premiums on consolidated FG VIEs of
$105 million
.
37
Table of Contents
Selected Information for Financial Guaranty Insurance
Policies Paid in Installments
As of
March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
(dollars in millions)
Premiums receivable, net of commission payable
$
662
$
693
Gross deferred premium revenue
1,156
1,240
Weighted-average risk-free rate used to discount premiums
3.1
%
3.1
%
Weighted-average period of premiums receivable (in years)
9.4
9.4
38
Table of Contents
Financial Guaranty Insurance Losses
Insurance Contracts' Loss Information
The following table provides information on loss and LAE reserves and salvage and subrogation recoverable, net of reinsurance. The Company used weighted average risk-free rates for U.S. dollar denominated financial guaranty insurance obligations that ranged from
0.0%
to
2.88%
as of
March 31, 2016
and
0.0%
to
3.25%
as of
December 31, 2015
. Financial guaranty insurance expected LAE reserve was
$8 million
as of
March 31, 2016
and
$10 million
as of
December 31, 2015
.
Loss and LAE Reserve and Salvage and Subrogation Recoverable
Net of Reinsurance
Insurance Contracts
As of March 31, 2016
As of December 31, 2015
Loss and
LAE
Reserve, net
Salvage and
Subrogation
Recoverable, net
Net Reserve (Recoverable)
Loss and
LAE
Reserve, net
Salvage and
Subrogation
Recoverable, net
Net Reserve (Recoverable)
(in millions)
Public Finance:
U.S. public finance
$
695
$
7
$
688
$
604
$
7
$
597
Non-U.S. public finance
27
—
27
25
—
25
Public Finance
722
7
715
629
7
622
Structured Finance:
U.S. RMBS:
First lien:
Prime first lien
2
—
2
2
—
2
Alt-A first lien
35
73
(38
)
46
—
46
Option ARM
10
51
(41
)
13
42
(29
)
Subprime
161
21
140
169
21
148
First lien
208
145
63
230
63
167
Second lien
34
49
(15
)
32
53
(21
)
Total U.S. RMBS
242
194
48
262
116
146
Triple-X life insurance transactions
85
—
85
82
—
82
Student loans
30
—
30
51
—
51
Other structured finance
32
—
32
48
—
48
Structured Finance
389
194
195
443
116
327
Subtotal
1,111
201
910
1,072
123
949
Other recoverables
—
3
(3
)
—
3
(3
)
Subtotal
1,111
204
907
1,072
126
946
Effect of consolidating FG VIEs
(71
)
—
(71
)
(74
)
0
(74
)
Total (1)
$
1,040
$
204
$
836
$
998
$
126
$
872
____________________
(1)
See “Components of Net Reserves (Salvage)” table for loss and LAE reserve and salvage and subrogation recoverable components.
39
Table of Contents
Components of Net Reserves (Salvage)
As of
March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
(in millions)
Loss and LAE reserve
$
1,112
$
1,067
Reinsurance recoverable on unpaid losses
(72
)
(69
)
Loss and LAE reserve, net
1,040
998
Salvage and subrogation recoverable
(206
)
(126
)
Salvage and subrogation payable(1)
5
3
Other recoverables
(3
)
(3
)
Salvage and subrogation recoverable, net and other recoverable
(204
)
(126
)
Net reserves (salvage)
$
836
$
872
____________________
(1)
Recorded as a component of reinsurance balances payable.
The table below provides a reconciliation of net expected loss to be paid to net expected loss to be expensed. Expected loss to be paid differs from expected loss to be expensed due to: (1) the contra-paid which represent the claim payments made and recoveries received that have not yet been recognized in the statement of operations, (2) salvage and subrogation recoverable for transactions that are in a net recovery position where the Company has not yet received recoveries on claims previously paid (having the effect of reducing net expected loss to be paid by the amount of the previously paid claim and the expected recovery), but will have no future income effect (because the previously paid claims and the corresponding recovery of those claims will offset in income in future periods), and (3) loss reserves that have already been established (and therefore expensed but not yet paid).
Reconciliation of Net Expected Loss to be Paid and
Net Expected Loss to be Expensed
Financial Guaranty Insurance Contracts
As of
March 31, 2016
(in millions)
Net expected loss to be paid - financial guaranty insurance (1)
$
1,210
Contra-paid, net
14
Salvage and subrogation recoverable, net of reinsurance
201
Loss and LAE reserve - financial guaranty insurance contracts, net of reinsurance
(1,038
)
Other recoveries
2
Net expected loss to be expensed (present value) (2)
$
389
____________________
(1)
See "Net Expected Loss to be Paid (Recovered) by Accounting Model" table in Note 5, Expected Loss to be Paid.
(2)
Excludes
$74 million
as of
March 31, 2016
, related to consolidated FG VIEs.
40
Table of Contents
The following table provides a schedule of the expected timing of net expected losses to be expensed. The amount and timing of actual loss and LAE may differ from the estimates shown below due to factors such as accelerations, commutations, changes in expected lives and updates to loss estimates. This table excludes amounts related to FG VIEs, which are eliminated in consolidation.
Net Expected Loss to be Expensed
Financial Guaranty Insurance Contracts
As of
March 31, 2016
(in millions)
2016 (April 1 – June 30)
$
11
2016 (July 1 – September 30)
10
2016 (October 1 – December 31)
9
Subtotal 2016
30
2017
34
2018
33
2019
30
2020
27
2021-2025
100
2026-2030
70
2031-2035
45
After 2035
20
Net expected loss to be expensed
389
Future accretion
156
Total expected future loss and LAE
$
545
41
Table of Contents
The following table presents the loss and LAE recorded in the consolidated statements of operations by sector for insurance contracts. Amounts presented are net of reinsurance.
Loss and LAE
Reported on the
Consolidated Statements of Operations
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Public Finance:
U.S. public finance
$
97
$
13
Non-U.S. public finance
0
5
Public finance
97
18
Structured Finance:
U.S. RMBS:
First lien:
Prime first lien
0
0
Alt-A first lien
8
(2
)
Option ARM
(14
)
(1
)
Subprime
4
0
First lien
(2
)
(3
)
Second lien
13
10
Total U.S. RMBS
11
7
Triple-X life insurance transactions
3
6
Student loans
(14
)
(6
)
Other structured finance
0
(2
)
Structured finance
0
5
Loss and LAE on insurance contracts before FG VIE consolidation
97
23
Effect of consolidating FG VIEs
(7
)
(5
)
Loss and LAE
$
90
$
18
42
Table of Contents
The following table provides information on financial guaranty insurance contracts categorized as BIG.
Financial Guaranty Insurance
BIG Transaction Loss Summary
As of
March 31, 2016
BIG Categories
BIG 1
BIG 2
BIG 3
Total
BIG, Net
Effect of
Consolidating
FG VIEs
Total
Gross
Ceded
Gross
Ceded
Gross
Ceded
(dollars in millions)
Number of risks(1)
202
(43
)
86
(14
)
129
(45
)
417
—
417
Remaining weighted-average contract period (in years)
10.1
7.4
13.1
10.4
7.2
5.4
10.6
—
10.6
Outstanding exposure:
Principal
$
7,084
$
(499
)
$
4,461
$
(446
)
$
3,145
$
(207
)
$
13,538
$
—
$
13,538
Interest
3,764
(214
)
3,058
(233
)
962
(44
)
7,293
—
7,293
Total(2)
$
10,848
$
(713
)
$
7,519
$
(679
)
$
4,107
$
(251
)
$
20,831
$
—
$
20,831
Expected cash outflows (inflows)
$
337
$
(28
)
$
1,418
$
(77
)
$
1,372
$
(58
)
$
2,964
$
(345
)
$
2,619
Potential recoveries
Undiscounted R&W
97
(2
)
(42
)
1
(88
)
5
(29
)
6
(23
)
Other(3)
(590
)
16
(250
)
10
(631
)
25
(1,420
)
190
(1,230
)
Total potential recoveries
(493
)
14
(292
)
11
(719
)
30
(1,449
)
196
(1,253
)
Subtotal
(156
)
(14
)
1,126
(66
)
653
(28
)
1,515
(149
)
1,366
Discount
153
(3
)
(288
)
14
29
(94
)
(189
)
33
(156
)
Present value of expected cash flows
$
(3
)
$
(17
)
$
838
$
(52
)
$
682
$
(122
)
$
1,326
$
(116
)
$
1,210
Deferred premium revenue
$
280
$
(10
)
$
156
$
(7
)
$
380
$
(33
)
$
766
$
(96
)
$
670
Reserves (salvage)
$
(96
)
$
(12
)
$
717
$
(47
)
$
352
$
(8
)
$
906
$
(71
)
$
835
43
Table of Contents
Financial Guaranty Insurance
BIG Transaction Loss Summary
As of
December 31, 2015
BIG Categories
BIG 1
BIG 2
BIG 3
Total
BIG, Net
Effect of
Consolidating
FG VIEs
Total
Gross
Ceded
Gross
Ceded
Gross
Ceded
(dollars in millions)
Number of risks(1)
202
(46
)
85
(13
)
132
(44
)
419
—
419
Remaining weighted-average contract period (in years)
10.0
8.7
13.8
9.5
7.7
5.9
10.7
—
10.7
Outstanding exposure:
Principal
$
7,751
$
(732
)
$
3,895
$
(240
)
$
3,087
$
(187
)
$
13,574
$
—
$
13,574
Interest
4,109
(354
)
2,805
(110
)
1,011
(42
)
7,419
—
7,419
Total(2)
$
11,860
$
(1,086
)
$
6,700
$
(350
)
$
4,098
$
(229
)
$
20,993
$
—
$
20,993
Expected cash outflows (inflows)
$
386
$
(42
)
$
1,158
$
(60
)
$
1,464
$
(53
)
$
2,853
$
(343
)
$
2,510
Potential recoveries
Undiscounted R&W
69
(2
)
(49
)
1
(85
)
5
(61
)
7
(54
)
Other(3)
(441
)
14
(118
)
7
(587
)
19
(1,106
)
175
(931
)
Total potential recoveries
(372
)
12
(167
)
8
(672
)
24
(1,167
)
182
(985
)
Subtotal
14
(30
)
991
(52
)
792
(29
)
1,686
(161
)
1,525
Discount
91
3
(286
)
12
(58
)
(89
)
(327
)
41
(286
)
Present value of expected cash flows
$
105
$
(27
)
$
705
$
(40
)
$
734
$
(118
)
$
1,359
$
(120
)
$
1,239
Deferred premium revenue
$
371
$
(37
)
$
150
$
(4
)
$
386
$
(32
)
$
834
$
(100
)
$
734
Reserves (salvage)
$
2
$
(19
)
$
591
$
(38
)
$
404
$
(9
)
$
931
$
(74
)
$
857
____________________
(1)
A risk represents the aggregate of the financial guaranty policies that share the same revenue source for purposes of making Debt Service payments. The ceded number of risks represents the number of risks for which the Company ceded a portion of its exposure.
(2)
Includes BIG amounts related to FG VIEs.
(3)
Includes excess spread.
Ratings Impact on Financial Guaranty Business
A downgrade of one of AGL’s insurance subsidiaries may result in increased claims under financial guaranties issued by the Company, if the insured obligors were unable to pay.
For example, AGM has issued financial guaranty insurance policies in respect of the obligations of municipal obligors under interest rate swaps. AGM insures periodic payments owed by the municipal obligors to the bank counterparties. In certain cases, AGM also insures termination payments that may be owed by the municipal obligors to the bank counterparties. If (i) AGM has been downgraded below the rating trigger set forth in a swap under which it has insured the termination payment, which rating trigger varies on a transaction by transaction basis; (ii) the municipal obligor has the right to cure by, but has failed in, posting collateral, replacing AGM or otherwise curing the downgrade of AGM; (iii) the transaction documents include as a condition that an event of default or termination event with respect to the municipal obligor has occurred, such as the rating of the municipal obligor being downgraded past a specified level, and such condition has been met; (iv) the bank counterparty has elected to terminate the swap; (v) a termination payment is payable by the municipal obligor; and (vi) the municipal obligor has failed to make the termination payment payable by it, then AGM would be required to pay the termination payment due by the municipal obligor, in an amount not to exceed the policy limit set forth in the financial guaranty insurance policy. At AGM's current financial strength ratings, if the conditions giving rise to the obligation of AGM to make a termination payment under the swap termination policies were all satisfied, then AGM could pay claims in an amount not exceeding approximately
$176 million
in respect of such termination payments. Taking into consideration whether the
44
Table of Contents
rating of the municipal obligor is below any applicable specified trigger, if the financial strength ratings of AGM were further downgraded below "A" by S&P or below "A2" by Moody's, and the conditions giving rise to the obligation of AGM to make a payment under the swap policies were all satisfied, then AGM could pay claims in an additional amount not exceeding approximately
$430 million
in respect of such termination payments.
As another example, with respect to variable rate demand obligations ("VRDOs") for which a bank has agreed to provide a liquidity facility, a downgrade of AGM or AGC may provide the bank with the right to give notice to bondholders that the bank will terminate the liquidity facility, causing the bondholders to tender their bonds to the bank. Bonds held by the bank accrue interest at a “bank bond rate” that is higher than the rate otherwise borne by the bond (typically the
prime rate
plus
2.00%
—
3.00%
, and capped at the lesser of
25%
and the maximum legal limit). In the event the bank holds such bonds for longer than a specified period of time, usually
90
-
180 days
, the bank has the right to demand accelerated repayment of bond principal, usually through payment of equal installments over a period of not less than five years. In the event that a municipal obligor is unable to pay interest accruing at the bank bond rate or to pay principal during the shortened amortization period, a claim could be submitted to AGM or AGC under its financial guaranty policy. As of
March 31, 2016
, AGM and AGC had insured approximately
$5.5 billion
net par of VRDOs, of which approximately
$0.3 billion
of net par constituted VRDOs issued by municipal obligors rated BBB- or lower pursuant to the Company’s internal rating. The specific terms relating to the rating levels that trigger the bank’s termination right, and whether it is triggered by a downgrade by one rating agency or a downgrade by all rating agencies then rating the insurer, vary depending on the transaction.
In addition, AGM may be required to pay claims in respect of AGMH’s former financial products business if Dexia SA and its affiliates, from which the Company had purchased AGMH and its subsidiaries, do not comply with their obligations following a downgrade of the financial strength rating of AGM. Most of the guaranteed investment contracts ("GICs") insured by AGM allow the GIC holder to terminate the GIC and withdraw the funds in the event of a downgrade of AGM below A3 or A-, with no right of the GIC issuer to avoid such withdrawal by posting collateral or otherwise enhancing its credit. Each GIC contract stipulates the thresholds below which the GIC issuer must post eligible collateral, along with the types of securities eligible for posting and the collateralization percentage applicable to each security type. These collateralization percentages range from
100%
of the GIC balance for cash posted as collateral to, typically,
108%
for asset-backed securities. If the entire aggregate accreted GIC balance of approximately
$1.7 billion
as of
March 31, 2016
were terminated, the assets of the GIC issuers (which had an aggregate market value which exceed the liabilities by
$0.8 billion
) would be sufficient to fund the withdrawal of the GIC funds.
7.
Fair Value Measurement
The Company carries a significant portion of its assets and liabilities at fair value. Fair value is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date (i.e., exit price). The price represents the price available in the principal market for the asset or liability. If there is no principal market, then the price is based on a hypothetical market that maximizes the value received for an asset or minimizes the amount paid for a liability (i.e., the most advantageous market).
Fair value is based on quoted market prices, where available. If listed prices or quotes are not available, fair value is based on either internally developed models that primarily use, as inputs, market-based or independently sourced market parameters, including but not limited to yield curves, interest rates and debt prices or with the assistance of an independent third-party using a discounted cash flow approach and the third party’s proprietary pricing models. In addition to market information, models also incorporate transaction details, such as maturity of the instrument and contractual features designed to reduce the Company’s credit exposure, such as collateral rights as applicable.
Valuation adjustments may be made to ensure that financial instruments are recorded at fair value. These adjustments include amounts to reflect counterparty credit quality, the Company’s creditworthiness and constraints on liquidity. As markets and products develop and the pricing for certain products becomes more or less transparent, the Company may refine its methodologies and assumptions. During
First Quarter 2016
, no changes were made to the Company’s valuation models that had or are expected to have, a material impact on the Company’s consolidated balance sheets or statements of operations and comprehensive income.
The Company’s methods for calculating fair value produce a fair value that may not be indicative of net realizable value or reflective of future fair values. The use of different methodologies or assumptions to determine fair value of certain financial instruments could result in a different estimate of fair value at the reporting date.
The categorization within the fair value hierarchy is determined based on whether the inputs to valuation techniques used to measure fair value are observable or unobservable. Observable inputs reflect market data obtained from independent
45
Table of Contents
sources, while unobservable inputs reflect Company estimates of market assumptions. The fair value hierarchy prioritizes model inputs into three broad levels as follows, with Level 1 being the highest and Level 3 the lowest. An asset or liability’s categorization is based on the lowest level of significant input to its valuation.
Level 1—Quoted prices for identical instruments in active markets. The Company generally defines an active market as a market in which trading occurs at significant volumes. Active markets generally are more liquid and have a lower bid-ask spread than an inactive market.
Level 2—Quoted prices for similar instruments in active markets; quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active; and observable inputs other than quoted prices, such as interest rates or yield curves and other inputs derived from or corroborated by observable market inputs.
Level 3—Model derived valuations in which one or more significant inputs or significant value drivers are unobservable. Financial instruments are considered Level 3 when their values are determined using pricing models, discounted cash flow methodologies or similar techniques and at least one significant model assumption or input is unobservable. Level 3 financial instruments also include those for which the determination of fair value requires significant management judgment or estimation.
Transfers between Levels 1, 2 and 3 are recognized at the end of the period when the transfer occurs. The Company reviews the classification between Levels 1, 2 and 3 quarterly to determine whether a transfer is necessary. During the periods presented, there were no transfers between Level 1, 2 and 3.
Measured and Carried at Fair Value
Fixed-Maturity Securities and Short-Term Investments
The fair value of bonds in the investment portfolio is generally based on prices received from third party pricing services or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency. The pricing services prepare estimates of fair value measurements using their pricing models, which include available relevant market information, benchmark curves, benchmarking of like securities, and sector groupings. Additional valuation factors that can be taken into account are nominal spreads and liquidity adjustments. The pricing services evaluate each asset class based on relevant market and credit information, perceived market movements, and sector news. The market inputs used in the pricing evaluation include: benchmark yields, reported trades, broker/dealer quotes, issuer spreads, two-sided markets, benchmark securities, bids, offers, reference data and industry and economic events. Benchmark yields have in many cases taken priority over reported trades for securities that trade less frequently or those that are distressed trades, and therefore may not be indicative of the market. The extent of the use of each input is dependent on the asset class and the market conditions. Given the asset class, the priority of the use of inputs may change or some market inputs may not be relevant. Additionally, the valuation of fixed-maturity investments is more subjective when markets are less liquid due to the lack of market based inputs, which may increase the potential that the estimated fair value of an investment is not reflective of the price at which an actual transaction would occur.
Short-term investments, that are traded in active markets, are classified within Level 1 in the fair value hierarchy and their value is based on quoted market prices. Securities such as discount notes are classified within Level 2 because these securities are typically not actively traded due to their approaching maturity and, as such, their cost approximates fair value. Short term securities that were obtained as part of loss mitigation efforts and whose prices were determined based on models, where at least one significant model assumption or input is unobservable, are considered to be Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy.
Annually, the Company reviews each pricing service’s procedures, controls and models used in the valuations of the Company’s investment portfolio, as well as the competency of the pricing service’s key personnel. In addition, on a quarterly basis, the Company holds a meeting of the internal valuation committee (comprised of individuals within the Company with market, valuation, accounting, and/or finance experience) that reviews and approves prices and assumptions used by the pricing services.
For Level 1 and 2 securities, the Company, on a quarterly basis, reviews internally developed analytic packages that highlight, at a CUSIP level, price changes from the previous quarter to the current quarter. Where unexpected price movements are noted for a specific CUSIP, the Company formally challenges the price provided, and reviews all key inputs utilized in the third party’s pricing model, and compares such information to management’s own market information.
46
Table of Contents
For Level 3 securities, the Company, on a quarterly basis:
•
reviews methodologies, any model updates and inputs and compares such information to management’s own market information and, where applicable, the internal models,
•
reviews internally developed analytic packages that highlight, at a CUSIP level, price changes from the previous quarter to the current quarter, and evaluates, documents, and resolves any significant pricing differences with the assistance of the third party pricing source, and
•
compares prices received from different third party pricing sources, and evaluates, documents the rationale for, and resolves any significant pricing differences.
As of
March 31, 2016
, the Company used models to price
36
fixed-maturity securities (which were purchased or obtained for loss mitigation or other risk management purposes), which were
9.8%
or
$1,080 million
of the Company’s fixed-maturity securities and short-term investments at fair value. Most Level 3 securities were priced with the assistance of an independent third-party. The pricing is based on a discounted cash flow approach using the third-party’s proprietary pricing models. The models use inputs such as projected prepayment speeds; severity assumptions; recovery lag assumptions; estimated default rates (determined on the basis of an analysis of collateral attributes, historical collateral performance, borrower profiles and other features relevant to the evaluation of collateral credit quality); home price depreciation/appreciation rates based on macroeconomic forecasts and recent trading activity. The yield used to discount the projected cash flows is determined by reviewing various attributes of the bond including collateral type, weighted average life, sensitivity to losses, vintage, and convexity, in conjunction with market data on comparable securities. Significant changes to any of these inputs could materially change the expected timing of cash flows within these securities which is a significant factor in determining the fair value of the securities.
Other Invested Assets
As of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, other invested assets include investments carried and measured at fair value on a recurring basis of
$53 million
and
$53 million
, respectively, and include primarily an investment in the global property catastrophe risk market and an investment in a fund that invests primarily in senior loans and bonds. Fair values for the majority of these investments are based on their respective net asset value ("NAV") per share or equivalent. Other invested assets also include fixed-maturity securities classified as trading carried as Level 2.
Other Assets
Committed Capital Securities
The fair value of committed capital securities ("CCS"), which is recorded in "other assets" on the consolidated balance sheets, represents the difference between the present value of remaining expected put option premium payments under AGC’s CCS (the “AGC CCS”) and AGM’s Committed Preferred Trust Securities (the “AGM CPS”) agreements, and the estimated present value that the Company would hypothetically have to pay currently for a comparable security (see Note 15, Long Term Debt and Credit Facilities). The AGC CCS and AGM CPS are carried at fair value with changes in fair value recorded in the consolidated statement of operations. The estimated current cost of the Company’s CCS is based on several factors, including broker-dealer quotes for the outstanding securities, AGM and AGC CDS spreads, the U.S. dollar forward swap curve, London Interbank Offered Rate ("LIBOR") curve projections and the term the securities are estimated to remain outstanding.
Supplemental Executive Retirement Plans
The Company classifies the fair value measurement of the assets of the Company's various supplemental executive retirement plans as either Level 1 or Level 2. The fair value of these assets is valued based on the observable published daily values of the underlying mutual fund included in the aforementioned plans (Level 1) or based upon the NAV of the funds if a published daily value is not available (Level 2). The NAV are based on observable information.
47
Table of Contents
Financial Guaranty Contracts Accounted for as Credit Derivatives
The Company’s credit derivatives consist primarily of insured CDS contracts, and also include interest rate swaps and hedges on other financial guarantors that fall under derivative accounting standards requiring fair value accounting through the statement of operations. The following is a description of the fair value methodology applied to the Company's insured credit default swaps that are accounted for as credit derivatives, which constitute the vast majority of the net credit derivative liability in the consolidated balance sheets. The Company did not enter into CDS with the intent to trade these contracts and the Company may not unilaterally terminate a CDS contract absent an event of default or termination event that entitles the Company to terminate such contracts; however, the Company has mutually agreed with various counterparties to terminate certain CDS transactions. Such terminations generally are not completed at fair value but instead for an amount that approximates the present value of future premiums or for a negotiated amount.
The terms of the Company’s CDS contracts differ from more standardized credit derivative contracts sold by companies outside the financial guaranty industry. The non-standard terms include the absence of collateral support agreements or immediate settlement provisions. In addition, the Company employs relatively high attachment points and does not exit derivatives it sells or purchases for credit protection purposes, except under specific circumstances such as mutual agreements with counterparties. Management considers the non-standard terms of its credit derivative contracts in determining the fair value of these contracts.
Due to the lack of quoted prices and other observable inputs for its instruments or for similar instruments, the Company determines the fair value of its credit derivative contracts primarily through internally developed, proprietary models that use both observable and unobservable market data inputs to derive an estimate of the fair value of the Company's contracts in its principal markets (see "Assumptions and Inputs"). There is no established market where financial guaranty insured credit derivatives are actively traded, therefore, management has determined that the exit market for the Company’s credit derivatives is a hypothetical one based on its entry market. Management has tracked the historical pricing of the Company’s deals to establish historical price points in the hypothetical market that are used in the fair value calculation. These contracts are classified as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy since there is reliance on at least one unobservable input deemed significant to the valuation model, most importantly the Company’s estimate of the value of the non-standard terms and conditions of its credit derivative contracts and of the Company’s current credit standing.
The Company’s models and the related assumptions are continuously reevaluated by management and enhanced, as appropriate, based upon improvements in modeling techniques and availability of more timely and relevant market information.
The fair value of the Company’s credit derivative contracts represents the difference between the present value of remaining premiums the Company expects to receive or pay and the estimated present value of premiums that a financial guarantor of comparable credit-worthiness would hypothetically charge or pay at the reporting date for the same protection. The fair value of the Company’s credit derivatives depends on a number of factors, including notional amount of the contract, expected term, credit spreads, changes in interest rates, the credit ratings of referenced entities, the Company’s own credit risk and remaining contractual cash flows. The expected remaining contractual premium cash flows are the most readily observable inputs since they are based on the CDS contractual terms. Credit spreads capture the effect of recovery rates and performance of underlying assets of these contracts, among other factors. Consistent with previous years, market conditions at
March 31, 2016
were such that market prices of the Company’s CDS contracts were not available.
Management considers factors such as current prices charged for similar agreements, when available, performance of underlying assets, life of the instrument, and the nature and extent of activity in the financial guaranty credit derivative marketplace. The assumptions that management uses to determine the fair value may change in the future due to market conditions. Due to the inherent uncertainties of the assumptions used in the valuation models, actual experience may differ from the estimates reflected in the Company’s consolidated financial statements and the differences may be material.
Assumptions and Inputs
The various inputs and assumptions that are key to the establishment of the Company’s fair value for CDS contracts are as follows:
•
Gross spread.
•
The allocation of gross spread among:
◦
the profit the originator, usually an investment bank, realizes for putting the deal together and funding the transaction (“bank profit”);
48
Table of Contents
◦
premiums paid to the Company for the Company’s credit protection provided (“net spread”); and
◦
the cost of CDS protection purchased by the originator to hedge their counterparty credit risk exposure to the Company (“hedge cost”).
•
The weighted average life which is based on Debt Service schedules.
The rates used to discount future expected premium cash flows ranged from
0.44%
to
2.06%
at
March 31, 2016
and
0.44%
to
2.51%
at
December 31, 2015
.
The Company obtains gross spreads on its outstanding contracts from market data sources published by third parties (e.g., dealer spread tables for the collateral similar to assets within the Company’s transactions), as well as collateral-specific spreads provided by trustees or obtained from market sources. If observable market credit spreads are not available or reliable for the underlying reference obligations, then market indices are used that most closely resemble the underlying reference obligations, considering asset class, credit quality rating and maturity of the underlying reference obligations. These indices are adjusted to reflect the non-standard terms of the Company’s CDS contracts. Market sources determine credit spreads by reviewing new issuance pricing for specific asset classes and receiving price quotes from their trading desks for the specific asset in question. Management validates these quotes by cross-referencing quotes received from one market source against quotes received from another market source to ensure reasonableness. In addition, the Company compares the relative change in price quotes received from one quarter to another, with the relative change experienced by published market indices for a specific asset class. Collateral specific spreads obtained from third-party, independent market sources are un-published spread quotes from market participants or market traders who are not trustees. Management obtains this information as the result of direct communication with these sources as part of the valuation process.
With respect to CDS transactions for which there is an expected claim payment within the next twelve months, the allocation of gross spread reflects a higher allocation to the cost of credit rather than the bank profit component. In the current market, it is assumed that a bank would be willing to accept a lower profit on distressed transactions in order to remove these transactions from its financial statements.
The following spread hierarchy is utilized in determining which source of gross spread to use, with the rule being to use CDS spreads where available. If not available, CDS spreads are either interpolated or extrapolated based on similar transactions or market indices.
•
Actual collateral specific credit spreads (if up-to-date and reliable market-based spreads are available).
•
Deals priced or closed during a specific quarter within a specific asset class and specific rating. No transactions closed during the periods presented.
•
Credit spreads interpolated based upon market indices.
•
Credit spreads provided by the counterparty of the CDS.
•
Credit spreads extrapolated based upon transactions of similar asset classes, similar ratings, and similar time to maturity.
Information by Credit Spread Type (1)
As of
March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
Based on actual collateral specific spreads
14
%
13
%
Based on market indices
72
%
73
%
Provided by the CDS counterparty
14
%
14
%
Total
100
%
100
%
____________________
(1) Based on par.
49
Table of Contents
Over time the data inputs can change as new sources become available or existing sources are discontinued or are no longer considered to be the most appropriate. It is the Company’s objective to move to higher levels on the hierarchy whenever possible, but it is sometimes necessary to move to lower priority inputs because of discontinued data sources or management’s assessment that the higher priority inputs are no longer considered to be representative of market spreads for a given type of collateral. This can happen, for example, if transaction volume changes such that a previously used spread index is no longer viewed as being reflective of current market levels.
The Company interpolates a curve based on the historical relationship between the premium the Company receives when a credit derivative is closed to the daily closing price of the market index related to the specific asset class and rating of the deal. This curve indicates expected credit spreads at each indicative level on the related market index. For transactions with unique terms or characteristics where no price quotes are available, management extrapolates credit spreads based on a similar transaction for which the Company has received a spread quote from one of the first
three
sources within the Company’s spread hierarchy. This alternative transaction will be within the same asset class, have similar underlying assets, similar credit ratings, and similar time to maturity. The Company then calculates the percentage of relative spread change quarter over quarter for the alternative transaction. This percentage change is then applied to the historical credit spread of the transaction for which no price quote was received in order to calculate the transactions’ current spread. Counterparties determine credit spreads by reviewing new issuance pricing for specific asset classes and receiving price quotes from their trading desks for the specific asset in question. These quotes are validated by cross-referencing quotes received from one market source with those quotes received from another market source to ensure reasonableness.
The premium the Company receives is referred to as the “net spread.” The Company’s pricing model takes into account not only how credit spreads on risks that it assumes affect pricing, but also how the Company’s own credit spread affects the pricing of its deals. The Company’s own credit risk is factored into the determination of net spread based on the impact of changes in the quoted market price for credit protection bought on the Company, as reflected by quoted market prices on CDS referencing AGC or AGM. For credit spreads on the Company’s name the Company obtains the quoted price of CDS contracts traded on AGC and AGM from market data sources published by third parties. The cost to acquire CDS protection referencing AGC or AGM affects the amount of spread on CDS deals that the Company retains and, hence, their fair value. As the cost to acquire CDS protection referencing AGC or AGM increases, the amount of premium the Company retains on a deal generally decreases. As the cost to acquire CDS protection referencing AGC or AGM decreases, the amount of premium the Company retains on a deal generally increases. In the Company’s valuation model, the premium the Company captures is not permitted to go below the minimum rate that the Company would currently charge to assume similar risks. This assumption can have the effect of mitigating the amount of unrealized gains that are recognized on certain CDS contracts. Given the current market conditions and the Company’s own credit spreads, approximately
18%
a
nd
20%
based on number of deals, of the Company's CDS contracts are fair valued using this minimum premium as of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, respectively. The percentage of deals that price using the minimum premiums fluctuates due to changes in AGM's and AGC's credit spreads. In general when AGM's and AGC's credit spreads narrow, the cost to hedge AGM's and AGC's name declines and more transactions price above previously established floor levels. Meanwhile, when AGM's and AGC's credit spreads widen, the cost to hedge AGM's and AGC's name increases causing more transactions to price at previously established floor levels. The Company corroborates the assumptions in its fair value model, including the portion of exposure to AGC and AGM hedged by its counterparties, with independent third parties each reporting period. The current level of AGC’s and AGM’s own credit spread has resulted in the bank or deal originator hedging a significant portion of its exposure to AGC and AGM. This reduces the amount of contractual cash flows AGC and AGM can capture as premium for selling its protection.
The amount of premium a financial guaranty insurance market participant can demand is inversely related to the cost of credit protection on the insurance company as measured by market credit spreads assuming all other assumptions remain constant. This is because the buyers of credit protection typically hedge a portion of their risk to the financial guarantor, due to the fact that the contractual terms of the Company's contracts typically do not require the posting of collateral by the guarantor. The extent of the hedge depends on the types of instruments insured and the current market conditions.
A fair value resulting in a credit derivative asset on protection sold is the result of contractual cash inflows on in-force deals in excess of what a hypothetical financial guarantor could receive if it sold protection on the same risk as of the reporting date. If the Company were able to freely exchange these contracts (i.e., assuming its contracts did not contain proscriptions on transfer and there was a viable exchange market), it would be able to realize a gain representing the difference between the higher contractual premiums to which it is entitled and the current market premiums for a similar contract. The Company determines the fair value of its CDS contracts by applying the difference between the current net spread and the contractual net spread for the remaining duration of each contract to the notional value of its CDS contracts and taking the present value of such amounts discounted at the corresponding LIBOR over the weighted average remaining life of the contract.
50
Table of Contents
Example
The following is an example of how changes in gross spreads, the Company’s own credit spread and the cost to buy protection on the Company affect the amount of premium the Company can demand for its credit protection. The assumptions used in these examples are hypothetical amounts. Scenario 1 represents the market conditions in effect on the transaction date and Scenario 2 represents market conditions at a subsequent reporting date.
Scenario 1
Scenario 2
bps
% of Total
bps
% of Total
Original gross spread/cash bond price (in bps)
185
500
Bank profit (in bps)
115
62
%
50
10
%
Hedge cost (in bps)
30
16
%
440
88
%
The premium the Company receives per annum (in bps)
40
22
%
10
2
%
In Scenario 1, the gross spread is
185
basis points. The bank or deal originator captures
115
basis points of the original gross spread and hedges
10%
of its exposure to AGC, when the CDS spread on AGC was
300
basis points (
300
basis points ×
10%
=
30
basis points). Under this scenario the Company receives premium of
40
basis points, or
22%
of the gross spread.
In Scenario 2, the gross spread is
500
basis points. The bank or deal originator captures
50
basis points of the original gross spread and hedges
25%
of its exposure to AGC, when the CDS spread on AGC was
1,760
basis points (
1,760
basis points ×
25%
=
440
basis points). Under this scenario the Company would receive premium of
10
basis points, or
2%
of the gross spread. Due to the increased cost to hedge AGC’s name, the amount of profit the bank would expect to receive, and the premium the Company would expect to receive decline significantly.
In this example, the contractual cash flows (the Company premium received per annum above) exceed the amount a market participant would require the Company to pay in today’s market to accept its obligations under the CDS contract, thus resulting in an asset.
Strengths and Weaknesses of Model
The Company’s credit derivative valuation model, like any financial model, has certain strengths and weaknesses.
The primary strengths of the Company’s CDS modeling techniques are:
•
The model takes into account the transaction structure and the key drivers of market value. The transaction structure includes par insured, weighted average life, level of subordination and composition of collateral.
•
The model maximizes the use of market-driven inputs whenever they are available. The key inputs to the model are market-based spreads for the collateral, and the credit rating of referenced entities. These are viewed by the Company to be the key parameters that affect fair value of the transaction.
•
The model is a consistent approach to valuing positions. The Company has developed a hierarchy for market-based spread inputs that helps mitigate the degree of subjectivity during periods of high illiquidity.
The primary weaknesses of the Company’s CDS modeling techniques are:
•
There is no exit market or actual exit transactions. Therefore the Company’s exit market is a hypothetical one based on the Company’s entry market.
•
There is a very limited market in which to validate the reasonableness of the fair values developed by the Company’s model.
•
The markets for the inputs to the model were highly illiquid, which impacts their reliability.
•
Due to the non-standard terms under which the Company enters into derivative contracts, the fair value of its credit derivatives may not reflect the same prices observed in an actively traded market of credit derivatives that do not contain terms and conditions similar to those observed in the financial guaranty market.
51
Table of Contents
These contracts were classified as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy because there is a reliance on at least one unobservable input deemed significant to the valuation model, most significantly the Company's estimate of the value of non-standard terms and conditions of its credit derivative contracts and amount of protection purchased on AGC or AGM's name.
Fair Value Option on FG VIEs’ Assets and Liabilities
The Company elected the fair value option for all the FG VIEs’ assets and liabilities. See Note 9, Consolidated Variable Interest Entities.
The FG VIEs issued securities collateralized by first lien and second lien RMBS as well as loans and receivables. The lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement of these assets and liabilities was a Level 3 input (i.e., unobservable), therefore management classified them as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy. Prices are generally determined with the assistance of an independent third-party, based on a discounted cash flow approach. The models to price the FG VIEs’ liabilities used, where appropriate, inputs such as estimated prepayment speeds; market values of the assets that collateralize the securities; estimated default rates (determined on the basis of an analysis of collateral attributes, historical collateral performance, borrower profiles and other features relevant to the evaluation of collateral credit quality); yields implied by market prices for similar securities; house price depreciation/appreciation rates based on macroeconomic forecasts and, for those liabilities insured by the Company, the benefit from the Company’s insurance policy guaranteeing the timely payment of principal and interest, taking into account the timing of the potential default and the Company’s own credit rating. The third-party also utilizes an internal model to determine an appropriate yield at which to discount the cash flows of the security, by factoring in collateral types, weighted-average lives, and other structural attributes specific to the security being priced. The expected yield is further calibrated by utilizing algorithms designed to aggregate market color, received by the third-party, on comparable bonds.
The fair value of the Company’s FG VIE assets is generally sensitive to changes related to estimated prepayment speeds; estimated default rates (determined on the basis of an analysis of collateral attributes such as: historical collateral performance, borrower profiles and other features relevant to the evaluation of collateral credit quality); discount rates implied by market prices for similar securities; and house price depreciation/appreciation rates based on macroeconomic forecasts. Significant changes to some of these inputs could materially change the market value of the FG VIE’s assets and the implied collateral losses within the transaction. In general, the fair value of the FG VIE asset is most sensitive to changes in the projected collateral losses, where an increase in collateral losses typically leads to a decrease in the fair value of FG VIE assets, while a decrease in collateral losses typically leads to an increase in the fair value of FG VIE assets. These factors also directly impact the fair value of the Company’s FG VIE liabilities.
The fair value of the Company’s FG VIE liabilities is generally sensitive to the various model inputs described above. In addition, the Company’s FG VIE liabilities with recourse are also sensitive to changes in the Company’s implied credit worthiness. Significant changes to any of these inputs could materially change the timing of expected losses within the insured transaction which is a significant factor in determining the implied benefit from the Company’s insurance policy guaranteeing the timely payment of principal and interest for the tranches of debt issued by the FG VIE that is insured by the Company. In general, extending the timing of expected loss payments by the Company into the future typically leads to a decrease in the value of the Company’s insurance and a decrease in the fair value of the Company’s FG VIE liabilities with recourse, while a shortening of the timing of expected loss payments by the Company typically leads to an increase in the value of the Company’s insurance and an increase in the fair value of the Company’s FG VIE liabilities with recourse.
Not Carried at Fair Value
Financial Guaranty Insurance Contracts
For financial guaranty insurance contracts that are acquired in a business combination, the Company measures each contract at fair value on the date of acquisition, and then follows insurance accounting guidance on a recurring basis thereafter. On a quarterly basis, the Company also discloses the fair value of its outstanding financial guaranty insurance contracts. In both cases, fair value is based on management’s estimate of what a similarly rated financial guaranty insurance company would demand to acquire the Company’s in-force book of financial guaranty insurance business. It is based on a variety of factors that may include pricing assumptions management has observed for portfolio transfers, commutations, and acquisitions that have occurred in the financial guaranty market, as well as prices observed in the credit derivative market with an adjustment for illiquidity so that the terms would be similar to a financial guaranty insurance contract, and includes adjustments to the carrying value of unearned premium reserve for stressed losses, ceding commissions and return on capital. The significant inputs were not readily observable. The Company accordingly classified this fair value measurement as Level 3.
52
Table of Contents
Long-Term Debt
The Company’s long-term debt, excluding notes payable, is valued by broker-dealers using third party independent pricing sources and standard market conventions. The market conventions utilize market quotations, market transactions for the Company’s comparable instruments, and to a lesser extent, similar instruments in the broader insurance industry. The fair value measurement was classified as Level 2 in the fair value hierarchy.
The fair value of the notes payable was determined by calculating the present value of the expected cash flows. The Company determines discounted future cash flows using market driven discount rates and a variety of assumptions, including a projection of the LIBOR rate, prepayment and default assumptions, and AGM CDS spreads. The fair value measurement was classified as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy because there is a reliance on significant unobservable inputs to the valuation model, including the discount rates, prepayment and default assumptions, loss severity and recovery on delinquent loans.
Other Invested Assets
The other invested assets not carried at fair value consist primarily of investments in a guaranteed investment contract for future claims payments. The fair value of the investments in the guaranteed investment contract approximated their carrying value due to their short term nature. The fair value measurement of the investments in the guaranteed investment contract was classified as Level 2 in the fair value hierarchy.
Other Assets and Other Liabilities
The Company’s other assets and other liabilities consist predominantly of accrued interest, receivables for securities sold and payables for securities purchased, the carrying values of which approximate fair value.
53
Table of Contents
Financial Instruments Carried at Fair Value
Amounts recorded at fair value in the Company’s financial statements are presented in the tables below.
Fair Value Hierarchy of Financial Instruments Carried at Fair Value
As of
March 31, 2016
Fair Value Hierarchy
Fair Value
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
(in millions)
Assets:
Investment portfolio, available-for-sale:
Fixed-maturity securities
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
$
5,776
$
—
$
5,769
$
7
U.S. government and agencies
405
—
405
—
Corporate securities
1,525
—
1,451
74
Mortgage-backed securities:
RMBS
1,239
—
879
360
CMBS
556
—
556
—
Asset-backed securities
811
—
172
639
Foreign government securities
276
—
276
—
Total fixed-maturity securities
10,588
—
9,508
1,080
Short-term investments
459
332
127
—
Other invested assets (1)
12
—
5
7
Credit derivative assets
55
—
—
55
FG VIEs’ assets, at fair value
1,191
—
—
1,191
Other assets
93
26
21
46
Total assets carried at fair value
$
12,398
$
358
$
9,661
$
2,379
Liabilities:
Credit derivative liabilities
$
489
$
—
$
—
$
489
FG VIEs’ liabilities with recourse, at fair value
1,165
—
—
1,165
FG VIEs’ liabilities without recourse, at fair value
119
—
—
119
Total liabilities carried at fair value
$
1,773
$
—
$
—
$
1,773
54
Table of Contents
Fair Value Hierarchy of Financial Instruments Carried at Fair Value
As of
December 31, 2015
Fair Value Hierarchy
Fair Value
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
(in millions)
Assets:
Investment portfolio, available-for-sale:
Fixed-maturity securities
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
$
5,841
$
—
$
5,833
$
8
U.S. government and agencies
400
—
400
—
Corporate securities
1,520
—
1,449
71
Mortgage-backed securities:
RMBS
1,245
—
897
348
CMBS
513
—
513
—
Asset-backed securities
825
—
168
657
Foreign government securities
283
—
283
—
Total fixed-maturity securities
10,627
—
9,543
1,084
Short-term investments
396
305
31
60
Other invested assets (1)
12
—
5
7
Credit derivative assets
81
—
—
81
FG VIEs’ assets, at fair value
1,261
—
—
1,261
Other assets
106
23
21
62
Total assets carried at fair value
$
12,483
$
328
$
9,600
$
2,555
Liabilities:
Credit derivative liabilities
$
446
$
—
$
—
$
446
FG VIEs’ liabilities with recourse, at fair value
1,225
—
—
1,225
FG VIEs’ liabilities without recourse, at fair value
124
—
—
124
Total liabilities carried at fair value
$
1,795
$
—
$
—
$
1,795
____________________
(1)
Excluded from the table above are investments funds of
$45 million
and
$45 million
as of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, respectively, measured using NAV per share. Includes Level 3 mortgage loans that are recorded at fair value on a non-recurring basis.
55
Table of Contents
Changes in Level 3 Fair Value Measurements
The table below presents a roll forward of the Company’s Level 3 financial instruments carried at fair value on a recurring basis during
First Quarter
2016
and
2015
.
Fair Value Level 3 Rollforward
Recurring Basis
First Quarter
2016
Fixed-Maturity Securities
Obligations
of State and
Political
Subdivisions
Corporate Securities
RMBS
Asset-
Backed
Securities
Short-Term Investments
FG VIEs’
Assets at
Fair
Value
Other
Assets (8)
Credit
Derivative
Asset
(Liability),
net(5)
FG VIEs' Liabilities
with
Recourse,
at Fair
Value
FG VIEs’ Liabilities
without
Recourse,
at Fair
Value
(in millions)
Fair value as of December 31, 2015
$
8
$
71
$
348
$
657
$
60
$
1,261
$
65
$
(365
)
$
(1,225
)
$
(124
)
Total pretax realized and unrealized gains/(losses) recorded in: (1)
Net income (loss)
0
(2
)
2
(2
)
(2
)
(2
)
1
(2
)
0
(2
)
(4
)
(3
)
(16
)
(4
)
(60
)
(6
)
21
(3
)
2
(3
)
Other comprehensive income (loss)
0
1
(5
)
(5
)
0
—
0
—
—
—
Purchases
—
—
34
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Settlements
(1
)
—
(15
)
(14
)
(60
)
(66
)
—
(9
)
39
3
FG VIE consolidations
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
FG VIE deconsolidations
—
—
0
—
—
0
—
—
0
—
Fair value as of
March 31, 2016
$
7
$
74
$
360
$
639
$
—
$
1,191
$
49
$
(434
)
$
(1,165
)
$
(119
)
Change in unrealized gains/(losses) related to financial instruments held as of March 31, 2016
$
0
$
1
$
(6
)
$
(5
)
$
—
$
4
$
(16
)
$
(79
)
$
21
$
1
56
Table of Contents
Fair Value Level 3 Rollforward
Recurring Basis
First Quarter
2015
Fixed-Maturity Securities
Obligations
of State and
Political
Subdivisions
Corporate Securities
RMBS
Asset-
Backed
Securities
FG VIEs’
Assets at
Fair
Value
Other
Assets (8)
Credit
Derivative
Asset
(Liability),
net(5)
FG VIEs' Liabilities
with
Recourse,
at Fair
Value
FG VIEs’ Liabilities
without
Recourse,
at Fair
Value
(in millions)
Fair value as of December 31, 2014
$
38
$
79
$
425
$
228
$
1,398
$
37
$
(895
)
$
(1,277
)
$
(142
)
Total pretax realized and unrealized gains/(losses) recorded in: (1)
Net income (loss)
3
(2
)
2
(2
)
9
(2
)
(2
)
(2
)
23
(3
)
2
(4
)
124
(6
)
93
(3
)
(5
)
(3
)
Other comprehensive income (loss)
(2
)
(2
)
5
1
—
1
—
—
—
Purchases
—
—
9
—
—
—
—
—
—
Settlements
(31
)
(7
)
—
(65
)
(1
)
(30
)
—
(11
)
37
2
FG VIE consolidations
—
—
—
—
104
—
—
(131
)
—
FG VIE deconsolidations
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Fair value as of
March 31, 2015
$
8
$
79
$
383
$
226
$
1,495
$
40
$
(782
)
$
(1,278
)
$
(145
)
Change in unrealized gains/(losses) related to financial instruments held as of March 31, 2015
$
0
$
(2
)
$
7
$
1
$
34
$
3
$
103
$
(6
)
$
(4
)
____________________
(1)
Realized and unrealized gains (losses) from changes in values of Level 3 financial instruments represent gains (losses) from changes in values of those financial instruments only for the periods in which the instruments were classified as Level 3.
(2)
Included in net realized investment gains (losses) and net investment income.
(3)
Included in fair value gains (losses) on FG VIEs.
(4)
Recorded in fair value gains (losses) on CCS, net investment income and other income.
(5)
Represents net position of credit derivatives. The consolidated balance sheet presents gross assets and liabilities based on net counterparty exposure.
(6)
Reported in net change in fair value of credit derivatives.
(7)
Primarily non-cash transaction.
(8)
Includes CCS and other invested assets.
57
Table of Contents
Level 3 Fair Value Disclosures
Quantitative Information About Level 3 Fair Value Inputs
At
March 31, 2016
Financial Instrument Description (1)
Fair Value at March 31, 2016 (in millions)
Significant Unobservable Inputs
Range
Weighted Average as a Percentage of Current Par Outstanding
Assets (2):
Fixed-maturity securities (3):
Corporate securities
$
74
Yield
20.2%
RMBS
360
CPR
1.0
%
-
9.8%
2.8%
CDR
4.8
%
-
12.8%
9.7%
Loss severity
65.0
%
-
100.0%
78.0%
Yield
3.9
%
-
8.9%
6.0%
Asset-backed securities:
Investor owned utility
71
Cash flow receipts
100.0%
Collateral recovery period
2.7 years
Discount factor
7.0%
Triple-X life insurance transactions
321
Yield
3.5
%
-
7.3%
4.9%
Collateralized debt obligations ("CDO")
247
Yield
15.0%
FG VIEs’ assets, at fair value
1,191
CPR
2.5
%
-
8.6%
5.1%
CDR
1.2
%
-
23.1%
5.6%
Loss severity
40.0
%
-
100.0%
86.8%
Yield
3.5
%
-
20.9%
6.8%
Other assets
46
Quotes from third party pricing
$
51
-
$54
$53
Term (years)
5 years
58
Table of Contents
Financial Instrument Description (1)
Fair Value at March 31, 2016 (in millions)
Significant Unobservable Inputs
Range
Weighted Average as a Percentage of Current Par Outstanding
Liabilities:
Credit derivative liabilities, net
(434
)
Year 1 loss estimates
0.0
%
-
41.0%
0.8%
Hedge cost (in bps)
25.5
-
231.8
52.8
Bank profit (in bps)
3.8
-
1,544.4
112.3
Internal floor (in bps)
7.0
-
100.0
18.2
Internal credit rating
AAA
-
CCC
AA+
FG VIEs’ liabilities, at fair value
(1,284
)
CPR
2.5
%
-
8.6%
5.1%
CDR
1.2
%
-
23.1%
5.6%
Loss severity
40.0
%
-
100.0%
86.8%
Yield
3.5
%
-
20.9%
5.9%
___________________
(1)
Discounted cash flow is used as valuation technique for all financial instruments.
(2)
Excludes several investments recorded in other invested assets with fair value of
$7 million
.
(3)
Excludes obligations of state and political subdivisions investments with fair value of
$7 million
.
59
Table of Contents
Quantitative Information About Level 3 Fair Value Inputs
At
December 31, 2015
Financial Instrument Description (1)
Fair Value at
December 31, 2015
(in millions)
Significant Unobservable Inputs
Range
Weighted Average as a Percentage of Current Par Outstanding
Assets (2):
Fixed-maturity securities (3):
Corporate securities
71
Yield
21.8%
RMBS
348
CPR
0.3
%
-
9.0%
2.6%
CDR
2.7
%
-
9.3%
7.0%
Loss severity
60.0
%
-
100.0%
74.0%
Yield
4.7
%
-
8.2%
6.0%
Asset-backed securities:
Investor owned utility
69
Cash flow receipts
100.0%
Collateral recovery period
2.9 years
Discount factor
7.0%
Triple-X life insurance transactions
329
Yield
3.5
%
-
7.5%
5.0%
CDO
259
Yield
20.0%
Short-term investments
60
Yield
17.0%
FG VIEs’ assets, at fair value
1,261
CPR
0.3
%
-
9.2%
3.9%
CDR
1.2
%
-
16.0%
4.7%
Loss severity
40.0
%
-
100.0%
85.9%
Yield
1.9
%
-
20.0%
6.4%
Other assets
62
Quotes from third party pricing
$44
-
$46
$45
Term (years)
5 years
60
Table of Contents
Financial Instrument Description (1)
Fair Value at
December 31, 2015
(in millions)
Significant Unobservable Inputs
Range
Weighted Average as a Percentage of Current Par Outstanding
Liabilities:
Credit derivative liabilities, net
(365
)
Year 1 loss estimates
0.0
%
-
41.0%
0.6%
Hedge cost (in bps)
32.8
-
282.0
66.3
Bank profit (in bps)
3.8
-
1,017.5
110.8
Internal floor (in bps)
7.0
-
100.0
16.8
Internal credit rating
AAA
-
CCC
AA+
FG VIEs’ liabilities, at fair value
(1,349
)
CPR
0.3
%
-
9.2%
3.9%
CDR
1.2
%
-
16.0%
4.7%
Loss severity
40.0
%
-
100.0%
85.9%
Yield
1.9
%
-
20.0%
5.6%
____________________
(1)
Discounted cash flow is used as valuation technique for all financial instruments.
(2)
Excludes several investments recorded in other invested assets with fair value of
$7 million
.
(3)
Excludes obligations of state and political subdivisions investments with fair value of
$8 million
.
The carrying amount and estimated fair value of the Company’s financial instruments are presented in the following table.
Fair Value of Financial Instruments
As of
March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
Carrying
Amount
Estimated
Fair Value
Carrying
Amount
Estimated
Fair Value
(in millions)
Assets:
Fixed-maturity securities
$
10,588
$
10,588
$
10,627
$
10,627
Short-term investments
459
459
396
396
Other invested assets (1)
150
152
150
152
Credit derivative assets
55
55
81
81
FG VIEs’ assets, at fair value
1,191
1,191
1,261
1,261
Other assets
211
211
206
206
Liabilities:
Financial guaranty insurance contracts (2)
3,804
9,500
3,998
8,712
Long-term debt
1,302
1,500
1,300
1,512
Credit derivative liabilities
489
489
446
446
FG VIEs’ liabilities with recourse, at fair value
1,165
1,165
1,225
1,225
FG VIEs’ liabilities without recourse, at fair value
119
119
124
124
Other liabilities
73
73
9
9
____________________
(1)
Includes investments not carried at fair value with a carrying value of
$93 million
and
$93 million
as of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, respectively. Excludes investments carried under the equity method.
(2)
Carrying amount includes the assets and liabilities related to financial guaranty insurance contract premiums, losses, and salvage and subrogation and other recoverables net of reinsurance.
61
Table of Contents
8.
Financial Guaranty Contracts Accounted for as Credit Derivatives
The Company has a portfolio of financial guaranty contracts that meet the definition of a derivative in accordance with GAAP (primarily CDS).
Credit derivative transactions are governed by ISDA documentation and have different characteristics from financial guaranty insurance contracts. For example, the Company’s control rights with respect to a reference obligation under a credit derivative may be more limited than when the Company issues a financial guaranty insurance contract. In addition, there are more circumstances under which the Company may be obligated to make payments. Similar to a financial guaranty insurance contract, the Company would be obligated to pay if the obligor failed to make a scheduled payment of principal or interest in full. However, the Company may also be required to pay if the obligor becomes bankrupt or if the reference obligation were restructured if, after negotiation, those credit events are specified in the documentation for the credit derivative transactions. Furthermore, the Company may be required to make a payment due to an event that is unrelated to the performance of the obligation referenced in the credit derivative. If events of default or termination events specified in the credit derivative documentation were to occur, the non-defaulting or the non-affected party, which may be either the Company or the counterparty, depending upon the circumstances, may decide to terminate a credit derivative prior to maturity. In that case, the Company may be required to make a termination payment to its swap counterparty upon such termination. The Company may not unilaterally terminate a CDS contract; however, the Company on occasion has mutually agreed with various counterparties to terminate certain CDS transactions.
62
Table of Contents
Credit Derivative Net Par Outstanding by Sector
The estimated remaining weighted average life of credit derivatives was
5.0
years at
March 31, 2016
and
5.4
years at
December 31, 2015
. The components of the Company’s credit derivative net par outstanding are presented below.
Credit Derivatives
Subordination and Ratings
As of March 31, 2016
As of December 31, 2015
Asset Type
Net Par
Outstanding
Original
Subordination(1)
Current
Subordination(1)
Weighted
Average
Credit
Rating
Net Par
Outstanding
Original
Subordination(1)
Current
Subordination(1)
Weighted
Average
Credit
Rating
(dollars in millions)
Pooled corporate obligations:
Collateralized loan obligation/collateral bond obligations
$
5,197
30.7
%
42.8
%
AAA
$
5,873
30.9
%
42.3
%
AAA
Synthetic investment grade pooled corporate
7,127
21.7
19.4
AAA
7,108
21.7
19.4
AAA
TruPS CDOs
3,394
45.6
42.9
A-
3,429
45.8
42.6
A-
Market value CDOs of corporate obligations
1,113
17.0
27.8
AAA
1,113
17.0
30.1
AAA
Total pooled corporate obligations
16,831
29.0
31.9
AAA
17,523
29.2
32.3
AAA
U.S. RMBS:
Option ARM and Alt-A first lien
336
10.5
12.8
AA-
351
10.5
12.7
AA-
Subprime first lien
951
27.7
45.0
AA
981
27.7
45.2
AA
Prime first lien
169
10.9
0.0
BB
177
10.9
0.0
BB
Closed-end second lien
16
—
—
CCC
17
—
—
CCC
Total U.S. RMBS
1,472
24.1
37.3
A+
1,526
24.1
37.4
A+
CMBS
496
44.7
53.8
AAA
530
44.8
52.6
AAA
Other
6,067
—
—
A
6,015
—
—
A
Total
$
24,866
AA+
$
25,594
AA+
____________________
(1)
Represents the sum of subordinate tranches and over-collateralization and does not include any benefit from excess interest collections that may be used to absorb losses.
Except for TruPS CDOs, the Company’s exposure to pooled corporate obligations is highly diversified in terms of obligors and industries. Most pooled corporate transactions are structured to limit exposure to any given obligor and industry. The majority of the Company’s pooled corporate exposure consists of collateralized loan obligation ("CLO") or synthetic pooled corporate obligations. Most of these CLOs have an average obligor size of less than
1%
of the total transaction and typically restrict the maximum exposure to any one industry to approximately
10%
. The Company’s exposure also benefits from embedded credit enhancement in the transactions which allows a transaction to sustain a certain level of losses in the underlying collateral, further insulating the Company from industry specific concentrations of credit risk on these deals.
The Company’s TruPS CDO asset pools are generally less diversified by obligors and industries than the typical CLO asset pool. Also, the underlying collateral in TruPS CDOs consists primarily of subordinated debt instruments such as TruPS issued by bank holding companies and similar instruments issued by insurance companies, real estate investment trusts and other real estate related issuers while CLOs typically contain primarily senior secured obligations. However, to mitigate these risks TruPS CDOs were typically structured with higher levels of embedded credit enhancement than typical CLOs.
63
Table of Contents
The Company’s exposure to “Other” CDS contracts is also highly diversified. It includes
$1.8 billion
of exposure to
one
pooled infrastructure transaction comprising diversified pools of international infrastructure project transactions and loans to regulated utilities. These pools were all structured with underlying credit enhancement sufficient for the Company to attach at AAA levels at origination. The remaining
$4.3 billion
of exposure in “Other” CDS contracts comprises numerous deals across various asset classes, such as commercial receivables, international RMBS, infrastructure, regulated utilities and consumer receivables.
Distribution of Credit Derivative Net Par Outstanding by Internal Rating
As of March 31, 2016
As of December 31, 2015
Ratings
Net Par
Outstanding
% of Total
Net Par
Outstanding
% of Total
(dollars in millions)
AAA
$
14,302
57.5
%
$
14,808
57.9
%
AA
4,624
18.6
4,821
18.8
A
2,253
9.1
2,144
8.4
BBB
2,108
8.5
2,212
8.6
BIG
1,579
6.3
1,609
6.3
Credit derivative net par outstanding
$
24,866
100.0
%
$
25,594
100.0
%
Fair Value of Credit Derivatives
Net Change in Fair Value of Credit Derivatives Gain (Loss)
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Realized gains on credit derivatives
$
10
$
23
Net credit derivative losses (paid and payable) recovered and recoverable and other settlements
(2
)
(2
)
Realized gains (losses) and other settlements on credit derivatives
8
21
Net change in unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives:
Pooled corporate obligations
(48
)
17
U.S. RMBS
(15
)
75
CMBS
0
0
Other
(5
)
11
Net change in unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives
(68
)
103
Net change in fair value of credit derivatives
$
(60
)
$
124
Net Par and Realized Gains
from Terminations and Settlements of Credit Derivative Contracts
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Net par of terminated credit derivative contracts
$
—
$
93
Realized gains on credit derivatives
0
11
64
Table of Contents
During
First Quarter 2016
, unrealized fair value losses were generated primarily in the trust preferred, and U.S. RMBS prime first lien and subprime sectors, due to wider implied net spreads. The wider implied net spreads were primarily a result of the decreased cost to buy protection on AGC and AGM, particularly for the one year and five year CDS spreads. These transactions were pricing at or above their floor levels (or the minimum rate at which the Company would consider assuming these risks based on historical experience); therefore when the cost of purchasing CDS protection on AGC and AGM, which management refers to as the CDS spread on AGC and AGM, decreased the implied spreads that the Company would expect to receive on these transactions increased. Unrealized fair value losses in the Other Sector were generated primarily by a price decline on a hedge the Company has against another financial guarantor. These losses were partially offset by an unrealized fair value gain on a terminated toll road securitization.
During
First Quarter 2015
, unrealized fair value gains were generated primarily in the U.S. RMBS prime first lien and Option ARM sectors. The change in fair value of credit derivatives in First Quarter 2015 was primarily due to a refinement in methodology to address an instance in a U.S. RMBS transaction that changed from an expected loss to an expected recovery position. This refinement resulted in approximately
$49 million
in fair value gains in
First Quarter 2015
. In addition, there were unrealized gains in the TruPS CDO and Other sectors as result of price improvements on the underlying collateral. The changes in the Company’s CDS spreads did not have a material impact during the quarter.
The impact of changes in credit spreads will vary based upon the volume, tenor, interest rates, and other market conditions at the time these fair values are determined. In addition, since each transaction has unique collateral and structural terms, the underlying change in fair value of each transaction may vary considerably. The fair value of credit derivative contracts also reflects the change in the Company’s own credit cost based on the price to purchase credit protection on AGC and AGM. The Company determines its own credit risk based on quoted CDS prices traded on the Company at each balance sheet date.
CDS Spread on AGC and AGM
Quoted price of CDS contract (in basis points)
As of
March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
As of
March 31, 2015
As of
December 31, 2014
Five-year CDS spread:
AGC
307
376
317
323
AGM
309
366
341
325
One-year CDS spread
AGC
105
139
60
80
AGM
102
131
80
85
Fair Value of Credit Derivatives Assets (Liabilities)
and Effect of AGC and AGM
Credit Spreads
As of
March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
(in millions)
Fair value of credit derivatives before effect of AGC and AGM credit spreads
$
(1,509
)
$
(1,448
)
Plus: Effect of AGC and AGM credit spreads
1,075
1,083
Net fair value of credit derivatives (1)
$
(434
)
$
(365
)
The fair value of CDS contracts at
March 31, 2016
, before considering the implications of AGC’s and AGM’s credit spreads, is a direct result of continued wide credit spreads in the fixed income security markets and ratings downgrades. The asset classes that remain most affected are 2005-2007 vintages of prime first lien, Alt-A, Option ARM, subprime RMBS deals as well as TruPS and pooled corporate securities. Comparing
March 31, 2016
with
December 31, 2015
, there was a widening of spreads primarily related to the Company's TruPS obligations which resulted in mark to market deterioration.
65
Table of Contents
Management believes that the trading level of AGC’s and AGM’s credit spreads over the past several years has been due to the correlation between AGC’s and AGM’s risk profile and the current risk profile of the broader financial markets and to increased demand for credit protection against AGC and AGM as the result of its financial guaranty volume, as well as the overall lack of liquidity in the CDS market. Offsetting the benefit attributable to AGC’s and AGM’s credit spread were higher credit spreads in the fixed income security markets. The higher credit spreads in the fixed income security market are due to the lack of liquidity in the high yield CDO, TruPS CDO, and CLO markets as well as continuing market concerns over the 2005-2007 vintages of RMBS.
The following table presents the fair value and the present value of expected claim payments or recoveries (i.e. net expected loss to be paid as described in Note 6) for contracts accounted for as derivatives.
Net Fair Value and Expected Losses
of Credit Derivatives by Sector
Fair Value of Credit Derivative
Asset (Liability), net
Expected Loss to be (Paid) Recovered
Asset Type
As of
March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
As of
March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
(in millions)
Pooled corporate obligations
$
(131
)
$
(82
)
$
(4
)
$
(5
)
U.S. RMBS
(113
)
(98
)
(33
)
(38
)
CMBS
0
0
—
—
Other
(190
)
(185
)
28
27
Total
$
(434
)
$
(365
)
$
(9
)
$
(16
)
Ratings Sensitivities of Credit Derivative Contracts
Within the Company's insured CDS portfolio, the transaction documentation for approximately
$3.7 billion
in CDS gross par insured as of
March 31, 2016
requires AGC to post eligible collateral to secure its obligations to make payments under such contracts. Eligible collateral is generally cash or U.S. government or agency securities; eligible collateral other than cash is valued at a discount to the face amount.
•
For approximately
$3.5 billion
of such contracts, AGC has negotiated caps such that the posting requirement cannot exceed a certain fixed amount, regardless of the mark-to-market valuation of the exposure or the financial strength ratings of AGC. For such contracts, AGC need not post on a cash basis an aggregate of more than
$575 million
, although the value of the collateral posted may exceed such fixed amount depending on the advance rate agreed with the counterparty for the particular type of collateral posted.
•
For the remaining approximately
$219 million
of such contracts, AGC could be required from time to time to post additional collateral without such cap based on movements in the mark-to-market valuation of the underlying exposure.
As of
March 31, 2016
, the Company was posting approximately
$308 million
to secure its obligations under CDS, of which approximately
$23 million
related to the
$219 million
of notional described above, as to which the obligation to collateralize is not capped. In contrast, as of
December 31, 2015
, the Company was posting approximately
$305 million
to secure its obligations under CDS, of which approximately
$23 million
related to
$221 million
of notional as to which the obligation to collateralize was not capped. The obligation to post collateral could impair the Company's liquidity and results of operations.
66
Table of Contents
Sensitivity to Changes in Credit Spread
The following table summarizes the estimated change in fair values on the net balance of the Company’s credit derivative positions assuming immediate parallel shifts in credit spreads on AGC and AGM and on the risks that they both assume.
Effect of Changes in Credit Spread
As of March 31, 2016
Credit Spreads(1)
Estimated Net
Fair Value
(Pre-Tax)
Estimated Change
in Gain/(Loss)
(Pre-Tax)
(in millions)
100% widening in spreads
$
(883
)
$
(449
)
50% widening in spreads
(658
)
(224
)
25% widening in spreads
(547
)
(113
)
10% widening in spreads
(479
)
(45
)
Base Scenario
(434
)
—
10% narrowing in spreads
(392
)
42
25% narrowing in spreads
(329
)
105
50% narrowing in spreads
(226
)
208
____________________
(1)
Includes the effects of spreads on both the underlying asset classes and the Company’s own credit spread.
9.
Consolidated Variable Interest Entities
Consolidated FG VIEs
The Company provides financial guaranties with respect to debt obligations of special purpose entities, including VIEs. Assured Guaranty does not act as the servicer or collateral manager for any VIE obligations insured by its companies. The transaction structure generally provides certain financial protections to the Company. This financial protection can take several forms, the most common of which are overcollateralization, first loss protection (or subordination) and excess spread. In the case of overcollateralization (i.e., the principal amount of the securitized assets exceeds the principal amount of the structured finance obligations guaranteed by the Company), the structure allows defaults of the securitized assets before a default is experienced on the structured finance obligation guaranteed by the Company. In the case of first loss, the financial guaranty insurance policy only covers a senior layer of losses experienced by multiple obligations issued by special purpose entities, including VIEs. The first loss exposure with respect to the assets is either retained by the seller or sold off in the form of equity or mezzanine debt to other investors. In the case of excess spread, the financial assets contributed to special purpose entities, including VIEs, generate interest income that are in excess of the interest payments on the debt issued by the special purpose entity. Such excess spread is typically distributed through the transaction’s cash flow waterfall and may be used to create additional credit enhancement, applied to redeem debt issued by the special purpose entities, including VIEs (thereby, creating additional overcollateralization), or distributed to equity or other investors in the transaction.
Assured Guaranty is not primarily liable for the debt obligations issued by the VIEs it insures and would only be required to make payments on those insured debt obligations in the event that the issuer of such debt obligations defaults on any principal or interest due and only for the amount of the shortfall. AGL’s and its Subsidiaries’ creditors do not have any rights with regard to the collateral supporting the debt issued by the FG VIEs. Proceeds from sales, maturities, prepayments and interest from such underlying collateral may only be used to pay Debt Service on VIE liabilities. Net fair value gains and losses on FG VIEs are expected to reverse to
zero
at maturity of the VIE debt, except for net premiums received and net claims paid by Assured Guaranty under the financial guaranty insurance contract. The Company’s estimate of expected loss to be paid for FG VIEs is included in Note 5, Expected Loss to be Paid.
As part of the terms of its financial guaranty contracts, the Company obtains certain protective rights with respect to the VIE that are triggered by the occurrence of certain events, such as failure to be in compliance with a covenant due to poor deal performance or a deterioration in a servicer or collateral manager's financial condition. At deal inception, the Company typically is not deemed to control a VIE; however, once a trigger event occurs, the Company's control of the VIE typically increases. The Company continuously evaluates its power to direct the activities that most significantly impact the economic
67
Table of Contents
performance of VIEs that have debt obligations insured by the Company and, accordingly, where the Company is obligated to absorb VIE losses or receive benefits that could potentially be significant to the VIE. The Company obtains protective rights under its insurance contracts that give the Company additional controls over a VIE if there is either deterioration of deal performance or in the financial health of the deal servicer. The Company is deemed to be the control party for certain VIEs under GAAP, typically when its protective rights give it the power to both terminate and replace the deal servicer, which are characteristics specific to the Company's financial guaranty contracts. If the protective rights that could make the Company the control party have not been triggered, then the VIE is not consolidated. If the Company is deemed no longer to have those protective rights, the transaction is deconsolidated.
Number of FG VIEs Consolidated
First Quarter
2016
2015
Beginning of the period, December 31
34
32
Consolidated (1)
—
1
Deconsolidated (1)
(1
)
—
End of the period, September 30
33
33
____________________
(1)
Net loss on deconsolidation was de minimis in
First Quarter 2016
, and net loss on consolidation was
$26 million
in
First Quarter 2015
, and recorded in “fair value gains (losses) on FG VIEs” in the consolidated statement of operations.
The total unpaid principal balance for the FG VIEs’ assets that were over
90
days or more past due was approximately
$146 million
at
March 31, 2016
and
$154 million
at
December 31, 2015
. The aggregate unpaid principal of the FG VIEs’ assets was approximately
$776 million
greater than the aggregate fair value at
March 31, 2016
, excluding the effect of R&W settlements. The aggregate unpaid principal of the FG VIEs’ assets was approximately
$804 million
greater than the aggregate fair value at
December 31, 2015
, excluding the effect of R&W settlements.
The change in the instrument-specific credit risk of the FG VIEs’ assets held as of
March 31, 2016
that was recorded in the consolidated statements of operations for
First Quarter 2016
were gains of
$34 million
The change in the instrument-specific credit risk of the FG VIEs’ assets held as of
March 31, 2015
that was recorded in the consolidated statements of operations for
First Quarter 2015
were gains of
$18 million
. To calculate the instrument specific credit risk, the changes in the fair value of the FG VIE assets are allocated between changes that are due to the instrument specific credit risk and changes due to other factors, including interest rates. The instrument specific credit risk amount is determined by using expected contractual cash flows versus current expected cash flows discounted at original contractual rate. The net present value is calculated by discounting the expected cash flows of the underlying security, excluding the Company’s financial guaranty insurance, at the relevant effective interest rate.
The unpaid principal for FG VIE liabilities with recourse, which represent obligations insured by AGC or AGM, was
$1,382 million
and
$1,436 million
as of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, respectively. FG VIE liabilities with recourse will mature at various dates ranging from
2025
to
2038
. The aggregate unpaid principal balance of the FG VIE liabilities with and without recourse was approximately
$407 million
greater than the aggregate fair value of the FG VIEs’ liabilities as of
March 31, 2016
. The aggregate unpaid principal balance was approximately
$423 million
greater than the aggregate fair value of the FG VIEs' liabilities as of
December 31, 2015
.
68
Table of Contents
The table below shows the carrying value of the consolidated FG VIEs’ assets and liabilities in the consolidated financial statements, segregated by the types of assets that collateralize their respective debt obligations for FG VIE liabilities with recourse.
Consolidated FG VIEs
By Type of Collateral
As of March 31, 2016
As of December 31, 2015
Assets
Liabilities
Assets
Liabilities
(in millions)
With recourse:
U.S. RMBS first lien
$
457
$
495
$
506
$
521
U.S. RMBS second lien
189
250
194
273
Life insurance
339
339
347
347
Manufactured housing
81
81
84
84
Total with recourse
1,066
1,165
1,131
1,225
Without recourse
125
119
130
124
Total
$
1,191
$
1,284
$
1,261
$
1,349
The consolidation of FG VIEs has a significant effect on net income and shareholders’ equity due to (1) changes in fair value gains (losses) on FG VIE assets and liabilities, (2) the elimination of premiums and losses related to the AGC and AGM FG VIE liabilities with recourse and (3) the elimination of investment balances related to the Company’s purchase of AGC and AGM insured FG VIE debt. Upon consolidation of a FG VIE, the related insurance and, if applicable, the related investment balances, are considered intercompany transactions and therefore eliminated. Such eliminations are included in the table below to present the full effect of consolidating FG VIEs.
Effect of Consolidating FG VIEs on Net Income,
Cash Flows From Operating Activities and Shareholders’ Equity
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Net earned premiums
$
(5
)
$
(5
)
Net investment income
(5
)
(3
)
Net realized investment gains (losses)
1
0
Fair value gains (losses) on FG VIEs
18
(7
)
Loss and LAE
6
5
Effect on income before tax
15
(10
)
Less: tax provision (benefit)
5
(4
)
Effect on net income (loss)
$
10
$
(6
)
Effect on cash flows from operating activities
$
6
$
18
As of
March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
(in millions)
Effect on shareholders’ equity (decrease) increase
$
(12
)
$
(23
)
69
Table of Contents
Fair value gains (losses) on FG VIEs represent the net change in fair value on the consolidated FG VIEs’ assets and liabilities. During
First Quarter 2016
, the Company recorded a pre-tax net fair value gain on consolidated FG VIEs of
$18 million
. The primary driver of the gain was price appreciation on the FG VIE assets during the quarter resulting from improvements in the underlying collateral.
During
First Quarter 2015
, the Company recorded a pre-tax net fair value loss on consolidated FG VIEs of
$7 million
. The primary driver of the loss was a pre-tax net fair value loss of
$26 million
on the consolidation of
one
new FG VIE. The net fair value loss on consolidation was partially offset by price appreciation on the FG VIE assets during the quarter resulting from improvements in the underlying collateral.
Other Consolidated VIEs
In certain instances where the Company consolidates a VIE that was established as part of a loss mitigation negotiation settlement agreement that results in the termination of the original insured financial guaranty insurance or credit derivative contract the Company classifies the assets and liabilities of those VIEs in the line items that most accurately reflect the nature of the items, as opposed to within the FG VIE assets and FG VIE liabilities.
Non-Consolidated VIEs
As of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, the Company had financial guaranty contracts outstanding for approximately
720
and
750
VIEs, respectively, that it did not consolidate. To date, the Company’s analyses have indicated that it does not have a controlling financial interest in any other VIEs and, as a result, they are not consolidated. The Company’s exposure provided through its financial guaranties with respect to debt obligations of special purpose entities is included within net par outstanding in Note 4, Outstanding Exposure.
10.
Investments and Cash
Net Investment Income and Realized Gains (Losses)
Net investment income is a function of the yield that the Company earns on invested assets and the size of the portfolio. The investment yield is a function of market interest rates at the time of investment as well as the type, credit quality and maturity of the invested assets. Accrued investment income, which is recorded in Other Assets, was $
98 million
and $
99 million
as of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, respectively.
Net Investment Income
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Income from fixed-maturity securities managed by third parties
$
79
$
82
Income from internally managed securities:
Fixed maturities
17
15
Other
5
6
Gross investment income
101
103
Investment expenses
(2
)
(2
)
Net investment income
$
99
$
101
70
Table of Contents
Net Realized Investment Gains (Losses)
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Gross realized gains on available-for-sale securities
$
6
$
24
Gross realized gains on other assets in investment portfolio
—
1
Gross realized losses on available-for-sale securities
(2
)
(1
)
Gross realized losses on other assets in investment portfolio
(1
)
(1
)
Other-than-temporary impairment
(16
)
(7
)
Net realized investment gains (losses)
$
(13
)
$
16
The following table presents the roll-forward of the credit losses of fixed-maturity securities for which the Company has recognized an other-than-temporary-impairment and where the portion of the fair value adjustment related to other factors was recognized in other comprehensive income ("OCI").
Roll Forward of Credit Losses
in the Investment Portfolio
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Balance, beginning of period
$
108
$
124
Additions for credit losses on securities for which an other-than-temporary-impairment was not previously recognized
1
—
Reductions for securities sold and other settlement during the period
(2
)
(21
)
Additions for credit losses on securities for which an other-than-temporary-impairment was previously recognized
0
3
Balance, end of period
$
107
$
106
71
Table of Contents
Investment Portfolio
Fixed-Maturity Securities and Short-Term Investments
by Security Type
As of March 31, 2016
Investment Category
Percent
of
Total(1)
Amortized
Cost
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Estimated
Fair
Value
AOCI(2)
Gain
(Loss) on
Securities
with
Other-Than-Temporary Impairment
Weighted
Average
Credit
Rating
(3)
(dollars in millions)
Fixed-maturity securities:
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
51
%
$
5,417
$
360
$
(1
)
$
5,776
$
3
AA
U.S. government and agencies
4
379
26
0
405
—
AA+
Corporate securities
14
1,473
69
(17
)
1,525
(11
)
A-
Mortgage-backed securities(4):
0
RMBS
11
1,222
37
(20
)
1,239
(13
)
A
CMBS
5
531
25
0
556
—
AAA
Asset-backed securities
8
821
3
(13
)
811
(11
)
B+
Foreign government securities
3
280
5
(9
)
276
—
AA+
Total fixed-maturity securities
96
10,123
525
(60
)
10,588
(32
)
A+
Short-term investments
4
459
0
0
459
—
AAA
Total investment portfolio
100
%
$
10,582
$
525
$
(60
)
$
11,047
$
(32
)
A+
72
Table of Contents
Fixed-Maturity Securities and Short-Term Investments
by Security Type
As of December 31, 2015
Investment Category
Percent
of
Total(1)
Amortized
Cost
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Estimated
Fair
Value
AOCI
Gain
(Loss) on
Securities
with
Other-Than-Temporary Impairment
Weighted
Average
Credit
Rating
(3)
(dollars in millions)
Fixed-maturity securities:
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
52
%
$
5,528
$
323
$
(10
)
$
5,841
$
5
AA
U.S. government and agencies
3
377
23
0
400
—
AA+
Corporate securities
14
1,505
38
(23
)
1,520
(13
)
A-
Mortgage-backed securities(4):
RMBS
11
1,238
29
(22
)
1,245
(7
)
A
CMBS
5
506
9
(2
)
513
—
AAA
Asset-backed securities
8
831
4
(10
)
825
(6
)
B+
Foreign government securities
3
290
4
(11
)
283
—
AA+
Total fixed-maturity securities
96
10,275
430
(78
)
10,627
(21
)
A+
Short-term investments
4
396
0
0
396
—
AA-
Total investment portfolio
100
%
$
10,671
$
430
$
(78
)
$
11,023
$
(21
)
A+
____________________
(1)
Based on amortized cost.
(2)
Accumulated OCI. See also Note 17, Shareholders' Equity.
(3)
Ratings in the tables above represent the lower of the Moody’s and S&P classifications except for bonds purchased for loss mitigation or risk management strategies, which use internal ratings classifications. The Company’s portfolio consists primarily of high-quality, liquid instruments.
(4)
Government-agency obligations were approximately
52%
of mortgage backed securities as of
March 31, 2016
and
54%
as of
December 31, 2015
based on fair value.
The Company’s investment portfolio in tax-exempt and taxable municipal securities includes issuances by a wide number of municipal authorities across the U.S. and its territories. Under the Company's investment guidelines, securities rated lower than A-/A3 by S&P or Moody’s are typically not purchased for the Company’s portfolio unless acquired for loss mitigation or risk management strategies.
The majority of the investment portfolio is managed by
four
outside managers. The Company has established detailed guidelines regarding credit quality, exposure to a particular sector and exposure to a particular obligor within a sector.
73
Table of Contents
The following tables summarize, for all securities in an unrealized loss position, the aggregate fair value and gross unrealized loss by length of time the amounts have continuously been in an unrealized loss position.
Fixed-Maturity Securities
Gross Unrealized Loss by Length of Time
As of March 31, 2016
Less than 12 months
12 months or more
Total
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Loss
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Loss
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Loss
(dollars in millions)
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
$
58
$
0
$
87
$
(1
)
$
145
$
(1
)
U.S. government and agencies
7
0
—
—
7
0
Corporate securities
78
(2
)
122
(15
)
200
(17
)
Mortgage-backed securities:
RMBS
123
(5
)
182
(15
)
305
(20
)
CMBS
7
0
5
0
12
0
Asset-backed securities
456
(13
)
—
—
456
(13
)
Foreign government securities
91
(4
)
53
(5
)
144
(9
)
Total
$
820
$
(24
)
$
449
$
(36
)
$
1,269
$
(60
)
Number of securities (1)
110
82
185
Number of securities with other-than-temporary impairment
12
6
18
74
Table of Contents
Fixed-Maturity Securities
Gross Unrealized Loss by Length of Time
As of December 31, 2015
Less than 12 months
12 months or more
Total
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Loss
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Loss
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Loss
(dollars in millions)
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
$
316
$
(10
)
$
7
$
0
$
323
$
(10
)
U.S. government and agencies
77
0
—
—
77
0
Corporate securities
381
(8
)
95
(15
)
476
(23
)
Mortgage-backed securities:
RMBS
438
(8
)
90
(14
)
528
(22
)
CMBS
140
(2
)
2
0
142
(2
)
Asset-backed securities
517
(10
)
—
—
517
(10
)
Foreign government securities
97
(4
)
82
(7
)
179
(11
)
Total
$
1,966
$
(42
)
$
276
$
(36
)
$
2,242
$
(78
)
Number of securities (1)
335
71
396
Number of securities with other-than-temporary impairment
9
4
13
___________________
(1)
The number of securities does not add across because lots of the same securities have been purchased at different times and appear in both categories above (i.e. Less than 12 months and 12 months or more). If a security appears in both categories, it is counted only once in the total column.
Of the securities in an unrealized loss position for 12 months or more as of
March 31, 2016
,
eleven
securities had unrealized losses greater than
10%
of book value. The total unrealized loss for these securities as of
March 31, 2016
was $
26 million
. The Company has determined that the unrealized losses recorded as of
March 31, 2016
are yield related and not the result of other-than-temporary-impairment.
The amortized cost and estimated fair value of available-for-sale fixed maturity securities by contractual maturity as of
March 31, 2016
are shown below. Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties.
Distribution of Fixed-Maturity Securities
by Contractual Maturity
As of March 31, 2016
Amortized
Cost
Estimated
Fair Value
(in millions)
Due within one year
$
469
$
470
Due after one year through five years
1,654
1,719
Due after five years through 10 years
2,195
2,320
Due after 10 years
4,052
4,284
Mortgage-backed securities:
RMBS
1,222
1,239
CMBS
531
556
Total
$
10,123
$
10,588
75
Table of Contents
The investment portfolio contains securities and cash that are either held in trust for the benefit of third party reinsurers in accordance with statutory requirements, invested in a guaranteed investment contract for future claims payments, placed on deposit to fulfill state licensing requirements, or otherwise restricted in the amount of $
300 million
and $
283 million
as of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, respectively, based on fair value. The investment portfolio also contains securities that are held in trust by certain AGL subsidiaries for the benefit of other AGL subsidiaries in accordance with statutory and regulatory requirements in the amount of
$1,550 million
and
$1,411 million
as of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, respectively, based on fair value.
The fair value of the Company’s pledged securities to secure its obligations under its CDS exposure totaled $
308 million
and $
305 million
as of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, respectively.
No material investments of the Company were non-income producing for
First Quarter
2016
and
First Quarter
2015
, respectively.
Internally Managed Portfolio
The investment portfolio tables shown above include both assets managed externally and internally. In the table below, more detailed information is provided for the component of the total investment portfolio that is internally managed (excluding short-term investments). The internally managed portfolio, as defined below, represents approximately
13%
and
13%
of the investment portfolio, on a fair value basis as of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, respectively. The internally managed portfolio consists primarily of the Company's investments in securities for (i) loss mitigation purposes, (ii) other risk management purposes and (iii) where the Company believes a particular security presents an attractive investment opportunity.
One of the Company's strategies for mitigating losses has been to purchase securities it has insured that have expected losses, at discounted prices (assets purchased for loss mitigation purposes). In addition, the Company holds other invested assets that were obtained or purchased as part of negotiated settlements with insured counterparties or under the terms of our financial guaranties (other risk management assets).
Internally Managed Portfolio
Carrying Value
As of
March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
(in millions)
Assets purchased for loss mitigation and other risk management purposes:
Fixed-maturity securities, at fair value
$
1,264
$
1,266
Other invested assets
112
114
Other
55
55
Total
$
1,431
$
1,435
11.
Insurance Company Regulatory Requirements
Dividend Restrictions and Capital Requirements
Under New York insurance law, AGM may only pay dividends out of "earned surplus," which is the portion of the company's surplus that represents the net earnings, gains or profits (after deduction of all losses) that have not been distributed to shareholders as dividends or transferred to stated capital or capital surplus, or applied to other purposes permitted by law, but does not include unrealized appreciation of assets. AGM may pay dividends without the prior approval of the New York Superintendent of Financial Services ("New York Superintendent") that, together with all dividends declared or distributed by it during the preceding 12 months, does not exceed the lesser of
10%
of its policyholders' surplus (as of its last annual or quarterly statement filed with the New York Superintendent) or
100%
of its adjusted net investment income during that period. The maximum amount available during 2016 for AGM to distribute as dividends without regulatory approval is estimated to be approximately
$236 million
, of which approximately
$32 million
is estimated to be available for distribution in the second quarter of 2016.
76
Table of Contents
Under Maryland's insurance law, AGC may, with prior notice to the Maryland Insurance Commissioner, pay an ordinary dividend that, together with all dividends paid in the prior 12 months, does not exceed
10%
of its policyholders' surplus (as of the prior December 31) or
100%
of its adjusted net investment income during that period. The maximum amount available during 2016 for AGC to distribute as ordinary dividends is approximately
$79 million
, of which approximately
$24 million
is available for distribution in the second quarter of 2016.
MAC is a New York domiciled insurance company subject to the same dividend limitations described above for AGM. The Company does not currently anticipate that MAC will distribute any dividends.
For AG Re, any distribution (including repurchase of shares) of any share capital, contributed surplus or other statutory capital that would reduce its total statutory capital by
15%
or more of its total statutory capital as set out in its previous year's financial statements requires the prior approval of the Bermuda Monetary Authority ("Authority"). Separately, dividends are paid out of an insurer's statutory surplus and cannot exceed that surplus. Further, annual dividends cannot exceed
25%
of total statutory capital and surplus as set out in its previous year's financial statements, which is
$246 million
, without AG Re certifying to the Authority that it will continue to meet required margins. Based on the foregoing limitations, in 2016 AG Re has the capacity to (i) make capital distributions in an aggregate amount up to
$127 million
without the prior approval of the Authority and (ii) declare and pay dividends in an aggregate amount up to the limit of its outstanding statutory surplus, which is
$140 million
. Such dividend capacity is further limited by the actual amount of AG Re’s unencumbered assets, which amount changes from time to time due in part to collateral posting requirements. As of
March 31, 2016
, AG Re had unencumbered assets of approximately
$594 million
.
U.K. company law prohibits each of AGE and AGUK from declaring a dividend to its shareholders unless it has “profits available for distribution.” The determination of whether a company has profits available for distribution is based on its accumulated realized profits less its accumulated realized losses. While the U.K. insurance regulatory laws impose no statutory restrictions on a general insurer's ability to declare a dividend, the Prudential Regulation Authority's capital requirements may in practice act as a restriction on dividends. The Company does not expect AGE or AGUK to distribute any dividends at this time.
Dividends and Surplus Notes
By Insurance Company Subsidiaries
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Dividends paid by AGC to AGUS
$
—
$
20
Dividends paid by AGM to AGMH
95
66
Dividends paid by AG Re to AGL
25
50
Repayment of surplus note by AGM to AGMH
—
25
12.
Income Taxes
Overview
AGL, and its "Bermuda Subsidiaries," which consist of AG Re, AGRO, and Cedar Personnel Ltd., are not subject to any income, withholding or capital gains taxes under current Bermuda law. The Company has received an assurance from the Minister of Finance in Bermuda that, in the event of any taxes being imposed, AGL and its Bermuda Subsidiaries will be exempt from taxation in Bermuda until March 31, 2035. AGL's U.S. and U.K. subsidiaries are subject to income taxes imposed by U.S. and U.K. authorities, respectively, and file applicable tax returns. In addition, AGRO, a Bermuda domiciled company and AGE, a U.K. domiciled company, have elected under Section 953(d) of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code to be taxed as a U.S. domestic corporation.
In November 2013, AGL became tax resident in the U.K. although it will remain a Bermuda-based company and its administrative and head office functions will continue to be carried on in Bermuda. As a U.K. tax resident company, AGL is required to file a corporation tax return with Her Majesty’s Revenue & Customs (“HMRC”). AGL is subject to U.K. corporation tax in respect of its worldwide profits (both income and capital gains), subject to any applicable exemptions. The main rate of corporation tax remains at
20%
for 2016. AGL has also registered in the U.K. to report its Value Added Tax
77
Table of Contents
(“VAT”) liability. The current rate of VAT is
20%
. Assured Guaranty expects that the dividends AGL receives from its direct subsidiaries will be exempt from U.K. corporation tax due to the exemption in section 931D of the U.K. Corporation Tax Act 2009. In addition, any dividends paid by AGL to its shareholders should not be subject to any withholding tax in the U.K. The U.K. government implemented a tax regime for “controlled foreign companies” (“CFC regime”) effective January 1, 2013. Assured Guaranty does not expect any profits of non-U.K. resident members of the group to be taxed under the CFC regime and has obtained a clearance from HMRC confirming this on the basis of current facts.
AGUS files a consolidated federal income tax return with AGC, AG Financial Products Inc. ("AGFP"), AG Analytics Inc., AGMH, beginning May 12, 2012 MAC and MAC Holdings, and beginning April 1, 2015 Radian Asset and Van American (“AGUS consolidated tax group”). Assured Guaranty Overseas US Holdings Inc. and its subsidiaries AGRO and AG Intermediary Inc., file their own consolidated federal income tax return.
Provision for Income Taxes
The Company's provision for income taxes for interim financial periods is not based on an estimated annual effective rate due, for example, to the variability in fair value of its credit derivatives, which prevents the Company from projecting a reliable estimated annual effective tax rate and pretax income for the full year 2016. A discrete calculation of the provision is calculated for each interim period.
The effective tax rates reflect the proportion of income recognized by each of the Company’s operating subsidiaries, with U.S. subsidiaries taxed at the U.S. marginal corporate income tax rate of
35%
, U.K. subsidiaries taxed at the U.K. marginal corporate tax rate of
20%
unless subject to U.S. tax by election or as a U.S. controlled foreign corporation, and no taxes for the Company’s Bermuda subsidiaries unless subject to U.S. tax by election or as a U.S. controlled foreign corporation. For periods subsequent to April 1, 2015, the U.K. corporation tax rate has been reduced to
20%
and will remain unchanged until April 1, 2017. For the period April 1, 2014 to April 1, 2015 the U.K. corporation tax rate was
21%
resulting in a blended tax rate of
20.25%
in 2015. The Company’s overall effective tax rate fluctuates based on the distribution of income across jurisdictions.
A reconciliation of the difference between the provision for income taxes and the expected tax provision at statutory rates in taxable jurisdictions is presented below.
Effective Tax Rate Reconciliation
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Expected tax provision (benefit) at statutory rates in taxable jurisdictions
$
18
$
77
Tax-exempt interest
(13
)
(14
)
Change in liability for uncertain tax positions
0
1
Other
1
1
Total provision (benefit) for income taxes
$
6
$
65
Effective tax rate
10.0
%
24.2
%
The expected tax provision at statutory rates in taxable jurisdictions is calculated as the sum of pretax income in each jurisdiction multiplied by the statutory tax rate of the jurisdiction by which it will be taxed. Pretax income of the Company’s subsidiaries which are not U.S. or U.K. domiciled but are subject to U.S. or U.K. tax by election, establishment of tax residency or as controlled foreign corporations, are included at the U.S. or U.K. statutory tax rate. Where there is a pretax loss in one jurisdiction and pretax income in another, the total combined expected tax rate may be higher or lower than any of the individual statutory rates.
78
Table of Contents
The following table presents pretax income and revenue by jurisdiction.
Pretax Income (Loss) by Tax Jurisdiction
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
United States
$
55
$
223
Bermuda
17
50
U.K.
(7
)
(7
)
Total
$
65
$
266
Revenue by Tax Jurisdiction
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
United States
$
205
$
300
Bermuda
42
73
U.K.
(2
)
(4
)
Total
$
245
$
369
Pretax income by jurisdiction may be disproportionate to revenue by jurisdiction to the extent that insurance losses incurred are disproportionate.
Valuation Allowance
As part of the Radian Asset Acquisition, the Company acquired
$11 million
of foreign tax credits (“FTC”) which will expire between 2018 and 2020. After reviewing positive and negative evidence, the Company came to the conclusion that it is more likely than not that the FTC will not be utilized, and therefore recorded a valuation allowance with respect to this tax attribute.
The Company came to the conclusion that it is more likely than not that the remaining net deferred tax asset will be fully realized after weighing all positive and negative evidence available as required under GAAP. The positive evidence that was considered included the cumulative income the Company has earned over the last
three
years, and the significant unearned premium income to be included in taxable income. The positive evidence outweighs any negative evidence that exists. As such, the Company believes that no valuation allowance is necessary in connection with this deferred tax asset. The Company will continue to analyze the need for a valuation allowance on a quarterly basis.
Audits
AGUS has open tax years with the U.S. Internal Revenue Service (“IRS”) for 2009 forward and is currently under audit for the 2009-2012 tax years. Assured Guaranty Oversees US Holdings Inc. has open tax years of 2012 forward. The Company's U.K. subsidiaries are not currently under examination and have open tax years of 2014 forward.
Uncertain Tax Positions
The Company's policy is to recognize interest and penalties related to uncertain tax positions in income tax expense and has accrued
$0.4 million
for
First Quarter 2016
and
$1 million
for 2015. As of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, the Company has accrued
$5.8 million
and
$5.4 million
of interest, respectively.
The total amount of unrecognized tax benefits as of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, that would affect the effective tax rate, if recognized, was
$46 million
and
$45 million
, respectively.
79
Table of Contents
13.
Reinsurance and Other Monoline Exposures
The Company assumes exposure on insured obligations (“Assumed Business”) and may cede portions of its exposure on obligations it has insured (“Ceded Business”) in exchange for premiums, net of ceding commissions. The Company historically entered into ceded reinsurance contracts in order to obtain greater business diversification and reduce the net potential loss from large risks.
Assumed and Ceded Business
The Company assumes business from other monoline financial guaranty companies. Under these relationships, the Company assumes a portion of the ceding company’s insured risk in exchange for a premium. The Company may be exposed to risk in this portfolio in that the Company may be required to pay losses without a corresponding premium in circumstances where the ceding company is experiencing financial distress and is unable to pay premiums. The Company’s facultative and treaty agreements are generally subject to termination at the option of the ceding company:
•
if the Company fails to meet certain financial and regulatory criteria and to maintain a specified minimum financial strength rating, or
•
upon certain changes of control of the Company.
Upon termination under these conditions, the Company may be required (under some of its reinsurance agreements) to return to the ceding company unearned premiums (net of ceding commissions) and loss reserves calculated on a statutory basis of accounting, attributable to reinsurance assumed pursuant to such agreements after which the Company would be released from liability with respect to the Assumed Business.
Upon the occurrence of the conditions set forth in the first bullet above, whether or not an agreement is terminated, the Company may be required to obtain a letter of credit or alternative form of security to collateralize its obligation to perform under such agreement or it may be obligated to increase the level of ceding commission paid.
The downgrade of the financial strength ratings of AG Re or of AGC gives certain ceding companies the right to recapture business they had ceded to AG Re and AGC, which would lead to a reduction in the Company's unearned premium reserve and related earnings on such reserve. With respect to a significant portion of the Company's in-force financial guaranty assumed business, based on AG Re's and AGC's current ratings and subject to the terms of each reinsurance agreement, the third party ceding company may have the right to recapture business it had ceded to AG Re and/or AGC, and in connection therewith, to receive payment from AG Re or AGC of an amount equal to the statutory unearned premium (net of ceding commissions) and statutory loss reserves (if any) associated with that business, plus, in certain cases, an additional ceding commission. As of
March 31, 2016
, if each third party insurer ceding business to AG Re and/or AGC had a right to recapture such business, and chose to exercise such right, the aggregate amounts that AG Re and AGC could be required to pay to all such companies would be approximately
$50 million
and
$33 million
, respectively.
The Company has Ceded Business to non-affiliated companies to limit its exposure to risk. Under these relationships, the Company ceded a portion of its insured risk in exchange for a premium paid to the reinsurer. The Company remains primarily liable for all risks it directly underwrites and is required to pay all gross claims. It then seeks reimbursement from the reinsurer for its proportionate share of claims. The Company may be exposed to risk for this exposure if it were required to pay the gross claims and not be able to collect ceded claims from an assuming company experiencing financial distress. A number of the financial guaranty insurers to which the Company has ceded par have experienced financial distress and been downgraded by the rating agencies as a result. In addition, state insurance regulators have intervened with respect to some of these insurers. The Company’s ceded contracts generally allow the Company to recapture Ceded Business after certain triggering events, such as reinsurer downgrades.
80
Table of Contents
The following table presents the components of premiums and losses reported in the consolidated statement of operations and the contribution of the Company's Assumed and Ceded Businesses.
Effect of Reinsurance on Statement of Operations
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Premiums Written:
Direct
$
21
$
29
Assumed
(2
)
3
Ceded
(17
)
0
Net
$
2
$
32
Premiums Earned:
Direct
$
190
$
148
Assumed
8
10
Ceded
(15
)
(16
)
Net
$
183
$
142
Loss and LAE:
Direct
$
109
$
26
Assumed
(14
)
(7
)
Ceded
(5
)
(1
)
Net
$
90
$
18
Other Monoline Exposures
In addition to assumed and ceded reinsurance arrangements, the Company may also have exposure to some financial guaranty reinsurers (i.e., monolines) in other areas. Second-to-pay insured par outstanding represents transactions the Company has insured that were previously insured by other monolines. The Company underwrites such transactions based on the underlying insured obligation without regard to the primary insurer. Another area of exposure is in the investment portfolio where the Company holds fixed-maturity securities that are wrapped by monolines and whose value may change based on the rating of the monoline. As of
March 31, 2016
, based on fair value, the Company had fixed-maturity securities in its investment portfolio consisting of
$157 million
insured by National Public Finance Guarantee Corporation ("National"),
$139 million
insured by Ambac and
$8 million
insured by other guarantors. In addition, the Company acquired bonds for loss mitigation or other risk management purposes. As of
March 31, 2016
these bonds had a fair value of
$247 million
insured by MBIA Insurance Corp. and
$127 million
insured by FGIC UK Limited.
81
Table of Contents
Exposure by Reinsurer
Ratings at
Par Outstanding (1)
May 3, 2016
As of March 31, 2016
Reinsurer
Moody’s
Reinsurer
Rating
S&P
Reinsurer
Rating
Ceded Par
Outstanding
Second-to-
Pay Insured
Par
Outstanding
Assumed Par
Outstanding
(dollars in millions)
American Overseas Reinsurance Company Limited (2)
WR (3)
WR
$
4,960
$
—
$
30
Tokio Marine & Nichido Fire Insurance Co., Ltd. (2)
Aa3 (4)
A+ (4)
4,171
—
—
Syncora Guarantee Inc. (2)
WR
WR
2,411
1,319
700
Mitsui Sumitomo Insurance Co. Ltd. (2)
A1
A+ (4)
1,718
—
—
ACA Financial Guaranty Corp.
NR (5)
WR
700
38
—
Ambac
WR
WR
117
3,892
9,589
National (6)
A3
AA-
—
5,139
5,065
MBIA
(7)
(7)
—
1,591
428
FGIC
(8)
(8)
—
1,437
636
Ambac Assurance Corp. Segregated Account
NR
NR
—
86
823
CIFG Assurance North America Inc.
WR
WR
—
43
2,784
Other (2)
Various
Various
76
776
128
Total
$
14,153
$
14,321
$
20,183
____________________
(1)
Includes par related to insured credit derivatives.
(2)
The total collateral posted by all non-affiliated reinsurers required or agreeing to post collateral as of
March 31, 2016
was approximately
$436 million
.
(3) Represents “Withdrawn Rating.”
(4) The Company benefits from trust arrangements that satisfy the triple-A credit requirement of S&P and/or Moody’s.
(5) Represents “Not Rated.”
(6)
Rated AA+ by KBRA.
(7)
MBIA includes subsidiaries MBIA Insurance Corp. rated B by S&P and B3 by Moody's and MBIA U.K. Insurance Ltd. rated BB by S&P and Ba2 by Moody’s.
(8)
FGIC includes subsidiaries Financial Guaranty Insurance Company and FGIC UK Limited both of which had their ratings withdrawn by rating agencies.
82
Table of Contents
Amounts Due (To) From Reinsurers
As of March 31, 2016
Assumed
Premium, net
of Commissions
Ceded
Premium, net
of Commissions
Assumed
Expected
Loss to be Paid
Ceded
Expected
Loss to be Paid
(in millions)
American Overseas Reinsurance Company Limited
$
—
$
(6
)
$
—
$
25
Tokio Marine & Nichido Fire Insurance Co., Ltd.
—
(11
)
—
44
Syncora Guarantee Inc.
15
(21
)
—
5
Mitsui Sumitomo Insurance Co. Ltd.
—
(3
)
—
18
Ambac
39
—
(3
)
—
National
6
—
(4
)
—
MBIA
5
—
(10
)
—
FGIC
4
—
(15
)
—
Ambac Assurance Corp. Segregated Account
10
—
(46
)
—
CIFG Assurance North America Inc.
0
—
(63
)
—
Other
—
(12
)
—
—
Total
$
79
$
(53
)
$
(141
)
$
92
Excess of Loss Reinsurance Facility
AGC, AGM and MAC entered into a
$360 million
aggregate excess of loss reinsurance facility with a number of reinsurers, effective as of January 1, 2016. This facility replaces a similar
$450 million
aggregate excess of loss reinsurance facility that AGC, AGM and MAC had entered into effective January 1, 2014 and which terminated on December 31, 2015. The new facility covers losses occurring either from January 1, 2016 through December 31, 2023, or January 1, 2017 through December 31, 2024, at the option of AGC, AGM and MAC. It terminates on January 1, 2018, unless AGC, AGM and MAC choose to extend it. The new facility covers certain U.S. public finance credits insured or reinsured by AGC, AGM and MAC as of September 30, 2015, excluding credits that were rated non-investment grade as of December 31, 2015 by Moody’s or S&P or internally by AGC, AGM or MAC and is subject to certain per credit limits. Among the credits excluded are those associated with the Commonwealth of Puerto Rico and its related authorities and public corporations. The new facility attaches when AGC’s, AGM’s and MAC’s net losses (net of AGC’s and AGM's reinsurance (including from affiliates) and net of recoveries) exceed
$1.25 billion
in the aggregate. The new facility covers a portion of the next
$400 million
of losses, with the reinsurers assuming pro rata in the aggregate
$360 million
of the
$400 million
of losses and AGC, AGM and MAC jointly retaining the remaining
$40 million
. The reinsurers are required to be rated at least AA- or to post collateral sufficient to provide AGM, AGC and MAC with the same reinsurance credit as reinsurers rated AA-. AGM, AGC and MAC are obligated to pay the reinsurers their share of recoveries relating to losses during the coverage period in the covered portfolio. AGC, AGM and MAC paid approximately
$9 million
of premiums in 2016 for the term January 1, 2016 through December 31, 2016 and deposited approximately
$9 million
of securities into trust accounts for the benefit of the reinsurers to be used to pay the premium for January 1, 2017 through December 31, 2017. The main differences between the new facility and the prior facility that terminated on December 31, 2015 are the reinsurance attachment point (
$1.25 billion
versus
$1.5 billion
), the total reinsurance coverage (
$360 million
part of
$400 million
versus
$450 million
part of
$500 million
) and the annual premium (
$9 million
versus
$19 million
).
83
Table of Contents
14. Commitments and Contingencies
Legal Proceedings
Lawsuits arise in the ordinary course of the Company’s business. It is the opinion of the Company’s management, based upon the information available, that the expected outcome of litigation against the Company, individually or in the aggregate, will not have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial position or liquidity, although an adverse resolution of litigation against the Company in a fiscal quarter or year could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations in a particular quarter or year.
In addition, in the ordinary course of their respective businesses, certain of the Company's subsidiaries assert claims in legal proceedings against third parties to recover losses paid in prior periods or prevent losses in the future. For example, as described in the "Recovery Litigation" section of Note 5, Expected Loss to be Paid, in January 2016 the Company commenced an action for declaratory judgment and injunctive relief in the U.S. District Court for the District of Puerto Rico to invalidate executive orders issued by the Governor of Puerto Rico directing the retention or transfer of certain taxes and revenues pledged to secure the payment of certain bonds insured by the Company. Also, in December 2008, the Company filed a claim in the Supreme Court of the State of New York against an investment manager in a transaction it insured alleging breach of fiduciary duty, gross negligence and breach of contract. The amounts, if any, the Company will recover in proceedings to recover losses are uncertain, and recoveries, or failure to obtain recoveries, in any one or more of these proceedings during any quarter or year could be material to the Company’s results of operations in that particular quarter or year.
The Company establishes accruals for litigation and regulatory matters to the extent it is probable that a loss has been incurred and the amount of that loss can be reasonably estimated. For litigation and regulatory matters where a loss may be reasonably possible, but not probable, or is probable but not reasonably estimable, no accrual is established, but if the matter is material, it is disclosed, including matters discussed below. The Company reviews relevant information with respect to its litigation and regulatory matters on a quarterly, and annual basis and updates its accruals, disclosures and estimates of reasonably possible loss based on such reviews.
Litigation
Proceedings Relating to the Company’s Financial Guaranty Business
The Company receives subpoenas
duces tecum
and interrogatories from regulators from time to time.
On November 28, 2011, Lehman Brothers International (Europe) (in administration) (“LBIE”) sued AGFP, an affiliate of AGC which in the past had provided credit protection to counterparties under credit default swaps. AGC acts as the credit support provider of AGFP under these credit default swaps. LBIE’s complaint, which was filed in the Supreme Court of the State of New York, alleged that AGFP improperly terminated
nine
credit derivative transactions between LBIE and AGFP and improperly calculated the termination payment in connection with the termination of
28
other credit derivative transactions between LBIE and AGFP. Following defaults by LBIE, AGFP properly terminated the transactions in question in compliance with the agreement between AGFP and LBIE, and calculated the termination payment properly. AGFP calculated that LBIE owes AGFP approximately
$29 million
in connection with the termination of the credit derivative transactions, whereas LBIE asserted in the complaint that AGFP owes LBIE a termination payment of approximately
$1.4 billion
. On February 3, 2012, AGFP filed a motion to dismiss certain of the counts in the complaint, and on March 15, 2013, the court granted AGFP's motion to dismiss the count relating to improper termination of the
nine
credit derivative transactions and denied AGFP's motion to dismiss the counts relating to the remaining transactions. On February 22, 2016, AGFP filed a motion for summary judgment on the remaining causes of action asserted by LBIE and on AGFP's counterclaims. LBIE's administrators disclosed in an April 10, 2015 report to LBIE’s unsecured creditors that LBIE's valuation expert has calculated LBIE's damages in aggregate for the
28
transactions to range between a minimum of approximately
$200 million
and a maximum of approximately
$500 million
, depending on what adjustment, if any, is made for AGFP's credit risk and excluding any applicable interest. Notwithstanding the range calculated by LBIE's valuation expert, the Company cannot reasonably estimate the possible loss, if any, that may arise from this lawsuit.
On September 25, 2013, Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., as trust administrator of the MASTR Adjustable Rate Mortgages Trust 2007-3, filed an interpleader complaint in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York against AGM, among others, relating to the right of AGM to be reimbursed from certain cashflows for principal claims paid in respect of insured certificates. The Company estimates that an adverse outcome to the interpleader proceeding could increase losses on the transaction by approximately
$10
-
$20 million
, net of expected settlement payments and reinsurance in force.
84
Table of Contents
Proceedings Resolved Since December 31, 2015
On May 28, 2014, Houston Casualty Company Europe, Seguros y Reseguros, S.A. (“HCCE”) notified Radian Asset that it was demanding arbitration against Radian Asset in connection with housing cooperative losses presented to Radian Asset by HCCE under several years of quota-share surety reinsurance contracts. Through November 30, 2015, HCCE had presented AGC, as successor to Radian Asset, with approximately
€15 million
in claims. In January 2016, Assured Guaranty and HCCE settled all the claims related to the Spanish housing cooperative losses.
Proceedings Related to AGMH’s Former Financial Products Business
The following is a description of legal proceedings involving AGMH’s former Financial Products Business. Although the Company did not acquire AGMH’s former Financial Products Business, which included AGMH’s former GIC business, medium term notes business and portions of the leveraged lease businesses, certain legal proceedings relating to those businesses are against entities that the Company did acquire. While Dexia SA and Dexia Crédit Local S.A., jointly and severally, have agreed to indemnify the Company against liability arising out of the proceedings described below, such indemnification might not be sufficient to fully hold the Company harmless against any injunctive relief or civil or criminal sanction that is imposed against AGMH or its subsidiaries.
Governmental Investigations into Former Financial Products Business
AGMH and/or AGM have received subpoenas
duces tecum
and interrogatories or civil investigative demands from the Attorneys General of the States of Connecticut, Florida, Illinois, Massachusetts, Missouri, New York, Texas and West Virginia relating to their investigations of alleged bid rigging of municipal GICs. AGMH has been responding to such requests. AGMH may receive additional inquiries from these or other regulators and expects to provide additional information to such regulators regarding their inquiries in the future. In addition, AGMH received a subpoena from the Antitrust Division of the Department of Justice in November 2006 issued in connection with an ongoing criminal investigation of bid rigging of awards of municipal GICs and other municipal derivatives. Pursuant to that subpoena, AGMH has furnished to the Department of Justice records and other information with respect to AGMH’s municipal GIC business. The ultimate loss that may arise from these investigations remains uncertain.
Lawsuits Relating to Former Financial Products Business
During 2008,
nine
putative class action lawsuits were filed in federal court alleging federal antitrust violations in the municipal derivatives industry, seeking damages and alleging, among other things, a conspiracy to fix the pricing of, and manipulate bids for, municipal derivatives, including GICs. These cases have been coordinated and consolidated for pretrial proceedings in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York as
MDL 1950, In re Municipal Derivatives Antitrust Litigation,
Case No. 1:08-cv-2516 (“MDL 1950”).
Five
of these cases named both AGMH and AGM: (a)
Hinds County, Mississippi v. Wachovia Bank, N.A.
; (b)
Fairfax County, Virginia v. Wachovia Bank, N.A.
; (c)
Central Bucks School District, Pennsylvania v. Wachovia Bank, N.A.
; (d)
Mayor and City Council of Baltimore, Maryland v. Wachovia Bank, N.A.
; and (e)
Washington County, Tennessee v. Wachovia Bank, N.A.
In April 2009, the MDL 1950 court granted the defendants’ motion to dismiss on the federal claims for these
five
cases, but granted leave for the plaintiffs to file an amended complaint. The Corrected Third Consolidated Amended Class Action Complaint, filed on October 9, 2013, lists neither AGM nor AGMH as a named defendant or a co-conspirator. The complaint generally seeks unspecified monetary damages, interest, attorneys’ fees and other costs. The other
four
cases named AGMH (but not AGM) and also alleged that the defendants violated California state antitrust law and common law by engaging in illegal bid-rigging and market allocation, thereby depriving the cities or municipalities of competition in the awarding of GICs and ultimately resulting in the cities paying higher fees for these products: (f)
City of Oakland, California v. AIG Financial Products Corp.
; (g)
County of Alameda, California v. AIG Financial Products Corp.
; (h)
City of Fresno, California v. AIG Financial Products Corp.
; and (i)
Fresno County Financing Authority v. AIG Financial Products Corp
. When the
four
plaintiffs filed a consolidated complaint in September 2009, the plaintiffs did not name AGMH as a defendant. However, the complaint does describe some of AGMH’s and AGM’s activities. The consolidated complaint generally seeks unspecified monetary damages, interest, attorneys’ fees and other costs. In April 2010, the MDL 1950 court granted in part and denied in part the named defendants’ motions to dismiss this consolidated complaint. On September 22, 2015, the remaining parties to the putative class action reported to the MDL 1950 Court that settlements in principle had been reached, and a motion for preliminary approval of those putative class claims was filed on February 24, 2016. The parties have reported that final settlement with those remaining defendants would resolve the putative class case. The settlement fairness hearing for those putative class cases is scheduled for July 8, 2016. The Company cannot reasonably estimate the possible loss, if any, or range of loss that may arise from these lawsuits.
85
Table of Contents
In 2008, AGMH and AGM also were named in
five
non-class action lawsuits originally filed in the California Superior Courts alleging violations of California law related to the municipal derivatives industry: (a)
City of Los Angeles, California v. Bank of America, N.A.
; (b)
City of Stockton, California v. Bank of America, N.A.
; (c)
County of San Diego, California v. Bank of America, N.A.
; (d)
County of San Mateo, California v. Bank of America, N.A.
; and (e)
County of Contra Costa, California v. Bank of America, N.A.
Amended complaints in these actions were filed in September 2009, adding a federal antitrust claim and naming AGM (but not AGMH) and AGUS, among other defendants. These cases have been transferred to the Southern District of New York and consolidated with MDL 1950 for pretrial proceedings. In late 2009, AGM and AGUS, among other defendants, were named in
six
additional non-class action cases filed in federal court, which also have been coordinated and consolidated for pretrial proceedings with MDL 1950;
one
was voluntarily dismissed with prejudice in October 2010, leaving
five
that are currently pending: (f)
City of Riverside, California v. Bank of America, N.A.
; (g)
Los Angeles World Airports v. Bank of America, N.A.
; (h)
Redevelopment Agency of the City of Stockton v. Bank of America, N.A.
; (i)
Sacramento Suburban Water District v. Bank of America, N.A.
; and (j)
County of Tulare, California v. Bank of America, N.A.
The MDL 1950 court denied AGM and AGUS’s motions to dismiss the
eleven
complaints that were pending as of April 2010. Amended complaints were filed in May 2010. The complaints in these lawsuits generally seek or sought unspecified monetary damages, interest, attorneys’ fees, costs and other expenses. The Company cannot reasonably estimate the possible loss, if any, or range of loss that may arise from the remaining lawsuits.
In May 2010, AGM and AGUS, among other defendants, were named in
five
additional non-class action cases filed in federal court in California: (a)
City of Richmond, California v. Bank of America, N.A.
(filed on May 18, 2010, N.D. California); (b)
City of Redwood City, California v. Bank of America, N.A
. (filed on May 18, 2010, N.D. California); (c)
Redevelopment Agency of the City and County of San Francisco, California v. Bank of America, N.A.
(filed on May 21, 2010, N.D. California); (d)
East Bay Municipal Utility District, California v. Bank of America, N.A.
(filed on May 18, 2010, N.D. California);
and (e) City of San Jose and the San Jose Redevelopment Agency, California v. Bank of America, N.A
(filed on May 18, 2010, N.D. California). These cases have also been transferred to the Southern District of New York and consolidated with MDL 1950 for pretrial proceedings. In September 2010, AGM and AGUS, among other defendants, were named in a sixth additional non-class action filed in federal court in New York, but which alleges violation of New York’s Donnelly Act in addition to federal antitrust law:
Active Retirement Community, Inc. d/b/a Jefferson’s Ferry v. Bank of America, N.A.
(filed on September 21, 2010, E.D. New York), which has also been transferred to the Southern District of New York and consolidated with MDL 1950 for pretrial proceedings. In December 2010, AGM and AGUS, among other defendants, were named in a seventh additional non-class action filed in federal court in the Central District of California,
Los Angeles Unified School District v. Bank of America, N.A.
, and in an eighth additional non-class action filed in federal court in the Southern District of New York,
Kendal on Hudson, Inc. v. Bank of America, N.A.
These cases also have been consolidated with MDL 1950 for pretrial proceedings. The complaints in these lawsuits generally seek unspecified monetary damages, interest, attorneys’ fees, costs and other expenses. The Company cannot reasonably estimate the possible loss, if any, or range of loss that may arise from these lawsuits.
In January 2011, AGM and AGUS, among other defendants, were named in an additional non-class action case filed in federal court in New York, which alleges violation of New York’s Donnelly Act in addition to federal antitrust law:
Peconic Landing at Southold, Inc. v. Bank of America, N.A.
This case has been consolidated with MDL 1950 for pretrial proceedings. The complaint in this lawsuit generally seeks unspecified monetary damages, interest, attorneys’ fees, costs and other expenses. The Company cannot reasonably estimate the possible loss, if any, or range of loss that may arise from this lawsuit.
In September 2009, the Attorney General of the State of West Virginia filed a lawsuit (Circuit Ct. Mason County, W. Va.) against Bank of America, N.A. alleging West Virginia state antitrust violations in the municipal derivatives industry, seeking damages and alleging, among other things, a conspiracy to fix the pricing of, and manipulate bids for, municipal derivatives, including GICs. An amended complaint in this action was filed in June 2010, adding a federal antitrust claim and naming AGM (but not AGMH) and AGUS, among other defendants. This case has been removed to federal court as well as transferred to the S.D.N.Y. and consolidated with MDL 1950 for pretrial proceedings. AGM and AGUS answered West Virginia's Second Amended Complaint on November 11, 2013. The complaint in this lawsuit generally seeks civil penalties, unspecified monetary damages, interest, attorneys’ fees, costs and other expenses. The Company cannot reasonably estimate the possible loss, if any, or range of loss that may arise from this lawsuit.
86
Table of Contents
15.
Long-Term Debt and Credit Facilities
The principal and carrying values of the Company’s long-term debt are presented in the table below.
Principal and Carrying Amounts of Debt
As of March 31, 2016
As of December 31, 2015
Principal
Carrying
Value
Principal
Carrying
Value
(in millions)
AGUS:
7% Senior Notes
$
200
$
197
$
200
$
197
5% Senior Notes
500
496
500
495
Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures
150
150
150
150
Total AGUS
850
843
850
842
AGMH:
6
7
/
8
% QUIBS
100
69
100
69
6.25% Notes
230
140
230
140
5.6% Notes
100
56
100
56
Junior Subordinated Debentures
300
182
300
180
Total AGMH
730
447
730
445
AGM:
Notes Payable
11
12
12
13
Total AGM
11
12
12
13
Total
$
1,591
$
1,302
$
1,592
$
1,300
Recourse Credit Facilities
2009 Strip Coverage Facility
In connection with the Company's acquisition of AGMH and its subsidiaries from Dexia Holdings Inc., AGM agreed to retain the risks relating to the debt and strip policy portions of the leveraged lease business. The liquidity risk to AGM related to the strip policy portion of the leveraged lease business is mitigated by the strip coverage facility described below.
In a leveraged lease transaction, a tax-exempt entity (such as a transit agency) transfers tax benefits to a tax-paying entity by transferring ownership of a depreciable asset, such as subway cars. The tax-exempt entity then leases the asset back from its new owner.
If the lease is terminated early, the tax-exempt entity must make an early termination payment to the lessor. A portion of this early termination payment is funded from monies that were pre-funded and invested at the closing of the leveraged lease transaction (along with earnings on those invested funds). The tax-exempt entity is obligated to pay the remaining, unfunded portion of this early termination payment (known as the “strip coverage”) from its own sources. AGM issued financial guaranty insurance policies (known as “strip policies”) that guaranteed the payment of these unfunded strip coverage amounts to the lessor, in the event that a tax-exempt entity defaulted on its obligation to pay this portion of its early termination payment. AGM can then seek reimbursement of its strip policy payments from the tax-exempt entity, and can also sell the transferred depreciable asset and reimburse itself from the sale proceeds.
Currently, all the leveraged lease transactions in which AGM acts as strip coverage provider are breaching a rating trigger related to AGM and are subject to early termination. However, early termination of a lease does not result in a draw on the AGM policy if the tax-exempt entity makes the required termination payment. If all the leases were to terminate early and the tax-exempt entities do not make the required early termination payments, then AGM would be exposed to possible liquidity claims on gross exposure of approximately
$1.1 billion
as of
March 31, 2016
. To date, none of the leveraged lease transactions that involve AGM has experienced an early termination due to a lease default and a claim on the AGM policy. It is difficult to determine the probability that AGM will have to pay strip provider claims or the likely aggregate amount of such claims. At
March 31, 2016
, approximately
$1.4 billion
of cumulative strip par exposure had been terminated since 2008 on a consensual basis. The consensual terminations have resulted in no claims on AGM.
87
Table of Contents
On July 1, 2009, AGM and Dexia Crédit Local S.A., acting through its New York Branch (“Dexia Crédit Local (NY)”), entered into a credit facility (the “Strip Coverage Facility”). Under the Strip Coverage Facility, Dexia Crédit Local (NY) agreed to make loans to AGM to finance all draws made by lessors on AGM strip policies that were outstanding as of November 13, 2008, up to the commitment amount, which is currently
$495
million.
Fundings under this facility are subject to certain conditions precedent, and their repayment is collateralized by a security interest that AGM granted to Dexia Crédit Local (NY) in amounts that AGM recovers—from the tax-exempt entity, or from asset sale proceeds—following its payment of strip policy claims. On June 30, 2014, AGM and Dexia Crédit Local (NY) agreed to shorten the duration of the facility. Accordingly, the Strip Coverage Facility will terminate upon the earliest to occur of an AGM change of control, the reduction of the commitment amount to
$0
in accordance with the terms of the facility, and June 30, 2024 (rather than the original maturity date of January 31, 2042).
The Strip Coverage Facility’s financial covenants require that AGM and its subsidiaries maintain:
•
a maximum debt-to-capital ratio of
30%
; and
•
a minimum net worth of
75%
of consolidated net worth as of July 1, 2009, plus, beginning June 30, 2015 and on each anniversary of such date, an amount equal to the product of (i)
25%
of the aggregate consolidated net income (or loss) for the period beginning July 2, 2009 and ending on June 30, 2014 and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the commitment amount as of the relevant calculation date and the denominator of which is
$1 billion
.
The Company was in compliance with all financial covenants as of
March 31, 2016
.
The Strip Coverage Facility contains restrictions on AGM, including, among other things, in respect of its ability to incur debt, permit liens, pay dividends or make distributions, dissolve or become party to a merger or consolidation. Most of these restrictions are subject to exceptions. The Strip Coverage Facility has customary events of default, including (subject to certain materiality thresholds and grace periods) payment default, bankruptcy or insolvency proceedings and cross-default to other debt agreements.
As of
March 31, 2016
,
no
amounts were outstanding under this facility, nor have there been any borrowings during the life of this facility.
Intercompany Credit Facility and Intercompany Debt
On October 25, 2013, AGL, as borrower, and AGUS, as lender, entered into a revolving credit facility pursuant to which AGL may, from time to time, borrow for general corporate purposes. Under the credit facility, AGUS committed to lend a principal amount not exceeding
$225 million
in the aggregate. Such commitment terminates on October 25, 2018 (the “loan termination date”). The unpaid principal amount of each loan will bear interest at a fixed rate equal to
100%
of the then applicable Federal short-term or mid-term interest rate, as the case may be, as determined under Internal Revenue Code Sec. 1274(d), and interest on all loans will be computed for the actual number of days elapsed on the basis of a year consisting of 360 days. Accrued interest on all loans will be paid on the last day of each June and December, beginning on December 31, 2013, and at maturity. AGL must repay the then unpaid principal amounts of the loans by the third anniversary of the loan termination date.
No
amounts are currently outstanding under the credit facility.
In addition, in 2012 AGUS borrowed
$90 million
from its affiliate AGRO to fund the acquisition of MAC. That loan remained outstanding as of
March 31, 2016
.
Committed Capital Securities
On April 8, 2005, AGC entered into separate agreements (the “Put Agreements”) with
four
custodial trusts (each, a “Custodial Trust”) pursuant to which AGC may, at its option, cause each of the Custodial Trusts to purchase up to
$50 million
of perpetual preferred stock of AGC (the “AGC Preferred Stock”). The custodial trusts were created as a vehicle for providing capital support to AGC by allowing AGC to obtain immediate access to new capital at its sole discretion at any time through the exercise of the put option. If the put options were exercised, AGC would receive
$200 million
in return for the issuance of its own perpetual preferred stock, the proceeds of which may be used for any purpose, including the payment of claims. The put options have not been exercised through the date of this filing.
88
Table of Contents
Distributions on the AGC CCS are determined pursuant to an auction process. Beginning on April 7, 2008 this auction process failed, thereby increasing the annualized rate on the AGC CCS to
one-month LIBOR
plus
250
basis points.
In June 2003,
$200 million
of “AGM CPS”, money market preferred trust securities, were issued by trusts created for the primary purpose of issuing the AGM CPS, investing the proceeds in high-quality commercial paper and selling put options to AGM, allowing AGM to issue the trusts non-cumulative redeemable perpetual preferred stock (the “AGM Preferred Stock”) of AGM in exchange for cash. There are
four
trusts, each with an initial aggregate face amount of
$50 million
. These trusts hold auctions every
28
days, at which time investors submit bid orders to purchase AGM CPS. If AGM were to exercise a put option, the applicable trust would transfer the portion of the proceeds attributable to principal received upon maturity of its assets, net of expenses, to AGM in exchange for AGM Preferred Stock. AGM pays a floating put premium to the trusts, which represents the difference between the commercial paper yield and the winning auction rate (plus all fees and expenses of the trust). If an auction does not attract sufficient clearing bids, however, the auction rate is subject to a maximum rate of
one-month LIBOR
plus
200
basis points for the next succeeding distribution period. Beginning in August 2007, the AGM CPS required the maximum rate for each of the relevant trusts. AGM continues to have the ability to exercise its put option and cause the related trusts to purchase AGM Preferred Stock. The trusts provide AGM access to new capital at its sole discretion through the exercise of the put options. As of
March 31, 2016
the put option had not been exercised.
The Company does not consider itself to be the primary beneficiary of the trusts. See Note 7, Fair Value Measurement, –Other Assets–Committed Capital Securities, for a fair value measurement discussion.
16.
Earnings Per Share
Computation of Earnings Per Share
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Basic earnings per share ("EPS"):
Net income (loss) attributable to AGL
$
59
$
201
Less: Distributed and undistributed income (loss) available to nonvested shareholders
1
0
Distributed and undistributed income (loss) available to common shareholders of AGL and subsidiaries, basic
$
58
$
201
Basic shares
136.2
155.8
Basic EPS
$
0.43
$
1.29
Diluted EPS:
Distributed and undistributed income (loss) available to common shareholders of AGL and subsidiaries, basic
$
58
$
201
Plus: Re-allocation of undistributed income (loss) available to nonvested shareholders of AGL and subsidiaries
0
0
Distributed and undistributed income (loss) available to common shareholders of AGL and subsidiaries, diluted
$
58
$
201
Basic shares
136.2
155.8
Dilutive securities:
Options and restricted stock awards
0.8
1.0
Diluted shares
137.0
156.8
Diluted EPS
$
0.43
$
1.28
Potentially dilutive securities excluded from computation of EPS because of antidilutive effect
0.8
0.7
89
Table of Contents
17.
Shareholders' Equity
Other Comprehensive Income
The following tables present the changes in each component of accumulated other comprehensive income ("AOCI") and the effect of reclassifications out of AOCI on the respective line items in net income.
Changes in Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income by Component
First Quarter
2016
Net Unrealized
Gains (Losses) on
Investments with no Other-Than-Temporary Impairment
Net Unrealized
Gains (Losses) on
Investments with Other-Than-Temporary Impairment
Cumulative
Translation
Adjustment
Cash Flow Hedge
Total Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income
(in millions)
Balance, December 31, 2015
$
260
$
(15
)
$
(16
)
$
8
$
237
Other comprehensive income (loss) before reclassifications
95
(17
)
(2
)
—
76
Amounts reclassified from AOCI to:
Net realized investment gains (losses)
(4
)
17
—
—
13
Net investment income
(3
)
—
—
—
(3
)
Interest expense
—
—
—
0
0
Total before tax
(7
)
17
—
0
10
Tax (provision) benefit
2
(6
)
—
0
(4
)
Total amount reclassified from AOCI, net of tax
(5
)
11
—
0
6
Net current period other comprehensive income (loss)
90
(6
)
(2
)
0
82
Balance, March 31, 2016
$
350
$
(21
)
$
(18
)
$
8
$
319
90
Table of Contents
Changes in Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income by Component
First Quarter
2015
Net Unrealized
Gains (Losses) on
Investments with no Other-Than-Temporary Impairment
Net Unrealized
Gains (Losses) on
Investments with Other-Than-Temporary Impairment
Cumulative
Translation
Adjustment
Cash Flow Hedge
Total Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income
(in millions)
Balance, December 31, 2014
$
367
$
4
$
(10
)
$
9
$
370
Other comprehensive income (loss) before reclassifications
18
(2
)
(5
)
—
11
Amounts reclassified from AOCI to:
Net realized investment gains (losses)
(20
)
4
—
—
(16
)
Interest expense
—
—
—
(1
)
(1
)
Total before tax
(20
)
4
—
(1
)
(17
)
Tax (provision) benefit
7
(1
)
—
0
6
Total amount reclassified from AOCI, net of tax
(13
)
3
—
(1
)
(11
)
Net current period other comprehensive income (loss)
5
1
(5
)
(1
)
0
Balance, March 31, 2015
$
372
$
5
$
(15
)
$
8
$
370
Share Repurchase
The following table presents share repurchases by quarter since January 2013.
Share Repurchases
Period
Number of Shares Repurchased
Total Payments(in millions)
Average Price Paid Per Share
2013
12,512,759
$
264
$
21.12
2014
24,413,781
590
24.17
2015 (January 1 - March 31)
5,860,291
152
25.87
2015 (April 1 - June 30)
4,737,388
133
28.13
2015 (July 1 - September 30)
5,362,103
135
25.17
2015 (October 1 - December 31)
5,035,637
135
26.81
Total 2015
20,995,419
555
26.43
2016 (January 1 - March 31)
3,038,928
75
24.69
2016 (April 1 - through May 4, 2016)
793,672
20
25.20
Total 2016
3,832,600
95
24.80
Cumulative repurchases since the beginning of 2013
61,754,559
$
1,504
$
24.36
On February 24, 2016, the Board of Directors approved a
$250 million
share repurchase authorization. The Company expects to repurchase shares from time to time in the open market or in privately negotiated transactions. The timing, form and amount of the share repurchases under the program are at the discretion of management and will depend on a variety of factors, including funds available at the parent company, market conditions, the Company's capital position, legal requirements and other factors. The repurchase program may be modified, extended or terminated by the Board of Directors at any time. It does not have an expiration date. As of
March 31, 2016
, the Company's remaining share repurchase authorization was
$230 million
, and as of May 4, 2016, it was approximately
$210 million
.
91
Table of Contents
18.
Subsidiary Information
The following tables present the condensed consolidating financial information for AGUS and AGMH, 100%-owned subsidiaries of AGL, which have issued publicly traded debt securities (see Note 15, Long Term Debt and Credit Facilities). The information for AGL, AGUS and AGMH presents its subsidiaries on the equity method of accounting.
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING BALANCE SHEET
AS OF
MARCH 31, 2016
(in millions)
Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Parent)
AGUS
(Issuer)
AGMH
(Issuer)
Other
Entities
Consolidating
Adjustments
Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Consolidated)
ASSETS
Total investment portfolio and cash
$
80
$
94
$
23
$
11,489
$
(360
)
$
11,326
Investment in subsidiaries
6,003
5,570
4,077
389
(16,039
)
—
Premiums receivable, net of commissions payable
—
—
—
792
(130
)
662
Ceded unearned premium reserve
—
—
—
1,236
(1,000
)
236
Deferred acquisition costs
—
—
—
172
(59
)
113
Reinsurance recoverable on unpaid losses
—
—
—
491
(419
)
72
Credit derivative assets
—
—
—
163
(108
)
55
Deferred tax asset, net
—
40
—
368
(130
)
278
Intercompany receivable
—
—
—
90
(90
)
—
Financial guaranty variable interest entities’ assets, at fair value
—
—
—
1,191
—
1,191
Other
34
46
28
645
(234
)
519
TOTAL ASSETS
$
6,117
$
5,750
$
4,128
$
17,026
$
(18,569
)
$
14,452
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
Unearned premium reserves
$
—
$
—
$
—
$
4,914
$
(1,104
)
$
3,810
Loss and LAE reserve
—
—
—
1,605
(493
)
1,112
Long-term debt
—
842
447
13
—
1,302
Intercompany payable
—
90
—
300
(390
)
—
Credit derivative liabilities
—
—
—
597
(108
)
489
Deferred tax liabilities, net
—
—
90
—
(90
)
—
Financial guaranty variable interest entities’ liabilities, at fair value
—
—
—
1,284
—
1,284
Other
4
26
18
655
(361
)
342
TOTAL LIABILITIES
4
958
555
9,368
(2,546
)
8,339
TOTAL SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY ATTRIBUTABLE TO ASSURED GUARANTY LTD.
6,113
4,792
3,573
7,269
(15,634
)
6,113
Noncontrolling interest
—
—
—
389
(389
)
—
TOTAL SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY
6,113
4,792
3,573
7,658
(16,023
)
6,113
TOTAL LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
$
6,117
$
5,750
$
4,128
$
17,026
$
(18,569
)
$
14,452
92
Table of Contents
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING BALANCE SHEET
AS OF
DECEMBER 31, 2015
(in millions)
Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Parent)
AGUS
(Issuer)
AGMH
(Issuer)
Other
Entities
Consolidating
Adjustments
Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Consolidated)
ASSETS
Total investment portfolio and cash
$
10
$
156
$
22
$
11,530
$
(360
)
$
11,358
Investment in subsidiaries
5,961
5,569
4,081
377
(15,988
)
—
Premiums receivable, net of commissions payable
—
—
—
833
(140
)
693
Ceded unearned premium reserve
—
—
—
1,266
(1,034
)
232
Deferred acquisition costs
—
—
—
176
(62
)
114
Reinsurance recoverable on unpaid losses
—
—
—
467
(398
)
69
Credit derivative assets
—
—
—
207
(126
)
81
Deferred tax asset, net
—
52
—
357
(133
)
276
Intercompany receivable
—
—
—
90
(90
)
—
Financial guaranty variable interest entities’ assets, at fair value
—
—
—
1,261
—
1,261
Other
98
29
26
571
(264
)
460
TOTAL ASSETS
$
6,069
$
5,806
$
4,129
$
17,135
$
(18,595
)
$
14,544
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
Unearned premium reserves
$
—
$
—
$
—
$
5,143
$
(1,147
)
$
3,996
Loss and LAE reserve
—
—
—
1,537
(470
)
1,067
Long-term debt
—
842
445
13
—
1,300
Intercompany payable
—
90
—
300
(390
)
—
Credit derivative liabilities
—
—
—
572
(126
)
446
Deferred tax liabilities, net
—
—
91
—
(91
)
—
Financial guaranty variable interest entities’ liabilities, at fair value
—
—
—
1,349
—
1,349
Other
6
82
15
622
(402
)
323
TOTAL LIABILITIES
6
1,014
551
9,536
(2,626
)
8,481
TOTAL SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY ATTRIBUTABLE TO ASSURED GUARANTY LTD.
6,063
4,792
3,578
7,222
(15,592
)
6,063
Noncontrolling interest
—
—
—
377
(377
)
—
TOTAL SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
6,063
4,792
3,578
7,599
(15,969
)
6,063
TOTAL LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
$
6,069
$
5,806
$
4,129
$
17,135
$
(18,595
)
$
14,544
93
Table of Contents
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
AND COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED
MARCH 31, 2016
(in millions)
Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Parent)
AGUS
(Issuer)
AGMH
(Issuer)
Other
Entities
Consolidating
Adjustments
Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Consolidated)
REVENUES
Net earned premiums
$
—
$
—
$
—
$
192
$
(9
)
$
183
Net investment income
0
0
0
100
(1
)
99
Net realized investment gains (losses)
0
—
—
(12
)
(1
)
(13
)
Net change in fair value of credit derivatives:
Realized gains (losses) and other settlements
—
—
—
8
0
8
Net unrealized gains (losses)
—
—
—
(68
)
—
(68
)
Net change in fair value of credit derivatives
—
—
—
(60
)
0
(60
)
Bargain purchase gain and settlement of pre-existing relationships
—
—
—
—
—
—
Other
0
—
—
36
—
36
TOTAL REVENUES
0
0
0
256
(11
)
245
EXPENSES
Loss and LAE
—
—
—
93
(3
)
90
Amortization of deferred acquisition costs
—
—
—
7
(3
)
4
Interest expense
—
13
13
3
(3
)
26
Other operating expenses
8
0
1
52
(1
)
60
TOTAL EXPENSES
8
13
14
155
(10
)
180
INCOME (LOSS) BEFORE INCOME TAXES AND EQUITY IN NET EARNINGS OF SUBSIDIARIES
(8
)
(13
)
(14
)
101
(1
)
65
Total (provision) benefit for income taxes
—
5
5
(16
)
0
(6
)
Equity in net earnings of subsidiaries
67
50
77
9
(203
)
—
NET INCOME (LOSS)
$
59
$
42
$
68
$
94
$
(204
)
$
59
Less: noncontrolling interest
—
—
—
9
(9
)
—
NET INCOME (LOSS) ATTRIBUTABLE TO ASSURED GUARANTY LTD.
$
59
$
42
$
68
$
85
$
(195
)
$
59
COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)
$
141
$
80
$
92
$
178
$
(350
)
$
141
94
Table of Contents
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
AND COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED
MARCH 31, 2015
(in millions)
Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Parent)
AGUS
(Issuer)
AGMH
(Issuer)
Other
Entities
Consolidating
Adjustments
Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Consolidated)
REVENUES
Net earned premiums
$
—
$
—
$
—
$
140
$
2
$
142
Net investment income
0
0
0
104
(3
)
101
Net realized investment gains (losses)
0
0
0
19
(3
)
16
Net change in fair value of credit derivatives:
Realized gains (losses) and other settlements
—
—
—
21
0
21
Net unrealized gains (losses)
—
—
—
103
—
103
Net change in fair value of credit derivatives
—
—
—
124
0
124
Other
—
—
—
(14
)
—
(14
)
TOTAL REVENUES
0
0
0
373
(4
)
369
EXPENSES
Loss and LAE
—
—
—
18
0
18
Amortization of deferred acquisition costs
—
—
—
6
(2
)
4
Interest expense
—
13
13
4
(5
)
25
Other operating expenses
8
0
0
48
0
56
TOTAL EXPENSES
8
13
13
76
(7
)
103
INCOME (LOSS) BEFORE INCOME TAXES AND EQUITY IN NET EARNINGS OF SUBSIDIARIES
(8
)
(13
)
(13
)
297
3
266
Total (provision) benefit for income taxes
—
5
5
(72
)
(3
)
(65
)
Equity in net earnings of subsidiaries
209
163
92
9
(473
)
—
NET INCOME (LOSS)
$
201
$
155
$
84
$
234
$
(473
)
$
201
Less: noncontrolling interest
—
—
—
9
(9
)
—
NET INCOME (LOSS) ATTRIBUTABLE TO ASSURED GUARANTY LTD.
$
201
$
155
$
84
$
225
$
(464
)
$
201
COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)
$
201
$
134
$
80
$
233
$
(447
)
$
201
95
Table of Contents
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED
MARCH 31, 2016
(in millions)
Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Parent)
AGUS
(Issuer)
AGMH
(Issuer)
Other
Entities
Consolidating
Adjustments
Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Consolidated)
Net cash flows provided by (used in) operating activities
$
166
$
17
$
88
$
(74
)
$
(287
)
$
(90
)
Cash flows from investing activities
Fixed-maturity securities:
Purchases
(4
)
(11
)
—
(281
)
—
(296
)
Sales
1
—
—
161
—
162
Maturities
—
—
—
301
—
301
Sales (purchases) of short-term investments, net
(69
)
11
—
(5
)
—
(63
)
Net proceeds from financial guaranty variable entities’ assets
—
—
—
66
—
66
Intercompany debt
—
—
—
—
—
—
Investment in subsidiary
—
—
—
—
—
—
Other
—
—
—
2
—
2
Net cash flows provided by (used in) investing activities
(72
)
0
—
244
—
172
Cash flows from financing activities
Return of capital
—
—
—
—
—
—
Dividends paid
(18
)
(80
)
(87
)
(120
)
287
(18
)
Repurchases of common stock
(75
)
—
—
—
—
(75
)
Share activity under option and incentive plans
0
—
—
—
—
0
Net paydowns of financial guaranty variable entities’ liabilities
—
—
—
(42
)
—
(42
)
Payment of long-term debt
—
—
—
0
—
0
Intercompany debt
—
—
—
—
—
—
Other
—
—
—
(1
)
—
(1
)
Net cash flows provided by (used in) financing activities
(93
)
(80
)
(87
)
(163
)
287
(136
)
Effect of exchange rate changes
—
—
—
0
—
0
Increase (decrease) in cash
1
(63
)
1
7
—
(54
)
Cash at beginning of period
0
95
8
63
—
166
Cash at end of period
$
1
$
32
$
9
$
70
$
—
$
112
96
Table of Contents
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED
MARCH 31, 2015
(in millions)
Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Parent)
AGUS
(Issuer)
AGMH
(Issuer)
Other
Entities
Consolidating
Adjustments
Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Consolidated)
Net cash flows provided by (used in) operating activities
$
97
$
127
$
59
$
34
$
(294
)
$
23
Cash flows from investing activities
Fixed-maturity securities:
Purchases
—
(46
)
(6
)
(396
)
—
(448
)
Sales
—
122
11
708
—
841
Maturities
—
4
—
151
—
155
Sales (purchases) of short-term investments, net
79
43
19
279
—
420
Net proceeds from financial guaranty variable entities’ assets
—
—
—
30
—
30
Intercompany debt
—
(200
)
—
—
200
—
Investment in subsidiary
—
—
25
—
(25
)
—
Other
—
—
—
3
—
3
Net cash flows provided by (used in) investing activities
79
(77
)
49
775
175
1,001
Cash flows from financing activities
Return of capital
—
—
—
(25
)
25
—
Dividends paid
(19
)
(50
)
(108
)
(136
)
294
(19
)
Repurchases of common stock
(152
)
—
—
—
—
(152
)
Share activity under option and incentive plans
(5
)
—
—
—
—
(5
)
Net paydowns of financial guaranty variable entities’ liabilities
—
—
—
(39
)
—
(39
)
Payment of long-term debt
—
—
—
(1
)
—
(1
)
Intercompany debt
—
—
—
200
(200
)
—
Other
—
—
—
4
—
4
Net cash flows provided by (used in) financing activities
(176
)
(50
)
(108
)
3
119
(212
)
Effect of exchange rate changes
—
—
—
(2
)
—
(2
)
Increase (decrease) in cash
—
—
—
810
—
810
Cash at beginning of period
0
—
4
71
—
75
Cash at end of period
$
0
$
—
$
4
$
881
$
—
$
885
97
Table of Contents
ITEM 2.
MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
Forward Looking Statements
This Form 10-Q contains information that includes or is based upon forward looking statements within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Forward looking statements give the expectations or forecasts of future events of Assured Guaranty Ltd. (“AGL”) and its subsidiaries (collectively with AGL, “Assured Guaranty” or the “Company”). These statements can be identified by the fact that they do not relate strictly to historical or current facts and relate to future operating or financial performance.
Any or all of Assured Guaranty’s forward looking statements herein are based on current expectations and the current economic environment and may turn out to be incorrect. Assured Guaranty’s actual results may vary materially. Among factors that could cause actual results to differ adversely are:
•
rating agency action, including a ratings downgrade, a change in outlook, the placement of ratings on watch for downgrade, or a change in rating criteria, at any time, of AGL or any of its subsidiaries, and/or of any securities AGL or any of its subsidiaries have issued, and/or of transactions that AGL's subsidiaries have insured;
•
reduction in the amount of available insurance opportunities and/or in the demand for Assured Guaranty's insurance;
•
developments in the world’s financial and capital markets that adversely affect obligors’ payment rates, Assured Guaranty’s loss experience, or its exposure to refinancing risk in transactions (which could result in substantial liquidity claims on its guarantees);
•
the possibility that budget or pension shortfalls or other factors will result in credit losses or impairments on obligations of state, territorial and local governments and their related authorities and public corporations that Assured Guaranty insures or reinsures;
•
the failure of Assured Guaranty to realize loss recoveries that are assumed in its expected loss estimates;
•
deterioration in the financial condition of Assured Guaranty’s reinsurers, the amount and timing of reinsurance recoverables actually received and the risk that reinsurers may dispute amounts owed to Assured Guaranty under its reinsurance agreements;
•
increased competition, including from new entrants into the financial guaranty industry;
•
rating agency action on obligors, including sovereign debtors, resulting in a reduction in the value of securities in Assured Guaranty’s investment portfolio and in collateral posted by and to Assured Guaranty;
•
the inability of Assured Guaranty to access external sources of capital on acceptable terms;
•
changes in the world’s credit markets, segments thereof, interest rates or general economic conditions;
•
the impact of market volatility on the mark-to-market of Assured Guaranty’s contracts written in credit default swap form;
•
changes in applicable accounting policies or practices;
•
changes in applicable laws or regulations, including insurance, bankruptcy and tax laws, or other governmental actions;
•
difficulties with the execution of Assured Guaranty’s business strategy;
•
loss of key personnel;
•
the effects of mergers, acquisitions and divestitures;
•
natural or man-made catastrophes;
•
other risks and uncertainties that have not been identified at this time;
98
Table of Contents
•
management’s response to these factors; and
•
other risk factors identified in AGL's filings with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”).
The foregoing review of important factors should not be construed as exhaustive, and should be read in conjunction with the other cautionary statements that are included in this Form 10-Q, as well as the risk factors included in AGL's 2015 Annual Report on Form 10-K. The Company undertakes no obligation to update publicly or review any forward looking statement, whether as a result of new information, future developments or otherwise, except as required by law. Investors are advised, however, to consult any further disclosures the Company makes on related subjects in the Company’s reports filed with the SEC.
If one or more of these or other risks or uncertainties materialize, or if the Company’s underlying assumptions prove to be incorrect, actual results may vary materially from what the Company projected. Any forward looking statements in this Form 10-Q reflect the Company’s current views with respect to future events and are subject to these and other risks, uncertainties and assumptions relating to its operations, results of operations, growth strategy and liquidity.
For these statements, the Company claims the protection of the safe harbor for forward looking statements contained in Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”).
Available Information
The Company maintains an Internet web site at
www.assuredguaranty.com
. The Company makes available, free of charge, on its web site (under
assuredguaranty.com/sec-filings
) the Company's annual report on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, and amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13 (a) or 15 (d) of the Exchange Act as soon as reasonably practicable after the Company files such material with, or furnishes it to, the SEC. The Company also makes available, free of charge, through its web site (under
assuredguaranty.com/governance
) links to the Company's Corporate Governance Guidelines, its Code of Conduct, AGL's Bye-Laws and the charters for its Board committees.
The Company routinely posts important information for investors on its web site (under
assuredguaranty.com/company-statements
and, more generally, under the Investor Information and Businesses pages). The Company uses this web site as a means of disclosing material information and for complying with its disclosure obligations under SEC Regulation FD (Fair Disclosure). Accordingly, investors should monitor the Company Statements, Investor Information and Businesses portions of the Company's web site, in addition to following the Company's press releases, SEC filings, public conference calls, presentations and webcasts.
The information contained on, or that may be accessed through, the Company's web site is not incorporated by reference into, and is not a part of, this report.
Executive Summary
This executive summary of management’s discussion and analysis highlights selected information and may not contain all of the information that is important to readers of this Quarterly Report. For a more detailed description of events, trends and uncertainties, as well as the capital, liquidity, credit, operational and market risks and the critical accounting policies and estimates affecting the Company, this Quarterly Report should be read in its entirety and in addition to AGL's 2015 Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Economic Environment
The amount and pricing of new business the Company originates as well as the financial health of the issuers whose obligations it insures depends in part on the economic environment in the markets it serves, including the level of interest rates and credit spreads in those markets.
99
Table of Contents
The overall economic environment in the United States ("U.S.") continued improving during the three-month period ended
March 31, 2016
("
First Quarter 2016
"). The U.S. Department of Commerce Bureau of Economic Analysis reported that gross domestic product increased at an annual rate of 0.5% in
First Quarter 2016
. According to the U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics (“BLS”), the estimated unemployment rate fell to 4.9% in January and February, the lowest monthly level since April 2008, and rose slightly to 5.0% in March. The BLS also reported that the U.S. economy added more than 430,000 jobs during the first three months of 2016, a 2% increase over the comparable prior-year period. U.S. home prices, as measured by the Case-Shiller Index, continued to rise across the country over the last 12 months, although the pace of growth has slowed year-over-year.
The Federal Open Market Committee (“FOMC”) position has maintained the target range for the federal funds rate at 1/4 to 1/2 percent and continues to support further improvement in labor market conditions and a return to 2% inflation. The U.S. stock market opened the new year in decline, with some commentators attributing the decline to global economic uncertainty and weak oil prices that threatened certain U.S. companies. The U.S. stock market rose in February after the Federal Reserve board chair indicated in Congressional testimony that further increases in the federal funds rate would be gradual, and as oil prices began to recover. Average municipal interest rates in
First Quarter 2016
were similar to those of first quarter 2015 and 25 basis points lower than the full-year average for 2015, based on the 30-year AAA MMD Index.
The European Central Bank continued its program of quantitative easing during
First Quarter 2016
and started to expand monthly purchases under the asset purchase program to €80 billion on April 1. Interest rates for European bank deposits remain at 0%.
100
Table of Contents
Financial Performance of Assured Guaranty
Financial Results
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Net income (loss)
$
59
$
201
Operating income(1)
113
140
Net income (loss) per diluted share
0.43
1.28
Operating income per share(1)
0.82
0.89
Diluted shares
137.0
156.8
Present value of new business production (“PVP”)(1)
$
38
$
36
Gross par written
2,749
2,708
As of March 31, 2016
As of December 31, 2015
Amount
Per Share
Amount
Per Share
(in millions, except per share amounts)
Shareholders' equity
$
6,113
$
45.26
$
6,063
$
43.96
Operating shareholders' equity(1)
5,954
44.08
5,946
43.11
Adjusted book value(1)
8,294
61.40
8,439
61.18
Common shares outstanding (2)
135.1
137.9
____________________
(1)
Please refer to “—Non-GAAP Financial Measures” for a definition of the financial measures that were not determined in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“GAAP”) and a reconciliation of the non-GAAP financial measure to the most directly comparable GAAP measure, if available.
(2)
Please refer to "Key Business Strategies – Capital Management" below for information on common share repurchases.
First Quarter 2016
There are several primary drivers of volatility in net income or loss that are not necessarily indicative of credit impairment or improvement, or ultimate economic gains or losses: changes in credit spreads of insured credit derivative obligations; changes in fair value of assets and liabilities of financial guaranty variable interest entities ("FG VIEs") and committed capital securities ("CCS"); changes in the Company's own credit spreads; and changes in risk-free rates used to discount expected losses. Changes in credit spreads generally have the most significant effect on the fair value of credit derivatives and FG VIE assets and liabilities. In addition to non-economic factors, other factors such as: changes in expected losses, the amount and timing of refunding transactions and terminations, realized gains and losses on the investment portfolio (including other-than-temporary impairments), the effects of large settlements and transactions, acquisitions, and the effects of the Company's various loss mitigation strategies, among others, may also have a significant effect on reported net income or loss in a given reporting period.
Net income for
First Quarter 2016
was
$59 million
compared with
$201 million
in the three-month period ended
March 31, 2015
("
First Quarter 2015
"). The decrease was due primarily attributable to fair value losses on credit derivatives in
First Quarter 2016
compared with gains in
First Quarter 2015
, higher loss and loss adjustment expenses ("LAE") attributable mainly to Puerto Rico, partially offset by higher net earned premiums due to refundings and terminations and a benefit due to loss mitigation recoveries recorded in other income. The fair value losses on credit derivatives were primarily due to the decreased cost to purchase protection on Assured Guaranty Corp. ("AGC") and Assured Guaranty Municipal Corp. ("AGM").
Non-GAAP operating income in
First Quarter 2016
was
$113 million
, compared with
$140 million
in
First Quarter 2015
. The decrease in operating income was primarily due to higher expected losses on certain Puerto Rico exposures, partially offset by higher net earned premiums due to refundings and terminations and a benefit due to loss mitigation recoveries recorded in other income.
101
Table of Contents
Key Business Strategies
The Company continually evaluates its business strategies. Currently, the Company is pursuing the following business strategies, each described in more detail below:
•
New business production
•
Capital management
•
Alternative strategies to create value, including through acquisitions and commutations
•
Loss mitigation
New Business Production
The Company believes high-profile defaults by municipal obligors, such as Detroit, Michigan and Stockton, California, both of which filed for protection under chapter 9 of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code, and the deteriorating financial condition of Puerto Rico, have led to increased awareness of the value of bond insurance and stimulated demand for the product. The Company believes there will be continued demand for its insurance in this market because, for those exposures that the Company guarantees, it undertakes the tasks of credit selection, analysis, negotiation of terms, surveillance and, if necessary, loss mitigation. The Company believes that its insurance:
•
encourages retail investors, who typically have fewer resources than the Company for analyzing municipal bonds, to purchase such bonds;
•
enables institutional investors to operate more efficiently; and
•
allows smaller, less well-known issuers to gain market access on a more cost-effective basis.
On the other hand, the persistently low interest rate environment continues to dampen demand for bond insurance and, after a number of years in which the Company was essentially the only financial guarantor, there are now two other financial guarantors active in one of its markets.
U.S. Municipal Market Data
Based on Sale Date
First Quarter 2016
First Quarter 2015
Year Ended December 31, 2015
Par
Number of
issues
Par
Number of
issues
Par
Number of
issues
(dollars in billions, except number of issues)
New municipal bonds issued
$
96.5
2,787
$
103.9
3,057
$
377.6
12,076
Total insured
5.7
430
6.0
517
25.2
1,880
Insured by Assured Guaranty
3.0
198
3.4
276
15.1
1,009
Industry Penetration Rates
U.S. Municipal Market
First Quarter
Year Ended December 31,
2016
2015
2015
Market penetration par
5.9%
5.7%
6.7%
Market penetration based on number of issues
15.4
16.9
15.6
% of single A par sold
28.0
21.6
22.1
% of single A transactions sold
58.7
55.2
54.1
% of $25 million and under par sold
17.7
19.8
18.7
% of $25 million and under transactions sold
17.7
19.8
17.6
102
Table of Contents
New Business Production
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
PVP (1):
Public Finance—U.S.
$
31
$
13
Public Finance—non-U.S.
7
—
Structured Finance—U.S.
—
18
Structured Finance—non-U.S.
—
5
Total PVP
$
38
$
36
Gross Par Written:
Public Finance—U.S.
$
2,749
$
2,441
Public Finance—non-U.S.
—
—
Structured Finance—U.S.
—
261
Structured Finance—non-U.S.
—
6
Total gross par written
$
2,749
$
2,708
____________________
(1)
PVP and Gross Par Written in the table above are based on "close date," when the transaction settles. See “– Non-GAAP Financial Measures – PVP or Present Value of New Business Production.”
U.S. public finance PVP increased to $31 million in
First Quarter 2016
from $13 million in
First Quarter 2015
representing an increase of 138%. The average premium rate increased compared with
First Quarter 2015
while the average rating of par written remained in the A- category. During
First Quarter 2016
, Assured Guaranty once again guaranteed the majority of insured par issued.
Non-U.S. public finance PVP in
First Quarter 2016
represents additional future premiums related to the restructuring of an existing insured obligation.
Outside the U.S., the Company believes the United Kingdom ("U.K.") currently presents the most new business opportunities for financial guarantees of infrastructure financings, which have typically required such guarantees for capital market access. These transactions typically have long lead times. Assured Guaranty believes it is the only company in the private sector offering such financial guarantees outside the United States.
In general, the Company expects that structured finance opportunities will increase in the future as the global economy recovers, interest rates rise, more issuers return to the capital markets for financings and institutional investors again utilize financial guaranties. The Company considers its involvement in both structured finance and international infrastructure transactions to be beneficial because such transactions diversify both the Company's business opportunities and its risk profile beyond public finance.
Capital Management
In recent years, the Company has developed strategies to manage capital within the Assured Guaranty group more efficiently.
In February 2016, the Company exhausted its previous $400 million common share repurchase authorization and on February 24, 2016, the Board of Directors approved an incremental $250 million share repurchase authorization. The Company expects the repurchases to be made from time to time in the open market or in privately negotiated transactions. The timing, form and amount of the share repurchases under the program are at the discretion of management and will depend on a variety of factors, including free funds available at the parent company, market conditions, the Company's capital position, legal requirements and other factors. The repurchase program may be modified, extended or terminated by the Board of Directors at any time. It does not have an expiration date. See Note 17, Shareholders' Equity, of the Financial Statements, for additional information about the Company's repurchases of its common shares.
In
First Quarter 2016
, the Company repurchased a total of 3.0 million common shares for approximately
$75 million
at an average price of
$24.69
per share.
103
Table of Contents
Summary of Share Repurchases
Amount
Number of Shares
Average price per share
(in millions, except per share data)
2013
$
264
12.5
$
21.12
2014
590
24.4
24.17
2015
555
21.0
26.43
2016 (through May 4, 2016)
95
3.8
24.80
Cumulative repurchases since the beginning of 2013
$
1,504
61.7
24.36
Accretive Effect of Cumulative Repurchases(1)
First Quarter
2016
2015
As of March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
(per share)
Net income
$
0.08
$
0.25
Operating income
0.20
0.18
Shareholders' equity
$
6.43
$
5.75
Operating shareholders' equity
6.07
5.49
Adjusted book value
11.45
10.83
_________________
(1)
Cumulative repurchases since the beginning of 2013.
As of May 4, 2016,
$210 million
of total capacity remained from the authorization, on a settlement basis.
In order to reduce leverage, and possibly rating agency capital charges, the Company has mutually agreed with beneficiaries to terminate selected financial guaranty insurance and credit derivative contracts. In particular, the Company has targeted investment grade securities for which claims are not expected but which carry a disproportionately large rating agency capital charge. The Company terminated investment grade securities of $1.9 billion and $0.1 billion in net par in
First Quarter 2016
and
First Quarter 2015
, respectively, of financial guaranty and credit default swap ("CDS") contracts.
Alternative Strategies
The Company considers alternative strategies in order to create long-term shareholder value. For example, the Company considers opportunities to acquire financial guaranty portfolios, whether by acquiring financial guarantors who are no longer actively writing new business or their insured portfolios, or by commuting business that it had previously ceded. These transactions enable the Company to improve its future earnings and deploy some of its excess capital.
On April 12, 2016, AGC entered into an agreement and plan of merger to acquire CIFG Holding Inc. ("CIFG"), the parent of financial guaranty insurer CIFG Assurance North America, Inc. ("CIFG NA"). AGC expects to pay
$450 million
in cash to acquire CIFG, subject to adjustments as contemplated in the agreement, and the acquisition is expected to be completed mid-2016, subject to receipt of anti-trust and insurance regulatory approvals as well as satisfaction of customary closing conditions. CIFG’s stockholders have already approved the acquisition. As part of the transaction, CIFG NA will merge into AGC, which will be the surviving entity. As of December 31, 2015, CIFG had a consolidated insured portfolio of
$5.6 billion
of net par and approximately
$637 million
of consolidated qualified statutory capital.
On April 1, 2015 (the "Acquisition Date"), AGC completed the acquisition of Radian Asset Acquisition for a cash purchase price of $804.5 million. In connection with the acquisition, AGC acquired Radian Asset’s entire insured portfolio, which resulted in an increase in net par outstanding as of the Acquisition Date of approximately $13.6 billion, consisting of $9.4 billion public finance net par outstanding and $4.2 billion structured finance net par outstanding. In 2015, the acquisition contributed net income of approximately $2.46 per share and operating income of approximately $2.13 per share, including the bargain purchase gain,
104
Table of Contents
settlement of pre-existing relationships and activity since the Acquisition Date. Shareholders' equity benefited by $1.04 per share, operating shareholders' equity benefited by $1.26 per share and adjusted book value benefited by $3.73 per share as of the Acquisition Date.
Loss Mitigation
In an effort to avoid or reduce potential losses in its insurance portfolios, the Company employs a number of strategies.
In the public finance area, the Company believes that its experience and the resources it is prepared to deploy, as well as its ability to provide bond insurance or other contributions as part of a solution, has resulted in more favorable outcomes in distressed public finance situations than would have been the case without its participation, as illustrated, for example, by the Company's role in the Detroit, Michigan; Stockton, California; and Jefferson County, Alabama financial crises. Currently, the Company is an active participant in discussions with the Commonwealth of Puerto Rico and its advisors with respect to a number of Puerto Rico credits. For example, on December 24, 2015, AGC and AGM entered into a Restructuring Support Agreement (“RSA”) with Puerto Rico Electric Power Authority ("PREPA"), an ad hoc group of uninsured bondholders and a group of fuel-line lenders that would, subject to certain conditions, result in, among other things, modernization of the utility and a restructuring of current debt. Legislation meeting the requirements of the RSA was enacted on February 16, 2016. The closing of the restructuring transaction, the issuance of the surety bonds and the closing of the bridge financing are subject to certain conditions, including confirmation that the enacted legislation meets all requirements of the RSA and execution of acceptable documentation and legal opinions. There can be no assurance that the conditions in the RSA will be met or that, if the conditions are met, the RSA's other provisions, including those related to the restructuring of the insured PREPA revenue bonds, will be implemented. In addition, there also can be no assurance that the negotiations with respect to other Puerto Rico credits will result in agreements on a consensual recovery plans.
The Company is currently working with the servicers of some of the residential mortgage-backed securities ("RMBS") it insures to encourage the servicers to provide alternatives to distressed borrowers that will encourage them to continue making payments on their loans and so improve the performance of the related RMBS. Many of the HELOC loans underlying the HELOC RMBS are entering their amortization periods, which results in material increases to the size of the monthly payments the borrowers are required to make.
The Company also continues to purchase attractively priced obligations, including below-investment-grade ("BIG") obligations, that it has insured and for which it has expected losses to be paid, in order to mitigate the economic effect of insured losses ("loss mitigation securities"). These purchases resulted in a reduction of net expected loss to be paid of $584 million as of
March 31, 2016
. The fair value of assets purchased for loss mitigation purposes as of
March 31, 2016
(excluding the value of the Company's insurance) was $986 million, with a par of $1,862 million (including bonds related to FG VIEs of $153 million in fair value and $286 million in par).
In some instances, the terms of the Company's policy gives it the option to pay principal on an accelerated basis, thereby reducing the amount of guaranteed interest due in the future. The Company has at times exercised this option, which uses cash but reduces projected future losses.
In an effort to recover losses the Company experienced in its insured U.S. RMBS portfolio, the Company also pursued providers of representations and warranties ("R&W") by enforcing R&W provisions in contracts, negotiating agreements with R&W providers relating to those provisions and, where appropriate, initiating litigation against R&W providers. While the Company has completed its pursuit of R&W claims, it continues to benefit from the agreements reached. See Note 5, Expected Loss to be Paid, of the Financial Statements.
Results of Operations
Estimates and Assumptions
The Company’s consolidated financial statements include amounts that are determined using estimates and assumptions. The actual amounts realized could ultimately be materially different from the amounts currently provided for in the Company’s consolidated financial statements. Management believes the most significant items requiring inherently subjective and complex estimates are expected losses, fair value estimates, other-than-temporary impairment, deferred income taxes, and premium revenue recognition. The following discussion of the results of operations includes information regarding the estimates and assumptions used for these items and should be read in conjunction with the notes to the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
105
Table of Contents
An understanding of the Company’s accounting policies is of critical importance to understanding its consolidated financial statements. See Part II, Item 8. “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for a discussion of significant accounting policies, loss estimation process, approach to projecting U.S. RMBS, and and fair value methodologies.
The Company carries a portion of its assets and liabilities at fair value, the majority of which are measured at fair value on a recurring basis. Level 3 assets, consisting primarily of financial guaranty variable interest entities’ assets, credit derivative assets, and investments, represented approximately 19% and 20% of total assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, respectively. All of the Company's liabilities that are measured at fair value are Level 3. See Note 7, Fair Value Measurement, of the Financial Statements for additional information about assets and liabilities classified as Level 3.
Consolidated Results of Operations
Consolidated Results of Operations
Three Months Ended March 31,
2016
2015
(in millions)
Revenues:
Net earned premiums
$
183
$
142
Net investment income
99
101
Net realized investment gains (losses)
(13
)
16
Net change in fair value of credit derivatives:
Realized gains (losses) and other settlements
8
21
Net unrealized gains (losses)
(68
)
103
Net change in fair value of credit derivatives
(60
)
124
Fair value gains (losses) on CCS
(16
)
2
Fair value gains (losses) on FG VIEs
18
(7
)
Other income (loss)
34
(9
)
Total revenues
245
369
Expenses:
Loss and LAE
90
18
Amortization of deferred acquisition costs
4
4
Interest expense
26
25
Other operating expenses
60
56
Total expenses
180
103
Income (loss) before provision for income taxes
65
266
Provision (benefit) for income taxes
6
65
Net income (loss)
$
59
$
201
106
Table of Contents
Net Earned Premiums
Net earned premiums are recognized over the contractual lives, or in the case of homogeneous pools of insured obligations, the remaining expected lives, of financial guaranty insurance contracts. The Company estimates remaining expected lives of its insured obligations and makes prospective adjustments for such changes in expected lives. Scheduled net earned premiums are expected to decrease each year unless replaced by a higher amount of new business, reassumptions of previously ceded business or books of business acquired in a business combination. See "Financial Guaranty Insurance Premiums" in Note 6, Financial Guaranty Insurance, of the Financial Statements, for additional information and the expected timing of future premium earnings.
Net Earned Premiums
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Financial guaranty:
Public finance
Scheduled net earned premiums and accretion
$
69
$
66
Accelerations(1)
79
40
Total public finance
148
106
Structured finance(2)
Scheduled net earned premiums and accretion
25
34
Accelerations(1)
10
1
Total structured finance
35
35
Other
0
1
Total net earned premiums
$
183
$
142
____________________
(1)
Reflects the unscheduled refunding or termination of the insurance on an insured obligation as well as changes in scheduled earnings due to changes in the expected lives of the insured obligations.
(2)
Excludes
$5 million
and
$5 million
for
First Quarter
2016
and
2015
, respectively related to consolidated FG VIEs.
Net earned premiums increased in
First Quarter 2016
compared with
First Quarter 2015
due primarily to higher accelerations and to net earned premiums related to the acquisition of Radian Asset, offset by the scheduled decline in structured finance par outstanding, as shown in the table above.
At
March 31, 2016
,
$3.6 billion
of net deferred premium revenue remained to be earned over the life of the insurance contracts.
107
Table of Contents
Net Investment Income
Net investment income is a function of the yield that the Company earns on invested assets and the size of the portfolio. The investment yield is a function of market interest rates at the time of investment as well as the type, credit quality and maturity of the invested assets.
Net Investment Income (1)
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Income from fixed-maturity securities managed by third parties
$
79
$
82
Income from internally managed securities:
Fixed maturities
17
15
Other
5
6
Gross investment income
101
103
Investment expenses
(2
)
(2
)
Net investment income
$
99
$
101
____________________
(1)
Net investment income excludes $5 million and $3 million for
First Quarter
2016
and
2015
, respectively, related to consolidated FG VIEs.
Net investment income decreased due to lower average investment balances and lower book yield. The overall pre-tax book yield was 3.65% as of
March 31, 2016
and 3.76% as of
March 31, 2015
, respectively. Excluding the internally managed portfolio, pre-tax book yield was 3.45% as of
March 31, 2016
compared with 3.55% as of
March 31, 2015
.
Net Realized Investment Gains (Losses)
The table below presents the components of net realized investment gains (losses). See Note 10, Investments and Cash, of the Financial Statements.
Net Realized Investment Gains (Losses)
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Gross realized gains on the investment portfolio
$
6
$
25
Gross realized losses on the investment portfolio
(3
)
(2
)
Other-than-temporary impairment
(16
)
(7
)
Net realized investment gains (losses)
$
(13
)
$
16
Other-than-temporary-impairments in First Quarter 2016 and First Quarter 2015 were primarily attributable to securities purchased for loss mitigation purposes. Realized gains on the investment portfolio in
First Quarter
2015
were due primarily to sales of securities in order to fund the purchase of Radian Asset by AGC.
Other Income (Loss)
Other income (loss) is comprised of recurring items such as foreign exchange remeasurement gains and losses, ancillary fees on financial guaranty policies such as commitment, consent and processing fees, and if applicable, other revenue items on financial guaranty insurance and reinsurance contracts such as commutation gains on re-assumptions of previously ceded business, loss mitigation recoveries and certain non-recurring items.
108
Table of Contents
Other Income (Loss)
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Foreign exchange gain (loss) on remeasurement of premium receivable and loss reserves
$
(2
)
$
(13
)
Other (1)
36
4
Total other income (loss)
$
34
$
(9
)
____________________
(1)
Other in
First Quarter
2016
represents primarily a benefit due to loss mitigation recoveries.
Economic Loss Development
The insured portfolio includes policies accounted for under three separate accounting models depending on the characteristics of the contract and the Company’s control rights. Please refer to Note 5, Expected Loss to be Paid, of the Financial Statements, for a discussion of the assumptions and methodologies used in calculating the expected loss to be paid for all contracts. For a discussion of the loss estimation process, approach to projecting losses in the U.S. RMBS portfolio and the measurement and recognition accounting policies under GAAP for each type of contract, see the following in Item 8, Financial Statements and Supplementary Data of the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K:
•
Note 5 for expected loss to be paid,
•
Note 6 for financial guaranty insurance,
•
Note 7 for fair value methodologies for credit derivatives and FG VIE assets and liabilities,
•
Note 8 for credit derivatives, and
•
Note 9 for consolidated FG VIEs.
The discussion of losses that follows encompasses losses on all contracts in the insured portfolio regardless of accounting model, unless otherwise specified. In order to effectively evaluate and manage the economics of the entire insured portfolio, management compiles and analyzes expected loss information for all policies on a consistent basis. That is, management monitors and assigns ratings and calculates expected losses in the same manner for all its exposures. Management also considers contract specific characteristics that affect the estimates of expected loss.
The surveillance process for identifying transactions with expected losses is described in the notes to the consolidated financial statements. More extensive monitoring and intervention is employed for all BIG surveillance categories, with internal credit ratings reviewed quarterly.
Net expected loss to be paid consists primarily of the present value of future: expected claim and loss adjustment expenses ("LAE") payments, expected recoveries from excess spread and other collateral in the transaction structures, cessions to reinsurers, and expected recoveries for breaches of R&W and the effects of other loss mitigation strategies. Current risk free rates are used to discount expected losses at the end of each reporting period and therefore changes in such rates from period to period affect the expected loss estimates reported. Assumptions used in the determination of the net expected loss to be paid such as delinquency, severity, and discount rates and expected timeframes to recovery in the mortgage market were consistent by sector regardless of the accounting model used. The primary drivers of economic loss development are discussed below. Changes in risk free rates used to discount losses affect economic loss development, loss and LAE, and non-GAAP loss expense; however the effect of changes in discount rates are not indicative of actual credit impairment or improvement in the period.
The primary differences between net economic loss development and loss and LAE reported under GAAP are that GAAP:
•
considers deferred premium revenue in the calculation of loss reserves and loss expense for financial guaranty insurance contracts,
•
eliminates losses related to FG VIEs and
•
does not include estimated losses on credit derivatives.
109
Table of Contents
Loss expense reported in operating income (i.e. non-GAAP loss expense) includes losses on financial guaranty insurance, credit derivatives and FG VIEs.
For financial guaranty insurance contracts, a GAAP loss is generally recorded only when expected losses exceed deferred premium revenue. Therefore, the timing of loss recognition in income does not necessarily coincide with the timing of the actual credit impairment or improvement reported in net economic loss development. Transactions acquired in a business combination generally have the largest deferred premium revenue balances because of the purchase accounting adjustments made at acquisition. Therefore the largest differences between net economic loss development and loss expense relate to these policies. See "—Loss and LAE (Financial Guaranty Insurance Contracts)" below.
Net Expected Loss to be Paid
As of
March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
(in millions)
Public finance
$
903
$
809
Structured finance
U.S. RMBS before benefit for recoveries for breaches of R&W
340
488
Net benefit for recoveries for breaches of R&W (1)
(47
)
(79
)
U.S. RMBS after benefit for recoveries for breaches of R&W
293
409
Other structured finance
141
173
Structured finance
434
582
Total
$
1,337
$
1,391
____________________
(1)
As of March 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, the remaining estimated benefit for recoveries for breaches of R&W are subject to contractual settlement agreements. The Company is no longer actively pursuing any R&W providers for breaches.
Economic Loss Development (Benefit) (1)
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Public finance
$
99
$
6
Structured finance
U.S. RMBS before benefit for recoveries for breaches of R&W
(50
)
(47
)
Net benefit for recoveries for breaches of R&W
19
51
U.S. RMBS after benefit for recoveries for breaches of R&W
(31
)
4
Other structured finance
(9
)
(13
)
Structured finance
(40
)
(9
)
Total
$
59
$
(3
)
____________________
(1)
Economic loss development includes the effects of changes in assumptions based on observed market trends, changes in discount rates, accretion of discount and the economic effects of loss mitigation efforts.
First Quarter
2016 Net Economic Loss Development
Total economic loss development of $59 million in
First Quarter 2016
was generated mainly by the U.S. public finance sector, partially offset by a net benefit in the structured finance sector. The risk-free rates used to discount expected losses ranged from
0.0%
to
2.88%
as of
March 31, 2016
and
0.0%
to
3.25%
as of
December 31, 2015
. The effect of the change in the risk-free rates used to discount expected losses was a loss of
$63 million
in
First Quarter 2016
.
110
Table of Contents
U.S. Public Finance Economic Loss Development:
The net par outstanding for U.S. public finance obligations rated BIG by the Company was
$8.0 billion
as of
March 31, 2016
compared with $7.8 billion as of
December 31, 2015
. The Company projects that its total net expected loss across its troubled U.S. public finance credits as of
March 31, 2016
will be
$864 million
, compared with $771 million as of
December 31, 2015
. Economic loss development in
First Quarter 2016
was
$98 million
, which was primarily attributable to Puerto Rico exposures. See "Insured Portfolio-Exposure to Puerto Rico" below for details about significant developments that have taken place in Puerto Rico.
U.S. RMBS Economic Loss Development:
The net benefit attributable to U.S. RMBS was $31 million due mainly to the acceleration of claim payments as a means of mitigating future losses on certain Alt-A transactions.
Other Structured Finance Economic Loss Development:
The net benefit attributable to structured finance (excluding U.S. RMBS) was $9 million, due primarily to the commutation of certain assumed student loan exposures.
First Quarter 2015
Net Economic Loss Development
Total economic loss development was a favorable $3 million in
First Quarter 2015
, due primarily to performance improvements in trust preferred securities ("TruPS") and student loans, offset by modest increases in loss estimates on certain Puerto Rico exposures. The risk-free rates used to discount expected losses ranged from 0.0% to 2.89% as of March 31, 2015 and 0.0% to 2.95% as of December 31, 2014. Please refer to Note 5, Expected Loss to be Paid, of the Financial Statements, for additional information.
U.S. Public Finance Economic Loss Development:
The net par outstanding for U.S. public finance obligations rated BIG by the Company was $7.9 billion as of March 31, 2015 compared with $7.9 billion as of December 31, 2014. The Company projected that its total net expected loss across its troubled U.S. public finance credits as of March 31, 2015 would be $310 million, compared with $303 million as of December 31, 2014. Economic loss development in
First Quarter 2015
was approximately $9 million, which was primarily attributable to certain Puerto Rico exposures.
U.S. RMBS Economic Loss Development:
The net economic development attributable to U.S. RMBS of $4 million was primarily due to modest underlying collateral deterioration. Certain of the Company's insured U.S. RMBS transactions benefited from a third-party settlement, which transactions are also covered by one of the Company's existing R&W settlement agreements. The resulting improvement in projected cash flows of the underlying transactions reduced the expected R&W benefit under the Company's settlement agreement. The net benefit of these agreements, after R&W, was $7 million in
First Quarter 2015
.
Loss and LAE (Financial Guaranty Insurance Contracts)
For transactions accounted for as financial guaranty insurance under GAAP, each transaction’s expected loss to be expensed, net of estimated recoveries, is compared with the deferred premium revenue of that transaction. Generally, when the expected loss to be expensed exceeds the deferred premium revenue, a loss is recognized in the income statement for the amount of such excess. When the Company measures operating income, a non-GAAP financial measure, it calculates the credit derivative and FG VIE losses incurred in a similar manner.
While expected loss to be paid is an important liquidity measure that provides the present value of amounts that the Company expects to pay or recover in future periods on all contracts, expected loss to be expensed is important because it presents the Company’s projection of incurred losses that will be recognized in future periods as deferred premium revenue amortizes into income on financial guaranty insurance policies. Expected loss to be paid for FG VIEs pursuant to AGC’s and AGM’s financial guaranty policies is calculated in a manner consistent with financial guaranty insurance contracts, but eliminated in consolidation under GAAP.
111
Table of Contents
The following table presents the loss and LAE recorded in the consolidated statements of operations. These amounts are based on economic loss development and expected losses to be paid for financial guaranty insurance contracts only, and the amortization of the related unearned premium reserve on a transaction by transaction basis. Amounts presented are net of reinsurance.
Loss and LAE Reported
on the Consolidated Statements of Operations
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Public finance
$
97
$
18
Structured finance:
U.S. RMBS
11
7
Other structured finance
(11
)
(2
)
Structured finance
0
5
Total insurance contracts before FG VIE consolidation
97
23
Effect of consolidating FG VIEs
(7
)
(5
)
Total loss and LAE (1)
$
90
$
18
____________________
(1)
Excludes credit derivative benefit of $6 million for
First Quarter 2016
and credit derivative benefit of $12 million for
First Quarter 2015
, which are included in non-GAAP loss expense.
Loss and LAE in
First Quarter 2016
was mainly driven by higher loss reserves on certain Puerto Rico exposures partially offset by a benefit from the commutations of certain assumed student loan exposures.
In
First Quarter 2015
, losses incurred were due primarily to increased loss estimates on certain Puerto Rico exposures, partially offset by a benefit in student loans and insured TruPS transactions.
For financial guaranty contracts accounted for as insurance, the amounts reported in the GAAP financial statements may only reflect a portion of the current period’s economic loss development and may also include a portion of prior-period economic loss development. The difference between economic loss development on financial guaranty insurance contracts and loss and LAE recognized in GAAP income relates to the effect of taking deferred premium revenue into account for GAAP loss and LAE, which is not considered in economic loss development.
The table below presents the expected timing of loss recognition for insurance contracts on both a reported GAAP net income and non-GAAP operating income basis.
112
Table of Contents
Financial Guaranty Insurance
Net Expected Loss to be Expensed
As of
March 31, 2016
In GAAP
Reported
Income
In Non-GAAP
Operating
Income (1)
(in millions)
2016 (April 1 – June 30)
$
11
$
14
2016 (July 1 – September 30)
10
12
2016 (October 1 – December 31)
9
12
2017
34
42
2018
33
41
2019
30
36
2020
27
33
2021-2025
100
117
2026-2030
70
78
2031-2035
45
54
After 2035
20
24
Net expected loss to be expensed
389
463
Future accretion
156
189
Total expected future loss and LAE
$
545
$
652
____________________
(1)
Net expected loss to be expensed for GAAP reported income is different than operating income, a non-GAAP financial measure, by the amount related to consolidated FG VIEs and credit derivatives.
Net Change in Fair Value of Credit Derivatives
Changes in the fair value of credit derivatives occur primarily because of changes in interest rates, credit spreads, notional amounts, credit ratings of the referenced entities, expected terms, realized gains (losses) and other settlements, and the issuing company's own credit rating and credit spreads, and other market factors. With considerable volatility continuing in the market, unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives may fluctuate significantly in future periods.
Except for net estimated credit impairments (i.e., net expected payments), the unrealized gains and losses on credit derivatives are expected to reduce to zero as the exposure approaches its maturity date. Changes in the fair value of the Company’s credit derivatives that do not reflect actual or expected claims or credit losses have no impact on the Company’s statutory claims-paying resources, rating agency capital or regulatory capital positions. Expected losses to be paid in respect of contracts accounted for as credit derivatives are included in the discussion above “—Economic Loss Development.”
The impact of changes in credit spreads will vary based upon the volume, tenor, interest rates, and other market conditions at the time these fair values are determined. In addition, since each transaction has unique collateral and structural terms, the underlying change in fair value of each transaction may vary considerably. The fair value of credit derivative contracts also reflects the change in the Company’s own credit cost based on the price to purchase credit protection on AGC and AGM. The Company determines its own credit risk based on quoted CDS prices traded on the Company at each balance sheet date. Generally, a widening of credit spreads of the underlying obligations results in unrealized losses and the tightening of credit spreads of the underlying obligations results in unrealized gains. A widening of the CDS prices traded on AGC and AGM has an effect of offsetting unrealized losses that result from widening general market credit spreads, while a narrowing of the CDS prices traded on AGC and AGM has an effect of offsetting unrealized gains that result from narrowing general market credit spreads.
The valuation of the Company’s credit derivative contracts requires the use of models that contain significant, unobservable inputs, and are classified as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy. The models used to determine fair value are primarily developed internally based on market conventions for similar transactions that the Company observed in the past. There has been very limited new issuance activity in this market over the past several years and as of
March 31, 2016
, market prices for the Company’s credit derivative contracts were generally not available. Inputs to the estimate of fair value include
113
Table of Contents
various market indices, credit spreads, the Company’s own credit spread, and estimated contractual payments. See Note 7, Fair Value Measurement, of the Financial Statements for additional information.
Net Change in Fair Value of Credit Derivatives Gain (Loss)
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Realized gains on credit derivatives
$
10
$
23
Net credit derivative losses (paid and payable) recovered and recoverable and other settlements
(2
)
(2
)
Realized gains (losses) and other settlements on credit derivatives (1)
8
21
Net change in unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives:
Pooled corporate obligations
(48
)
17
U.S. RMBS
(15
)
75
CMBS
0
0
Other
(5
)
11
Net change in unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives
(68
)
103
Net change in fair value of credit derivatives
$
(60
)
$
124
____________________
(1)
Includes realized gains and losses due to terminations and settlements of CDS contracts.
Net Par and Realized Gains
from Terminations and Settlements of Credit Derivative Contracts
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Net par of terminated credit derivative contracts
$
—
$
93
Realized gains on credit derivatives
0
11
During
First Quarter 2016
, unrealized fair value losses were generated primarily in the trust preferred, and U.S. RMBS prime first lien and subprime sectors, due to wider implied net spreads. The wider implied net spreads were primarily a result of the decreased cost to buy protection on AGC and AGM, particularly for the one year and five year CDS spread. These transactions were pricing at or above their floor levels (or the minimum rate at which the Company would consider assuming these risks based on historical experience); therefore when the cost of purchasing CDS protection on AGC and AGM, which management refers to as the CDS spread on AGC and AGM, decreased the implied spreads that the Company would expect to receive on these transactions increased. Unrealized fair value losses in the Other Sector were generated primarily by a price decline on a hedge the Company has against another financial guarantor. These losses were partially offset by an unrealized fair value gain on a terminated toll road securitization.
During
First Quarter 2015
, unrealized fair value gains were generated primarily in the U.S. RMBS prime first lien and adjustable rate mortgage ("Option ARM") sectors. The change in fair value of credit derivatives in First Quarter 2015 was primarily due to a refinement in methodology to address an instance in a U.S. RMBS transaction that changed from an expected loss to an expected recovery position. This refinement resulted in approximately
$49 million
in fair value gains in
First Quarter 2015
. In addition, there were unrealized gains in the TruPS CDO and Other sectors as result of price improvements on the underlying collateral. The changes in the Company’s CDS spreads did not have a material impact during the quarter.
114
Table of Contents
CDS Spread on AGC and AGM
Quoted price of CDS contract (in basis points)
As of
March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
As of
March 31, 2015
As of
December 31, 2014
Five-year CDS spread:
AGC
307
376
317
323
AGM
309
366
341
325
One-year CDS spread
AGC
105
139
60
80
AGM
102
131
80
85
Effect of Changes in the Company’s Credit Spread on
Unrealized Gains (Losses) on Credit Derivatives
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Change in unrealized gains (losses) of credit derivatives:
Before considering implication of the Company’s credit spreads
$
(27
)
$
111
Resulting from change in the Company’s credit spreads
(41
)
(8
)
After considering implication of the Company’s credit spreads
$
(68
)
$
103
Management believes that the trading level of AGC’s and AGM’s credit spreads is due to the correlation between AGC’s and AGM’s risk profile, the current risk profile of the broader financial markets, and to increased demand for credit protection against AGC and AGM as the result of its financial guaranty volume, as well as the overall lack of liquidity in the CDS market. Offsetting the benefit attributable to AGC’s and AGM’s credit spread were higher credit spreads in the fixed income security markets relative to pre-financial crisis levels. The higher credit spreads in the fixed income security market are due to the lack of liquidity in the high-yield collateralized debt obligations ("CDO"), TruPS CDOs, and collateralized loan obligation ("CLO") markets as well as continuing market concerns over the 2005-2007 vintages of RMBS.
Financial Guaranty Variable Interest Entities
As of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, the Company consolidated
33
and 34 VIEs, respectively. The table below presents the effects on reported GAAP income resulting from consolidating these FG VIEs and eliminating their related insurance and investment accounts and, in total, represents a difference between GAAP reported net income and non-GAAP operating income attributable to FG VIEs. The consolidation of FG VIEs has a significant effect on net income and shareholders' equity due to:
•
changes in fair value gains (losses) on FG VIE assets and liabilities,
•
the eliminations of premiums and losses related to the AGC and AGM FG VIE liabilities with recourse, and
•
the elimination of investment balances related to the Company’s purchase of AGC and AGM insured FG VIE debt.
Upon consolidation of a FG VIE, the related insurance and, if applicable, the related investment balances, are considered intercompany transactions and therefore eliminated. See “—Non-GAAP Financial Measures—Operating Income” below and Note 9, Consolidated Variable Interest Entities, of the Financial Statements for more details.
115
Table of Contents
Effect of Consolidating FG VIEs on Net Income
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Net earned premiums
$
(5
)
$
(5
)
Net investment income
(5
)
(3
)
Net realized investment gains (losses)
1
0
Fair value gains (losses) on FG VIEs
18
(7
)
Loss and LAE
6
5
Effect on income before tax
15
(10
)
Less: tax provision (benefit)
5
(4
)
Effect on net income (loss)
$
10
$
(6
)
Fair value gains (losses) on FG VIEs represent the net change in fair value on the consolidated FG VIEs’ assets and liabilities. During
First Quarter 2016
, the Company recorded a pre-tax net fair value gain on consolidated FG VIEs of
$18 million
. The primary driver of the gain was price appreciation on the FG VIE assets during the quarter resulting from improvements in the underlying collateral.
During
First Quarter 2015
, the Company recorded a pre-tax net fair value loss on consolidated FG VIEs of
$7 million
. The primary driver of the loss was a pre-tax net fair value loss of
$26 million
on the consolidation of
one
new FG VIE. The net fair value loss on consolidation was partially offset by net gains due to price appreciation on the FG VIE assets during the quarter resulting from improvements in the underlying collateral.
Provision for Income Tax
Provision for Income Taxes and Effective Tax Rates
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Total provision (benefit) for income taxes
$
6
$
65
Effective tax rate
10.0
%
24.2
%
The Company’s effective tax rates reflect the proportion of income recognized by each of the Company’s operating subsidiaries, with U.S. subsidiaries taxed at the U.S. marginal corporate income tax rate of
35%
, U.K. subsidiaries taxed at the U.K. marginal corporate tax rate of
20%
unless subject to U.S. tax by election or as a U.S. controlled foreign corporation, and no taxes for the Company’s Bermuda subsidiaries unless subject to U.S tax by election or as a U.S. controlled foreign corporation. The Company’s overall corporate effective tax rate fluctuates based on the distribution of taxable income across these jurisdictions. In each of the periods presented, the portion of taxable income from each jurisdiction varied. The non-taxable book to tax differences were consistent as compared to the prior period. The effective tax rate is lower in 2016, due to a higher ratio of tax exempt investment income to pre-tax income.
Non-GAAP Financial Measures
To reflect the key financial measures management analyzes in evaluating the Company’s operations and progress towards long-term goals, the Company discusses both measures determined in accordance with GAAP and measures not promulgated in accordance with GAAP (“non-GAAP financial measures”). Although the financial measures identified as non-GAAP should not be considered substitutes for GAAP measures, management considers them key performance indicators and employs them as well as other factors in determining compensation. Non-GAAP financial measures, therefore, provide investors with important information about the key financial measures management utilizes in measuring its business. The primary limitation of non-GAAP financial measures is the potential lack of comparability to those of other companies, which may define non-GAAP measures differently because there is limited literature with respect to such measures. Three of the primary non-GAAP financial measures analyzed by the Company’s senior management are: operating income, adjusted book value and PVP.
116
Table of Contents
Management and the board of directors utilize non-GAAP financial measures in evaluating the Company’s financial performance. By providing these non-GAAP financial measures, the Company gives investors, analysts and financial news reporters access to the same information that management reviews internally. In addition, Assured Guaranty’s presentation of non-GAAP financial measures is consistent with how analysts calculate their estimates of Assured Guaranty’s financial results in their research reports on Assured Guaranty and with how investors, analysts and the financial news media evaluate Assured Guaranty’s financial results.
The following paragraphs define each non-GAAP financial measure and describe why it is useful. A reconciliation of the non-GAAP financial measure and the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure, is also presented below.
Operating Income
Management believes that operating income is a useful measure because it clarifies the understanding of the underwriting results of the Company’s financial guaranty business, and also includes financing costs and net investment income, and enables investors and analysts to evaluate the Company’s financial results as compared with the consensus analyst estimates distributed publicly by financial databases. Operating income is defined as net income (loss) attributable to AGL, as reported under GAAP, adjusted for the following:
1)
Elimination of the after-tax realized gains (losses) on the Company’s investments, except for gains and losses on securities classified as trading. The timing of realized gains and losses, which depends largely on market credit cycles, can vary considerably across periods. The timing of sales is largely subject to the Company’s discretion and influenced by market opportunities, as well as the Company’s tax and capital profile. Trends in the underlying profitability of the Company’s business can be more clearly identified without the fluctuating effects of these transactions.
2)
Elimination of the after-tax non-credit-impairment unrealized fair value gains (losses) on credit derivatives, which is the amount in excess of the present value of the expected estimated economic credit losses, and non-economic payments. Such fair value adjustments are heavily affected by, and in part fluctuate with, changes in market interest rates, credit spreads and other market factors and are not expected to result in an economic gain or loss. Additionally, such adjustments present all financial guaranty contracts on a more consistent basis of accounting, whether or not they are subject to derivative accounting rules.
3)
Elimination of the after-tax fair value gains (losses) on the Company’s CCS. Such amounts are heavily affected by, and in part fluctuate with, changes in market interest rates, credit spreads and other market factors and are not expected to result in an economic gain or loss.
4)
Elimination of the after-tax foreign exchange gains (losses) on remeasurement of net premium receivables and loss and LAE reserves. Long-dated receivables constitute a significant portion of the net premium receivable balance and represent the present value of future contractual or expected collections. Therefore, the current period’s foreign exchange remeasurement gains (losses) are not necessarily indicative of the total foreign exchange gains (losses) that the Company will ultimately recognize.
5)
Elimination of the effects of consolidating FG VIEs in order to present all financial guaranty contracts on a more consistent basis of accounting, whether or not GAAP requires consolidation. GAAP requires the Company to consolidate certain VIEs that have issued debt obligations insured by the Company even though the Company does not own such VIEs.
117
Table of Contents
Reconciliation of Net Income (Loss)
to Operating Income
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Net income (loss)
$
59
$
201
Less after-tax adjustments:
Realized gains (losses) on investments
(9
)
9
Non-credit impairment unrealized fair value gains (losses) on credit derivatives
(43
)
66
Fair value gains (losses) on CCS
(10
)
1
Foreign exchange gains (losses) on remeasurement of premiums receivable and loss and LAE reserves
(2
)
(9
)
Effect of consolidating FG VIEs
10
(6
)
Operating income
$
113
$
140
Effective tax rate on operating income
20.3
%
22.1
%
Adjusted Book Value and Operating Shareholders’ Equity
Management also uses adjusted book value to measure the intrinsic value of the Company, excluding franchise value. Growth in adjusted book value per share is one of the key financial measures used in determining the amount of certain long term compensation to management and employees and used by rating agencies and investors.
Management believes that operating shareholders’ equity is a useful measure because it presents the equity of the Company with all financial guaranty contracts accounted for on a more consistent basis and excludes fair value adjustments that are not expected to result in economic gain or loss. Many investors, analysts and financial news reporters use operating shareholders’ equity as the principal financial measure for valuing AGL’s current share price or projected share price and also as the basis of their decision to recommend, buy or sell AGL’s common shares. Many of the Company’s fixed income investors also use operating shareholders’ equity to evaluate the Company’s capital adequacy. Operating shareholders’ equity is the basis of the calculation of adjusted book value (see below). Operating shareholders’ equity is defined as shareholders’ equity attributable to AGL, as reported under GAAP, adjusted for the following:
1)
Elimination of the effects of consolidating FG VIEs in order to present all financial guaranty contracts on a more consistent basis of accounting, whether or not GAAP requires consolidation. GAAP requires the Company to consolidate certain VIEs that have issued debt obligations insured by the Company even though the Company does not own such VIEs.
2)
Elimination of the after-tax non-credit-impairment unrealized fair value gains (losses) on credit derivatives, which is the amount in excess of the present value of the expected estimated economic credit losses, and non-economic payments. Such fair value adjustments are heavily affected by, and in part fluctuate with, changes in market interest rates, credit spreads and other market factors and are not expected to result in an economic gain or loss.
3)
Elimination of the after-tax fair value gains (losses) on the Company’s CCS. Such amounts are heavily affected by, and in part fluctuate with, changes in market interest rates, credit spreads and other market factors and are not expected to result in an economic gain or loss.
4)
Elimination of the after-tax unrealized gains (losses) on the Company’s investments that are recorded as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income (“AOCI”) (excluding foreign exchange remeasurement). The AOCI component of the fair value adjustment on the investment portfolio is not deemed economic because the Company generally holds these investments to maturity and therefore should not recognize an economic gain or loss.
Management believes that adjusted book value is a useful measure because it enables an evaluation of the net present value of the Company’s in-force premiums and revenues in addition to operating shareholders’ equity. The premiums and
118
Table of Contents
revenues included in adjusted book value will be earned in future periods, but actual earnings may differ materially from the estimated amounts used in determining current adjusted book value due to changes in foreign exchange rates, prepayment speeds, terminations, credit defaults and other factors. Many investors, analysts and financial news reporters use adjusted book value to evaluate AGL’s share price and as the basis of their decision to recommend, buy or sell the AGL common shares. Adjusted book value is operating shareholders’ equity, as defined above, further adjusted for the following:
1)
Elimination of after-tax deferred acquisition costs, net. These amounts represent net deferred expenses that have already been paid or accrued and will be expensed in future accounting periods.
2)
Addition of the after-tax net present value of estimated net future credit derivative revenue. See below.
3)
Addition of the after-tax value of the unearned premium reserve on financial guaranty contracts in excess of expected loss to be expensed, net of reinsurance. This amount represents the expected future net earned premiums, net of expected losses to be expensed, which are not reflected in GAAP equity.
Net Present Value of Estimated Net Future Credit Derivative Revenue
Management believes that this amount is a useful measure because it enables an evaluation of the value of future estimated credit derivative revenue. There is no corresponding GAAP financial measure. This amount represents the present value of estimated future revenue from the Company’s credit derivative in-force book of business, net of reinsurance, ceding commissions and premium taxes, for contracts without expected economic losses, and is discounted at 6%. Estimated net future credit derivative revenue may change from period to period due to changes in foreign exchange rates, prepayment speeds, terminations, credit defaults or other factors that affect par outstanding or the ultimate maturity of an obligation.
Reconciliation of Shareholders’ Equity
to Adjusted Book Value
As of March 31, 2016
As of December 31, 2015
Total
Per Share
Total
Per Share
(dollars in millions, except per share amounts)
Shareholders’ equity
$
6,113
$
45.26
$
6,063
$
43.96
Less after-tax adjustments:
Effect of consolidating FG VIEs
(12
)
(0.09
)
(23
)
(0.16
)
Non-credit impairment unrealized fair value gains (losses) on credit derivatives
(203
)
(1.50
)
(160
)
(1.16
)
Fair value gains (losses) on CCS
30
0.22
40
0.29
Unrealized gain (loss) on investment portfolio excluding foreign exchange effect
344
2.55
260
1.88
Operating shareholders’ equity
5,954
44.08
5,946
43.11
After-tax adjustments:
Less: Deferred acquisition costs
145
1.07
147
1.06
Plus: Net present value of estimated net future credit derivative revenue
91
0.67
116
0.84
Plus: Net unearned premium reserve on financial guaranty contracts in excess of expected loss to be expensed
2,394
17.72
2,524
18.29
Adjusted book value
$
8,294
$
61.40
$
8,439
$
61.18
Shareholder's equity increased since December 31, 2015 due primarily to positive income and net unrealized gains on available for sale investment securities recorded in AOCI, which was partially offset by share repurchases and dividends. While operating shareholders' equity increased slightly, adjusted book value decreased since December 31, 2015 due mainly to share repurchases and dividends. Operating shareholders' equity per share and adjusted book value per share benefited from the repurchase of
3.0 million
common shares through
March 31, 2016
.
119
Table of Contents
PVP or Present Value of New Business Production
Management believes that PVP is a useful measure because it enables the evaluation of the value of new business production for the Company by taking into account the value of estimated future installment premiums on all new contracts underwritten in a reporting period as well as premium supplements and additional installment premium on existing contracts as to which the issuer has the right to call the insured obligation but has not exercised such right, whether in insurance or credit derivative contract form, which GAAP gross premiums written and the net credit derivative premiums received and receivable portion of net realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives (“Credit Derivative Revenues”) do not adequately measure. PVP in respect of financial guaranty contracts written in a specified period is defined as gross upfront and installment premiums received and the present value of gross estimated future installment premiums, in each case, discounted at 6%. For purposes of the PVP calculation, management discounts estimated future installment premiums on insurance contracts at 6%, while under GAAP, these amounts are discounted at a risk free rate. Additionally, under GAAP, management records future installment premiums on financial guaranty insurance contracts covering non-homogeneous pools of assets based on the contractual term of the transaction, whereas for PVP purposes, management records an estimate of the future installment premiums the Company expects to receive, which may be based upon a shorter period of time than the contractual term of the transaction. Actual future net earned or written premiums and Credit Derivative Revenues may differ from PVP due to factors including, but not limited to, changes in foreign exchange rates, prepayment speeds, terminations, credit defaults, or other factors that affect par outstanding or the ultimate maturity of an obligation.
Reconciliation of PVP to Gross Written Premiums
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Total PVP
$
38
$
36
Less: PVP of non-financial guaranty insurance
0
6
PVP of financial guaranty insurance
38
30
Less: Financial guaranty installment premium PVP
7
17
Total: Financial guaranty upfront gross written premiums
31
13
Plus: Installment gross written premiums and other GAAP adjustments (1)
(12
)
19
Total gross written premiums
$
19
$
32
___________________
(1)
Includes present value of new business on installment policies, gross written premium adjustments on existing installment policies due to changes in assumptions, any cancellations of assumed reinsurance contracts, and other GAAP adjustments.
Insured Portfolio
The following tables present the insured portfolio by asset class net of cessions to reinsurers. It includes all financial guaranty contracts outstanding as of the dates presented, regardless of the form written (i.e., credit derivative form or traditional financial guaranty insurance form) or the applicable accounting model (i.e., insurance, derivative or VIE consolidation). The Company excludes amounts attributable to loss mitigation securities (unless otherwise indicated) from par and principal and interest ("Debt Service") outstanding because it manages such securities as investments not insurance exposures.
120
Table of Contents
Net Par Outstanding and Average Internal Rating by Sector
As of March 31, 2016
As of December 31, 2015
Sector
Net Par
Outstanding
Avg.
Rating
Net Par
Outstanding
Avg.
Rating
(dollars in millions)
Public finance:
U.S.:
General obligation
$
121,800
A
$
126,255
A
Tax backed
57,218
A
58,062
A
Municipal utilities
45,086
A
45,936
A
Transportation
22,531
A
23,454
A
Healthcare
14,631
A
15,006
A
Higher education
11,535
A
11,936
A
Infrastructure finance
3,145
BBB
4,993
BBB
Housing
1,932
A-
2,037
A
Investor-owned utilities
915
A-
916
A-
Other public finance—U.S.
3,262
A
3,271
A
Total public finance—U.S.
282,055
A
291,866
A
Non-U.S.:
Infrastructure finance
12,673
BBB
12,728
BBB
Regulated utilities
9,907
BBB+
10,048
BBB+
Pooled infrastructure
1,831
AA
1,879
AA
Other public finance
4,974
A
4,922
A
Total public finance—non-U.S.
29,385
BBB+
29,577
BBB+
Total public finance
311,440
A
321,443
A
Structured finance:
U.S.:
Pooled corporate obligations
15,380
AAA
16,008
AAA
RMBS
6,677
BBB-
7,067
BBB-
Insurance securitizations
2,900
A+
3,000
A+
Consumer receivables
2,084
A-
2,099
A-
Financial products
1,824
AA-
1,906
AA-
CMBS and other commercial real estate related exposures
498
AAA
533
AAA
Commercial receivables
382
BBB+
427
BBB+
Other structured finance—U.S.
707
AA-
730
AA-
Total structured finance—U.S.
30,452
AA-
31,770
AA-
Non-U.S.:
Pooled corporate obligations
3,465
AA
3,645
AA
Commercial receivables
541
BBB+
600
BBB+
RMBS
504
BBB
492
BBB
Other structured finance
613
AA-
621
AA-
Total structured finance—non-U.S.
5,123
AA-
5,358
AA-
Total structured finance
35,575
AA-
37,128
AA-
Total net par outstanding
$
347,015
A
$
358,571
A
121
Table of Contents
The following tables set forth the Company’s net financial guaranty portfolio by internal rating.
Financial Guaranty Portfolio by Internal Rating
As of March 31, 2016
Public Finance
U.S.
Public Finance
Non-U.S.
Structured Finance
U.S
Structured Finance
Non-U.S
Total
Rating
Category
Net Par
Outstanding
%
Net Par
Outstanding
%
Net Par
Outstanding
%
Net Par
Outstanding
%
Net Par
Outstanding
%
(dollars in millions)
AAA
$
2,541
0.9
%
$
688
2.3
%
$
13,953
45.8
%
$
2,529
49.4
%
$
19,711
5.7
%
AA
65,310
23.2
1,969
6.7
7,505
24.7
154
3.0
74,938
21.6
A
145,515
51.6
6,695
22.8
2,584
8.5
551
10.8
155,345
44.7
BBB
60,736
21.5
18,622
63.4
1,279
4.2
1,267
24.7
81,904
23.6
BIG
7,953
2.8
1,411
4.8
5,131
16.8
622
12.1
15,117
4.4
Total net par outstanding (1)
$
282,055
100.0
%
$
29,385
100.0
%
$
30,452
100.0
%
$
5,123
100.0
%
$
347,015
100.0
%
_____________________
(1)
Excludes
$1.5 billion
of loss mitigation securities insured and held by the Company as of
March 31, 2016
, which are primarily BIG.
Financial Guaranty Portfolio by Internal Rating
As of December 31, 2015
Public Finance
U.S.
Public Finance
Non-U.S.
Structured Finance
U.S
Structured Finance
Non-U.S
Total
Rating
Category
Net Par
Outstanding
%
Net Par
Outstanding
%
Net Par
Outstanding
%
Net Par
Outstanding
%
Net Par
Outstanding
%
(dollars in millions)
AAA
$
3,053
1.1
%
$
709
2.4
%
$
14,366
45.2
%
$
2,709
50.6
%
$
20,837
5.8
%
AA
69,274
23.7
2,017
6.8
7,934
25.0
177
3.3
79,402
22.1
A
157,440
53.9
6,765
22.9
2,486
7.8
555
10.3
167,246
46.7
BBB
54,315
18.6
18,708
63.2
1,515
4.8
1,365
25.5
75,903
21.2
BIG
7,784
2.7
1,378
4.7
5,469
17.2
552
10.3
15,183
4.2
Total net par outstanding (1)
$
291,866
100.0
%
$
29,577
100.0
%
$
31,770
100.0
%
$
5,358
100.0
%
$
358,571
100.0
%
_____________________
(1)
Excludes
$1.5 billion
of loss mitigation securities insured and held by the Company as of
December 31, 2015
, which are primarily BIG.
Exposure to Puerto Rico
The Company has insured exposure to general obligation bonds of the Commonwealth of Puerto Rico and various obligations of its related authorities and public corporations aggregating
$5.1 billion
net par as of
March 31, 2016
, all of which are rated BIG.
Puerto Rico has experienced significant general fund budget deficits in recent years. In addition to high debt levels, Puerto Rico faces a challenging economic environment.
In June 2014, the Puerto Rico legislature passed the Puerto Rico Public Corporation Debt Enforcement and Recovery Act (the "Recovery Act") in order to provide a legislative framework for certain public corporations experiencing severe financial stress to restructure their debt, including Puerto Rico Highway and Transportation Authority ("PRHTA") and PREPA. Subsequently, the Commonwealth stated PREPA might need to seek relief under the Recovery Act due to liquidity constraints. Investors in bonds issued by PREPA filed suit in the United States District Court for the District of Puerto Rico challenging the Recovery Act. On February 6, 2015, the U.S. District Court for the District of Puerto Rico ruled the Recovery Act is preempted by the U.S. Bankruptcy Code and is therefore void. On July 6, 2015, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the First Circuit upheld that ruling, and on December 4, 2015, the U.S. Supreme Court granted petitions for writs of certiorari relating to that ruling. Oral
122
Table of Contents
arguments were held on March 22, 2016. Typical Supreme Court practice suggests a decision could be announced in June 2016, but there is no assurance that an opinion will be announced at such time, especially in light of the Supreme Court vacancy.
On June 28, 2015, Governor García Padilla of Puerto Rico (the "Governor") publicly stated that the Commonwealth’s public debt, considering the current level of economic activity, is unpayable and that a comprehensive debt restructuring may be necessary, and he has made similar statements since then.
On September 9, 2015, the Working Group for the Fiscal and Economic Recovery of Puerto Rico (“Working Group”) established by the Governor published its “Puerto Rico Fiscal and Economic Growth Plan” (the “FEGP”). The FEGP included a recommendation that the Commonwealth’s advisors begin to work on a voluntary exchange offer to its creditors as part of the FEGP.
On November 30, 2015, and December 8, 2015, the Governor issued executive orders (“Clawback Orders”) directing the Puerto Rico Department of Treasury and the Puerto Rico Tourism Company to retain or transfer certain taxes pledged to secure the payment of bonds issued by PRHTA, Puerto Rico Infrastructure Finance Authority ("PRIFA") and Puerto Rico Convention Center District Authority ("PRCCDA"). On January 7, 2016 the Company sued various Puerto Rico governmental officials in the United States District Court, District of Puerto Rico asserting that this attempt to “claw back” pledged taxes is unconstitutional, and demanding declaratory and injunctive relief. The Puerto Rico credits insured by the Company impacted by the Clawback Orders are shown in the table “Puerto Rico Net Par Outstanding” below.
On January 1, 2016 PRIFA defaulted on payment of a portion of the interest due on its bonds on that date. For those PRIFA bonds the Company had insured, the Company paid approximately
$451 thousand
of claims for the interest payments on which PRIFA had defaulted.
On April 6, 2016 the Governor signed into law the Puerto Rico Emergency Moratorium & Financial Rehabilitation Act (the “Moratorium Act”). The Moratorium Act purportedly empowers the Governor to declare a moratorium, entity by entity, on debt service payments on debt of the commonwealth and its related authorities and public corporations, as well as instituting a stay against related litigation, among other things. It is possible that a court may find any attempt to exercise the power to declare a moratorium on debt service payments purportedly granted by the Moratorium Act to be unconstitutional, and the impact of any attempt to exercise such power on the Puerto Rico credits insured by the Company is uncertain. Shortly after signing it into law, the Governor used the authority of the Moratorium Act to declare an emergency period with respect to the Government Development Bank (the “GDB”), placing restrictions on its disbursements and certain of its other activities and moving the clearing of payroll of Commonwealth and GDB employees from the GDB.
On April 30, 2016, the Governor signed an order under the Moratorium Act ordering a moratorium on the debt service payment of approximately
$422 million
due to be made by the GDB on May 2, 2016. On May 1, 2016, the GDB announced a tentative agreement with a group of creditors of the GDB (the “Ad Hoc Group”) for a restructuring of GDB’s notes and that the GDB would pay the interest due on May 2, 2016. According to the announcement, the Ad Hoc Group agreed to forbear from initiating litigation for
30
days during the pendency of negotiations. The GDB noted in its May 1 announcement that the tentative agreement requires
100%
participation of the GDB’s creditors and that it would be unlikely to reach that level of participation without a restructuring law enabling it to bind non-consenting creditors. The Company does not insure any debt issued by the GDB.
There have been a number of other proposals, plans and legislative initiatives offered in Puerto Rico and in the United States aimed at addressing Puerto Rico’s fiscal issues. Among the responses proposed is a federal financial control board and access to bankruptcy courts or another restructuring mechanism. In addition, the Working Group has made several proposals for voluntary exchanges that include terms such as discounts, extensions and subordination. The final shape and timing of responses to Puerto Rico’s distress eventually enacted or implemented by Puerto Rico or the United States, if any, and the impact of any such actions on obligations insured by the Company, is uncertain and may differ substantially from the recommendations of the Working Group or any other proposals or plans described in the press or offered to date or in the future.
Standard & Poor's Ratings Services ("S&P"), Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. ("Moody’s") and Fitch Ratings have lowered the credit rating of the Commonwealth’s bonds and on its public corporations several times over the past approximately two years, and the Commonwealth has disclosed its liquidity has been adversely affected by rating agency downgrades and by the limited market access for its debt, and also noted it has relied on short-term financings and interim loans from the GDB and other private lenders, which reliance has constrained its liquidity and increased its near-term refinancing risk.
123
Table of Contents
PREPA
As of
March 31, 2016
, the Company had
$744 million
insured net par outstanding of PREPA obligations. On July 1, 2015, PREPA made full payment of the
$416 million
of principal and interest due on its bonds, including bonds insured by AGM and AGC. However, that payment was conditioned on and facilitated by AGM and AGC agreeing, also on July 1, to purchase a portion of
$131 million
of interest-bearing bonds to help replenish certain of the operating funds PREPA used to make the
$416 million
of principal and interest payments. On July 31, 2015, AGM and AGC purchased
$74 million
aggregate principal amount of those bonds; the bonds were repaid in full in 2016.
On December 24, 2015, AGM and AGC entered into a RSA with PREPA, an ad hoc group of uninsured bondholders and a group of fuel-line lenders that would, subject to certain conditions, result in, among other things, modernization of the utility and a restructuring of current debt. Upon finalization of the contemplated restructuring transaction, insured PREPA revenue bonds (with no reduction to par or stated interest rate or extension of maturity) will be supported by securitization bonds issued by a special purpose corporation and secured by a transition charge assessed on ratepayers. To facilitate the securitization transaction, which enables PREPA to achieve debt relief and more efficient capital markets financing, Assured Guaranty will issue surety insurance policies in an aggregate amount not expected to exceed
$113 million
in exchange for a market premium and to support a portion of the reserve fund for the securitization bonds. Certain of the creditors also agreed, subject to certain conditions, to participate in a bridge financing. The Company’s share of the bridge financing is approximately
$15 million
. Legislation meeting the requirements of the RSA was enacted on February 16, 2016. The closing of the restructuring transaction, the issuance of the surety bonds and the closing of the bridge financing are subject to certain conditions, including confirmation that the enacted legislation meets all requirements of the RSA and execution of acceptable documentation and legal opinions.
There can be no assurance that the conditions in the RSA will be met or that, if the conditions are met, the RSA's other provisions, including those related to the restructuring of the insured PREPA revenue bonds, will be implemented. In addition, the impact of the Moratorium Act or any attempt to exercise the power purportedly granted by the Moratorium Act on the implementation of the RSA is uncertain. PREPA, during the pendency of the agreements, has suspended deposits into its debt service fund.
PRHTA
As of
March 31, 2016
, the Company had
$910 million
insured net par outstanding of PRHTA (Transportation revenue) bonds and
$369 million
net par of PRHTA (Highway revenue) bonds. The Clawback Orders cover Commonwealth-derived taxes that are allocated to PRHTA. The Company believes that such sources represented a substantial majority of PRHTA’s revenues in 2015.
Puerto Rico Sales Tax Financing Corporation (“COFINA”)
As of
March 31, 2016
, the Company had
$270 million
insured net par outstanding of junior COFINA bonds, which are secured by a lien on certain sales and use taxes. There have been proposals from both the Commonwealth and from holders of certain senior COFINA bonds to restructure COFINA debt.
Puerto Rico Convention Center District Authority
As of March 31, 2016, the Company had
$164 million
insured net par outstanding of PRCCDA bonds, which are secured by certain hotel tax revenues. These revenues are sensitive to the level of economic activity in the area and are subject to the Clawback Orders.
Puerto Rico Aqueduct and Sewer Authority (“PRASA”)
As of March 31, 2016, the Company had
$388 million
insured par outstanding to PRASA bonds, which are secured by the gross revenues of the system. On September 15, 2015, PRASA entered into a settlement with the U.S. Justice Department and the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency that requires it to spend
$1.6 billion
to upgrade and improve its sewer system island-wide. According to a material event notice PRASA filed on March 4, 2016, it owed its contractors
$140 million
.
124
Table of Contents
Municipal Finance Agency
As of
March 31, 2016
, the Company had
$387 million
net par outstanding of bonds issued by the Puerto Rico Municipal Finance Agency (“MFA”) secured by a pledge of local property tax revenues. On October 13, 2015, the Company filed a motion to intervene in litigation between Centro de Recaudación de Ingresos Municipales (“CRIM”) and the GDB in which CRIM was seeking to ensure that the pledged tax revenues are, and will continue to be, available to support the MFA bonds. While the Company’s motion to intervene was denied, the GDB and CRIM have reported that they executed a new deed of trust that requires the GDB, as fiduciary, to keep the pledged tax revenues separate from any other GDB monies or accounts and that governs the manner in which the pledged revenues may be invested and dispersed.
125
Table of Contents
Net Exposure to Puerto Rico
As of
March 31, 2016
Net Par Outstanding
AGM Consolidated
AGC Consolidated
AG Re (1) Consolidated
Eliminations (2)
Total Net Par Outstanding (4)
Gross Par Outstanding
Internal Rating
(in millions)
Exposures Previously Subject to the Voided Recovery Act(3):
PRHTA (Transportation revenue) (5)
$
289
$
476
$
225
$
(80
)
$
910
$
937
CCC-
PREPA
431
74
239
—
744
902
CC
PRASA
—
296
92
—
388
388
CCC
PRHTA (Highway revenue) (5)
219
100
50
—
369
574
CCC
PRCCDA (5)
—
82
82
—
164
164
CCC-
Total
939
1,028
688
(80
)
2,575
2,965
Exposures Not Previously Subject to the Voided Recovery Act:
Commonwealth of Puerto Rico - General Obligation Bonds
720
415
480
—
1,615
1,738
CCC
MFA
206
65
116
—
387
570
CCC-
COFINA
262
—
8
—
270
270
CCC+
Puerto Rico Public Buildings Authority
13
137
38
—
188
194
CCC
PRIFA (5) (6)
—
10
8
—
18
18
C
University of Puerto Rico
—
1
—
—
1
1
CCC-
Total
1,201
628
650
—
2,479
2,791
Total net exposure to Puerto Rico
$
2,140
$
1,656
$
1,338
$
(80
)
$
5,054
$
5,756
___________________
(1)
"AG Re" means Assured Guaranty Re Ltd.
(2)
Net par outstanding eliminations relate to second-to-pay policies under which an Assured Guaranty insurance subsidiary guarantees an obligation already insured by another Assured Guaranty insurance subsidiary.
(3)
On February 6, 2015, the U.S. District Court for the District of Puerto Rico ruled that the Recovery Act is preempted by the U.S. Bankruptcy Code and is therefore void. On July 6, 2015, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the First Circuit upheld that ruling, and on December 4, 2015, the U.S. Supreme Court granted petitions for writs of certiorari relating to that ruling.
(4)
Includes exposure to capital appreciation bonds with a current aggregate net par outstanding of $34 million and a fully accreted net par at maturity of $67 million. Of these amounts, current net par of $18 million and fully accreted net par at maturity of $50 million relate to the Puerto Rico Sales Tax Financing Corporation, current net par of $10 million and fully accreted net par at maturity of $11 million relate to the PRHTA, and current net par of $5 million and fully accreted net par at maturity of $5 million relate to the Commonwealth General Obligation Bonds.
(5)
The Governor issued executive orders on November 30, 2015 and December 8, 2015, directing the Puerto Rico Department of Treasury and the Puerto Rico Tourism Company to retain or transfer certain taxes and revenues pledged to secure the payment of bonds issued by PRHTA, PRIFA and PRCCDA. On January 7, 2016, the Company sued various Puerto Rico governmental officials in the United States District Court, District of Puerto Rico asserting that this attempt to “claw back” pledged taxes and revenues is unconstitutional, and demanding declaratory and injunctive relief.
(6)
On January 1, 2016 PRIFA defaulted on full payment of a portion of the interest due on its bonds on that date. For those PRIFA bonds the Company had insured, the Company paid approximately
$451 thousand
of claims for the interest payments on which PRIFA had defaulted.
126
Table of Contents
The following table shows the scheduled amortization of the general obligation bonds of Puerto Rico and various obligations of its related authorities and public corporations insured by the Company. The Company guarantees payments of interest and principal when those amounts are scheduled to be paid and cannot be required to pay on an accelerated basis. In the event that obligors default on their obligations, the Company would only pay the shortfall between the principal and interest due in any given period and the amount paid by the obligors.
Amortization Schedule
of Net Par Outstanding of Puerto Rico
As of
March 31, 2016
Scheduled Net Par Amortization
2016 (2Q)
2016 (3Q)
2016 (4Q)
2017
2018
2019
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
2025
2026 -2030
2031 -2035
2036 -2040
2041 -2045
2046 -2047
Total
(in millions)
Exposures Previously Subject to the Voided Recovery Act:
PRHTA (Transportation revenue)
$
0
$
33
$
0
$
36
$
42
$
28
$
23
$
18
$
19
$
21
$
1
$
26
$
151
$
227
$
240
$
45
$
—
$
910
PREPA
0
20
0
5
4
25
42
22
22
81
78
52
309
84
0
—
—
744
PRASA
—
15
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
2
25
84
—
2
92
168
388
PRHTA (Highway revenue)
—
19
—
10
10
21
22
26
6
8
8
8
27
167
37
—
—
369
PRCCDA
—
11
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
19
105
29
—
—
164
Total
0
98
0
51
56
74
87
66
47
110
89
111
590
583
308
137
168
2,575
Exposures Not Previously Subject to the Voided Recovery Act:
Commonwealth of Puerto Rico - General Obligation Bonds
0
142
0
95
75
82
137
16
37
14
73
68
255
475
146
—
—
1,615
MFA
—
55
—
47
47
44
37
33
33
16
12
11
52
—
—
—
—
387
COFINA
0
(1
)
0
(1
)
(1
)
(1
)
(1
)
(2
)
(2
)
1
0
(2
)
(6
)
32
99
155
—
270
Puerto Rico Public Buildings Authority
—
8
—
30
—
5
10
12
0
7
0
8
52
40
16
—
—
188
PRIFA
—
—
—
—
2
—
—
—
—
2
—
—
—
—
10
4
—
18
University of Puerto Rico
—
0
—
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
—
—
—
1
Total
0
204
0
171
123
130
183
59
68
40
85
85
353
548
271
159
—
2,479
Total net par for Puerto Rico
$
0
$
302
$
0
$
222
$
179
$
204
$
270
$
125
$
115
$
150
$
174
$
196
$
943
$
1,131
$
579
$
296
$
168
$
5,054
127
Table of Contents
Amortization Schedule
of Net Debt Service Outstanding of Puerto Rico
As of
March 31, 2016
Scheduled Net Debt Service Amortization
2016 (2Q)
2016 (3Q)
2016 (4Q)
2017
2018
2019
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
2025
2026 -2030
2031 -2035
2036 -2040
2041 -2045
2046 -2047
Total
(in millions)
Exposures Previously Subject to the Voided Recovery Act:
PRHTA (Transportation revenue)
$
0
$
57
$
—
$
82
$
86
$
69
$
63
$
57
$
57
$
58
$
37
$
61
$
309
$
348
$
288
$
47
$
—
$
1,619
PREPA
2
35
2
38
37
58
74
52
50
109
102
72
366
92
0
—
—
1,089
PRASA
—
25
—
19
19
19
19
19
19
19
21
45
160
68
70
159
181
862
PRHTA (Highway revenue)
—
29
—
29
29
39
39
42
20
21
21
21
88
203
39
—
—
620
PRCCDA
—
15
—
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
7
51
127
30
—
—
286
Total
2
161
2
175
178
192
202
177
153
214
188
206
974
838
427
206
181
4,476
Exposures Not Previously Subject to the Voided Recovery Act:
Commonwealth of Puerto Rico - General Obligation Bonds
0
184
—
171
146
150
201
72
93
69
127
117
459
605
161
—
—
2,555
MFA
—
64
—
64
62
56
47
40
39
21
16
15
57
—
—
—
—
481
COFINA
0
6
—
13
13
13
13
13
13
16
15
12
68
103
164
170
—
632
Puerto Rico Public Buildings Authority
—
13
—
39
8
12
18
20
6
14
6
14
72
49
17
—
—
288
PRIFA
—
0
—
1
3
1
1
1
1
3
0
1
4
3
13
4
—
36
University of Puerto Rico
—
0
—
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
—
—
—
1
Total
0
267
—
288
232
232
280
146
152
123
164
159
660
761
355
174
—
3,993
Total net debt service for Puerto Rico
$
2
$
428
$
2
$
463
$
410
$
424
$
482
$
323
$
305
$
337
$
352
$
365
$
1,634
$
1,599
$
782
$
380
$
181
$
8,469
128
Table of Contents
Exposure to Residential Mortgage-Backed Securities
The tables below provide information on the risk ratings and certain other risk characteristics of the Company’s financial guaranty insurance and credit derivative RMBS exposures as of
March 31, 2016
. U.S. RMBS exposures represent 2% of the total net par outstanding, and BIG U.S. RMBS represent 24% of total BIG net par outstanding. See Note 5, Expected Loss to be Paid, of the Financial Statements, for a discussion of expected losses to be paid on U.S. RMBS exposures.
Distribution of U.S. RMBS by Rating and Type of Exposure as of
March 31, 2016
Ratings:
Prime
First
Lien
Alt-A
First Lien
Option
ARMs
Subprime
First
Lien
Second
Lien
Total Net
Par
Outstanding
(dollars in millions)
AAA
$
8
$
209
$
17
$
1,560
$
30
$
1,825
AA
92
316
80
390
70
948
A
1
—
4
34
1
39
BBB
76
15
—
92
0
183
BIG
248
698
135
1,229
1,372
3,682
Total exposures
$
425
$
1,238
$
235
$
3,305
$
1,474
$
6,677
Distribution of U.S. RMBS by Year Insured and Type of Exposure as of
March 31, 2016
Year
insured:
Prime
First
Lien
Alt-A
First Lien
Option
ARMs
Subprime
First
Lien
Second
Lien
Total Net
Par
Outstanding
(in millions)
2004 and prior
$
52
$
53
$
17
$
1,032
$
97
$
1,252
2005
121
433
35
173
322
1,085
2006
82
189
33
695
412
1,411
2007
169
562
150
1,337
642
2,861
2008
—
—
—
67
—
67
Total exposures
$
425
$
1,238
$
235
$
3,305
$
1,474
$
6,677
Exposures by Reinsurer
Ceded par outstanding represents the portion of insured risk ceded to other reinsurers. Under these relationships, the Company cedes a portion of its insured risk in exchange for a premium paid to the reinsurer. The Company remains primarily liable for all risks it directly underwrites and is required to pay all gross claims. It then seeks reimbursement from the reinsurer for its proportionate share of claims. The Company may be exposed to risk for this exposure if it were required to pay the gross claims and not be able to collect ceded claims from an assuming company experiencing financial distress. A number of the financial guaranty insurers to which the Company has ceded par have experienced financial distress and as a result have been downgraded by the rating agencies. In addition, state insurance regulators have intervened with respect to some of these insurers.
In accordance with U.S. statutory accounting requirements and U.S. insurance laws and regulations, in order for the Company to receive credit for liabilities ceded to reinsurers domiciled outside of the U.S., such reinsurers must secure their liabilities to the Company. All of the unauthorized reinsurers in the table below are required to post collateral for the benefit of the Company in an amount at least equal to the sum of their ceded unearned premium reserve, loss reserves and contingency reserves, all calculated on a statutory basis of accounting. In addition, certain authorized reinsurers in the table below post collateral on terms negotiated with the Company. Collateral may be in the form of letters of credit or trust accounts. The total collateral posted by all non-affiliated reinsurers as of
March 31, 2016
was approximately $
436 million
.
Assumed par outstanding represents the amount of par assumed by the Company from other monolines. Under these relationships, the Company assumes a portion of the ceding company’s insured risk in exchange for a premium. The Company
129
Table of Contents
may be exposed to risk in this portfolio in that the Company may be required to pay losses without a corresponding premium in circumstances where the ceding company is experiencing financial distress and is unable to pay premiums.
In addition to assumed and ceded reinsurance arrangements, the Company may also have exposure to financial guaranty insurers in "second-to-pay" transactions, where the Company provides insurance on an obligation that is already insured by another financial guarantor. In that case, if the underlying obligor and the financial guarantor both fail to pay an amount scheduled to be paid, the Company would be obligated to pay. The Company underwrites these transactions based on the underlying obligation, without regard to the financial obligor. See Note 13, Reinsurance and Other Monoline Exposures, of the Financial Statements
Exposure by Reinsurer
Ratings at
Par Outstanding (1)
May 3, 2016
As of March 31, 2016
Reinsurer
Moody’s
Reinsurer
Rating
S&P
Reinsurer
Rating
Ceded Par
Outstanding
Second-to-
Pay Insured
Par
Outstanding
Assumed Par
Outstanding
(dollars in millions)
American Overseas Reinsurance Company Limited (2)
WR (3)
WR
$
4,960
$
—
$
30
Tokio Marine & Nichido Fire Insurance Co., Ltd. (2)
Aa3 (4)
A+ (4)
4,171
—
—
Syncora Guarantee Inc. (2)
WR
WR
2,411
1,319
700
Mitsui Sumitomo Insurance Co. Ltd. (2)
A1
A+ (4)
1,718
—
—
ACA Financial Guaranty Corp.
NR (5)
WR
700
38
—
Ambac Assurance Corporation
WR
WR
117
3,892
9,589
National Public Finance Guarantee Corporation ("National") (6)
A3
AA-
—
5,139
5,065
MBIA
(7)
(7)
—
1,591
428
FGIC
(8)
(8)
—
1,437
636
Ambac Assurance Corp. Segregated Account
NR
NR
—
86
823
CIFG Assurance North America Inc.
WR
WR
—
43
2,784
Other (2)
Various
Various
76
776
128
Total
$
14,153
$
14,321
$
20,183
____________________
(1)
Includes par related to insured credit derivatives.
(2)
The total collateral posted by all non-affiliated reinsurers required or agreeing to post collateral as of
March 31, 2016
was approximately
$436 million
.
(3) Represents “Withdrawn Rating.”
(4) The Company benefits from trust arrangements that satisfy the triple-A credit requirement of S&P and/or Moody’s.
(5) Represents “Not Rated.”
(6)
Rated AA+ by KBRA.
(7)
MBIA includes subsidiaries MBIA Insurance Corp. rated B by S&P and B3 by Moody's and MBIA U.K. Insurance Ltd. rated BB by S&P and Ba2 by Moody’s.
(8)
FGIC includes subsidiaries Financial Guaranty Insurance Company and FGIC UK Limited both of which had their ratings withdrawn by rating agencies.
130
Table of Contents
Ceded Par Outstanding by Reinsurer and Credit Rating
As of March 31, 2016
Internal Credit Rating
Reinsurer
AAA
AA
A
BBB
BIG
Total
(in millions)
American Overseas Reinsurance Company Limited
$
378
$
1,760
$
1,528
$
976
$
318
$
4,960
Tokio Marine & Nichido Fire Insurance Co., Ltd.
543
522
1,126
1,358
622
4,171
Syncora Guarantee Inc.
—
132
422
1,734
123
2,411
Mitsui Sumitomo Insurance Co. Ltd.
131
504
551
359
173
1,718
ACA Financial Guaranty Corp.
—
449
240
11
—
700
Ambac Assurance Corporation
—
—
117
—
—
117
Other
47
0
1
28
—
76
Total
$
1,099
$
3,367
$
3,985
$
4,466
$
1,236
$
14,153
Second-to-Pay
Insured Par Outstanding by Internal Rating
As of March 31, 2016
(1)
Public Finance
Structured Finance
AAA
AA
A
BBB
BIG
AAA
AA
A
BBB
BIG
Total
(in millions)
Syncora Guarantee Inc.
$
—
$
71
$
239
$
617
$
348
$
—
$
—
$
—
$
—
$
44
$
1,319
ACA Financial Guaranty Corp.
—
—
2
19
17
—
—
—
—
—
38
Ambac Assurance Corporation
10
1,037
1,449
1,187
47
1
—
57
96
8
3,892
National
71
1,655
3,387
1
—
—
—
25
—
—
5,139
MBIA
—
65
247
265
—
—
750
81
80
103
1,591
FGIC
—
30
741
261
227
139
—
5
—
34
1,437
Ambac Assurance Corp. Segregated Account
—
—
—
—
—
—
22
—
—
64
86
CIFG Assurance North America Inc.
—
—
—
22
21
—
—
—
—
—
43
Other
—
776
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
776
Total
$
81
$
3,634
$
6,065
$
2,372
$
660
$
140
$
772
$
168
$
176
$
253
$
14,321
____________________
(1)
Assured Guaranty’s internal rating.
131
Table of Contents
Selected European Exposure
The European countries where the Company has exposure and believes heightened uncertainties exist are: Hungary, Italy, Portugal and Spain (collectively, the “Selected European Countries”). The Company’s direct economic exposure to the Selected European Countries (based on par for financial guaranty contracts and notional amount for financial guaranty contracts accounted for as derivatives) is shown in the following tables, both gross and net of ceded reinsurance.
Gross Direct Economic Exposure
to Selected European Countries(1)
As of
March 31, 2016
Hungary
Italy
Portugal
Spain
Total
(in millions)
Sub-sovereign exposure(2)
$
274
$
1,082
$
90
$
470
$
1,916
Non-sovereign exposure(3)
185
506
—
—
691
Total
$
459
$
1,588
$
90
$
470
$
2,607
Total BIG
$
385
$
—
$
90
$
470
$
945
Net Direct Economic Exposure
to Selected European Countries(1)
As of
March 31, 2016
Hungary
Italy
Portugal
Spain
Total
(in millions)
Sub-sovereign exposure(2)
$
271
$
827
$
84
$
375
$
1,557
Non-sovereign exposure(3)
179
458
—
—
637
Total
$
450
$
1,285
$
84
$
375
$
2,194
Total BIG
$
379
$
—
$
84
$
375
$
838
____________________
(1)
While the Company’s exposures are shown in U.S. dollars, the obligations the Company insures are in various currencies, primarily Euros.
(2)
Sub-sovereign exposure in Selected European Countries includes transactions backed by receivables from or supported by sub-sovereigns, which are governmental or government-backed entities other than the ultimate governing body of the country.
(3)
Non-sovereign exposure in Selected European Countries includes debt of regulated utilities and RMBS.
The tables above include the par amount of financial guaranty contracts accounted for as derivatives of $116 million with a fair value of $3 million, net of reinsurance. The Company’s credit derivative transactions are governed by International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc. ("ISDA") documentation, and the Company is required to make a loss payment on them only upon the occurrence of one or more defined credit events with respect to the referenced securities or loans.
The Company has excluded from the exposure tables above its indirect economic exposure to the Selected European Countries through policies it provides on pooled corporate and commercial receivables transactions. The Company calculates indirect exposure to a country by multiplying the par amount of a transaction insured by the Company times the percent of the relevant collateral pool reported as having a nexus to the country. On that basis, the Company has calculated exposure of
$206 million
to Selected European Countries (plus Greece) in transactions with
$4.1 billion
of net par outstanding. The indirect exposure to credits with a nexus to Greece is
$6 million
across several highly rated pooled corporate obligations with net par outstanding of
$231 million
.
132
Table of Contents
Liquidity and Capital Resources
Liquidity Requirements and Sources
AGL and its Holding Company Subsidiaries
The liquidity of AGL, Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc. ("AGUS") and Assured Guaranty Municipal Holdings Inc. ("AGMH") is largely dependent on dividends from their operating subsidiaries and their access to external financing. The liquidity requirements of these entities include the payment of operating expenses, interest on debt issued by AGUS and AGMH, and dividends on AGL's common shares. AGL and its holding company subsidiaries may also require liquidity to make periodic capital investments in their operating subsidiaries or, in the case of AGL, to repurchase its common shares pursuant to its share repurchase authorization. In the ordinary course of business, the Company evaluates its liquidity needs and capital resources in light of holding company expenses and dividend policy, as well as rating agency considerations. The Company also subjects its cash flow projections and its assets to a stress test, maintaining a liquid asset balance of one time its stressed operating company net cash flows. Management believes that AGL will have sufficient liquidity to satisfy its needs over the next twelve months. See “—Insurance Company Regulatory Restrictions” below for a discussion of the dividend restrictions of its insurance company subsidiaries.
AGL and Holding Company Subsidiaries
Significant Cash Flow Items
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Dividends paid by AGC to AGUS
$
—
$
20
Dividends paid by AGM to AGMH
95
66
Dividends paid by AG Re to AGL
25
50
Repayment of surplus note by AGM to AGMH
—
25
Dividends paid to AGL shareholders
(18
)
(19
)
Repurchases of common shares(1)
(75
)
(152
)
Interest paid
(7
)
(7
)
Issuance of note by AGUS to AGC(2)
—
(200
)
____________________
(1)
On February 24, 2016, in continuation of the Company's capital management strategy of repurchasing its common shares, the Company's Board of Directors approved the repurchase of a $250 million of common shares. As of
March 31, 2016
and May 4, 2016, on a settlement date basis, the remaining authorization for share repurchases was
$230 million
and
$210 million
, respectively.
(2)
On March 31, 2015, AGUS, as lender, provided
$200 million
to AGC, as borrower, from available funds to help partially fund the purchase of Radian Asset. AGC repaid that loan in full on April 14, 2015.
Dividends From Subsidiaries
The Company anticipates that for the next twelve months, amounts paid by AGL’s direct and indirect insurance company subsidiaries as dividends or other distributions will be a major source of its liquidity. The insurance company subsidiaries’ ability to pay dividends depends upon their financial condition, results of operations, cash requirements, and compliance with rating agency requirements, and is also subject to restrictions contained in the insurance laws and related regulations of their states of domicile. Dividend restrictions applicable to AGC and AGM, and to AG Re, are described under Note 11, Insurance Company Regulatory Requirements of the Financial Statements.
•
Under New York insurance law, AGM may only pay dividends out of "earned surplus," which is the portion of the company's surplus that represents the net earnings, gains or profits (after deduction of all losses) that have not been distributed to shareholders as dividends or transferred to stated capital or capital surplus, or applied to other purposes permitted by law, but does not include unrealized appreciation of assets. AGM may pay dividends without the prior approval of the New York Superintendent that, together with all dividends declared or distributed by it during the preceding 12 months, does not exceed the lesser of
10%
of its policyholders' surplus
133
Table of Contents
(as of its last annual or quarterly statement filed with the New York Superintendent) or
100%
of its adjusted net investment income during that period. The maximum amount available during 2016 for AGM to distribute as dividends without regulatory approval is estimated to be approximately
$236 million
, of which approximately
$32 million
is estimated to be available for distribution in the second quarter of 2016.
•
Under Maryland's insurance law, AGC may, with prior notice to the Maryland Insurance Commissioner, pay an ordinary dividend that, together with all dividends paid in the prior 12 months, does not exceed the lesser of
10%
of its policyholders' surplus (as of the prior December 31) or
100%
of its adjusted net investment income during that period. The maximum amount available during 2016 for AGC to distribute as ordinary dividends will be approximately
$79 million
, of which approximately
$24 million
is available for distribution in the second quarter of 2016.
•
Municipal Assurance Corp. ("MAC") is a New York domiciled insurance company subject to the same dividend limitations described above for AGM. The Company does not currently anticipate that MAC will distribute any dividends.
•
For AG Re, any distribution (including repurchase of shares) of any share capital, contributed surplus or other statutory capital that would reduce its total statutory capital by
15%
or more of its total statutory capital as set out in its previous year's financial statements requires the prior approval of the Bermuda Monetary Authority ("Authority"). Separately, dividends are paid out of an insurer's statutory surplus and cannot exceed that surplus. Further, annual dividends cannot exceed
25%
of total statutory capital and surplus surplus as set out in its previous year's financial statements, which is
$246 million
, without AG Re certifying to the Authority that it will continue to meet required margins. Based on the foregoing limitations, in 2016 AG Re has the capacity to (i) make capital distributions in an aggregate amount up to
$127 million
without the prior approval of the Authority and (ii) declare and pay dividends in an aggregate amount up to the limit of its outstanding statutory surplus, which is
$140 million
. Such dividend capacity is further limited by the actual amount of AG Re’s unencumbered assets, which amount changes from time to time due in part to collateral posting requirements. As of
March 31, 2016
, AG Re had unencumbered assets of approximately
$594 million
.
Generally, dividends paid by a U.S. company to a Bermuda holding company are subject to a 30% withholding tax. After AGL became tax resident in the U.K., it became subject to the tax rules applicable to companies resident in the U.K., including the benefits afforded by the U.K.’s tax treaties. The income tax treaty between the U.K. and the U.S. reduces or eliminates the U.S. withholding tax on certain U.S. sourced investment income (to 5% or 0%), including dividends from U.S. subsidiaries to U.K. resident persons entitled to the benefits of the treaty.
External Financing
From time to time, AGL and its subsidiaries have sought external debt or equity financing in order to meet their obligations. External sources of financing may or may not be available to the Company, and if available, the cost of such financing may not be acceptable to the Company.
Intercompany Loans and Guarantees
On March 30, 2015, AGUS loaned $200 million to AGC to facilitate the acquisition of Radian Asset on April 1, 2015. AGC repaid the loan in full on April 14, 2015.
From time to time, AGL and its subsidiaries have entered into intercompany loan facilities. For example, on October 25, 2013, AGL, as borrower, and AGUS, as lender, entered into a revolving credit facility pursuant to which AGL may, from time to time, borrow for general corporate purposes. Under the credit facility, AGUS committed to lend a principal amount not exceeding $225 million in the aggregate. Such commitment terminates on October 25, 2018 (the “loan termination date”). The unpaid principal amount of each loan will bear interest at a fixed rate equal to 100% of the then applicable Federal short-term or mid-term interest rate, as the case may be, as determined under Internal Revenue Code Sec. 1274(d), and interest on all loans will be computed for the actual number of days elapsed on the basis of a year consisting of 360 days. Accrued interest on all loans will be paid on the last day of each June and December, beginning on December 31, 2013, and at maturity. AGL must repay the then unpaid principal amounts of the loans by the third anniversary of the loan termination date. No amounts are currently outstanding under the credit facility.
In addition, in 2012 AGUS borrowed $90 million from its affiliate Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd. to fund the acquisition of MAC. That loan remained outstanding as of
March 31, 2016
.
134
Table of Contents
Furthermore, AGL fully and unconditionally guarantees the payment of the principal of, and interest on, the $1,130 million aggregate principal amount of senior notes issued by AGUS and AGMH, and the $450 million aggregate principal amount of junior subordinated debentures issued by AGUS and AGMH, in each case, as described under "Commitments and Contingencies -- Long-Term Debt Obligations " below.
Cash and Investments
As of
March 31, 2016
, AGL had $80 million in cash and short-term investments. AGUS and AGMH had a total of $42 million in cash and short-term investments. In addition, the Company's U.S. holding companies have $70 million in fixed-maturity securities with weighted average duration of 0.4 years.
Insurance Company Subsidiaries
Liquidity of the insurance company subsidiaries is primarily used to pay for:
•
operating expenses,
•
claims on the insured portfolio,
•
posting of collateral in connection with credit derivatives and reinsurance transactions,
•
reinsurance premiums,
•
dividends to AGL, AGUS and/or AGMH, as applicable,
•
principal of and, where applicable, interest on surplus notes, and
•
capital investments in their own subsidiaries, where appropriate.
Management believes that its subsidiaries’ liquidity needs for the next twelve months can be met from current cash, short-term investments and operating cash flow, including premium collections and coupon payments as well as scheduled maturities and paydowns from their respective investment portfolios. The Company targets a balance of its most liquid assets including cash and short-term securities, Treasuries, agency RMBS and pre-refunded municipal bonds equal to 1.5 times its projected operating company cash flow needs over the next four quarters. The Company intends to hold and has the ability to hold temporarily impaired debt securities until the date of anticipated recovery.
Beyond the next twelve months, the ability of the operating subsidiaries to declare and pay dividends may be influenced by a variety of factors, including market conditions, insurance regulations and rating agency capital requirements and general economic conditions.
Insurance policies issued provide, in general, that payments of principal, interest and other amounts insured may not be accelerated by the holder of the obligation. Amounts paid by the Company therefore are typically in accordance with the obligation’s original payment schedule, unless the Company accelerates such payment schedule, at its sole option.
Payments made in settlement of the Company’s obligations arising from its insured portfolio may, and often do, vary significantly from year-to-year, depending primarily on the frequency and severity of payment defaults and whether the Company chooses to accelerate its payment obligations in order to mitigate future losses.
135
Table of Contents
Claims (Paid) Recovered
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Public finance
$
(5
)
$
(2
)
Structured finance:
U.S. RMBS before benefit for recoveries for breaches of R&W
(98
)
(39
)
Net benefit for recoveries for breaches of R&W
13
21
U.S. RMBS after benefit for recoveries for breaches of R&W
(85
)
(18
)
Other structured finance
(23
)
8
Structured finance
(108
)
(10
)
Claims (paid) recovered, net of reinsurance(1)
$
(113
)
$
(12
)
____________________
(1)
Includes $8 million paid and $6 million paid for consolidated FG VIEs for
First Quarter
2016
and
2015
, respectively.
As of
March 31, 2016
, the Company had exposure of approximately
$561 million
to an infrastructure transaction with refinancing risk. The Company may be required to make claim payments on such exposure, the aggregate amount of the claim payments may be substantial and, although the Company may not experience ultimate loss on it, reimbursement may not occur for an extended time. This transaction involves a long-term infrastructure project that was financed by bonds that mature prior to the expiration of the project concession. The Company expects the cash flows from the project to be sufficient to repay all of the debt over the life of the project concession, and also expects the debt to be refinanced in the market at or prior to its maturity. If the issuer is unable to refinance the debt due to market conditions, the Company may have to pay a claim when the debt matures, and then recover from cash flows produced by the project in the future. The Company generally projects that in most scenarios it will be fully reimbursed for such claim payments. However, the recovery of such amounts is uncertain and may take from
10
to
35
years, depending on the performance of the underlying collateral. As of
March 31, 2016
, the Company estimated that total claims for the
one
transaction with significant refinancing risk, assuming no refinancing and based on certain performance assumptions, could be
$561 million
on a gross basis; such claims would occur from 2018 through 2022.
In addition, the Company has net par exposure of
$5.1 billion
to Commonwealth of Puerto Rico transactions, all of which are BIG. Puerto Rico has experienced significant general fund budget deficits in recent years. These deficits have been covered primarily with the net proceeds of bond issuances, with interim financings provided by GDB and, in some cases, with one-time revenue measures or expense adjustment measures. In addition to high debt levels, Puerto Rico faces a challenging economic environment. Information regarding the Company's exposure to the Commonwealth of Puerto Rico and its related authorities and public corporations is set forth in "Insured Portfolio-Exposure to Puerto Rico" above.
The terms of the Company’s CDS contracts generally are modified from standard CDS contract forms approved by ISDA in order to provide for payments on a scheduled basis and to replicate the terms of a traditional financial guaranty insurance policy. Some contracts the Company entered into as the credit protection seller, however, utilize standard ISDA settlement mechanics of cash settlement (i.e., a process to value the loss of market value of a reference obligation) or physical settlement (i.e., delivery of the reference obligation against payment of principal by the protection seller) in the event of a “credit event,” as defined in the relevant contract. Cash settlement or physical settlement generally requires the payment of a larger amount, prior to the maturity of the reference obligation, than would settlement on a “pay-as-you-go” basis, under which the Company would be required to pay scheduled interest shortfalls during the term of the reference obligation and scheduled principal shortfall only at the final maturity of the reference obligation. As of
March 31, 2016
, the Company was posting approximately
$308 million
to secure its obligations under CDS. Of that amount, approximately $285 million related to
$3.5 billion
in CDS gross par insured where the amount of required collateral is capped and the remaining
$23 million
related to
$219 million
in CDS gross par insured where the amount of required collateral is based on movements in the mark-to-market valuation of the underlying exposure.
On April 12, 2016, AGC entered into an agreement and plan of merger to acquire CIFG, the parent of financial guaranty insurer CIFG NA. AGC expects to pay
$450 million
in cash to acquire CIFG, subject to adjustments as contemplated in the agreement, and the acquisition is expected to be completed mid-2016, subject to receipt of anti-trust and insurance regulatory approvals as well as satisfaction of customary closing conditions. CIFG’s stockholders have already approved the acquisition. As part of the transaction, CIFG NA will merge into AGC, which will be the surviving entity. As of December 31,
136
Table of Contents
2015, CIFG had a consolidated insured portfolio of
$5.6 billion
of net par and approximately
$637 million
of consolidated qualified statutory capital.
Consolidated Cash Flows
Consolidated Cash Flow Summary
First Quarter
2016
2015
(in millions)
Net cash flows provided by (used in) operating activities before effects of trading securities and FG VIEs consolidation
$
(96
)
$
8
(Purchases) sales of trading securities, net
—
(3
)
Effect of FG VIEs consolidation
6
18
Net cash flows provided by (used in) operating activities - reported
(90
)
23
Net cash flows provided by (used in) investing activities before effects of FG VIEs consolidation
136
980
Effect of FG VIEs consolidation
36
21
Net cash flows provided by (used in) investing activities - reported
172
1,001
Net cash flows provided by (used in) financing activities before effects of FG VIEs consolidation
(94
)
(173
)
Effect of FG VIEs consolidation
(42
)
(39
)
Net cash flows provided by (used in) financing activities - reported (1)
(136
)
(212
)
Effect of exchange rate changes
0
(2
)
Cash at beginning of period
166
75
Total cash at the end of the period
$
112
$
885
____________________
(1)
Claims paid on consolidated FG VIEs are presented in the consolidated cash flow statements as a component of paydowns on FG VIE liabilities in financing activities as opposed to operating activities.
Excluding net cash flows from purchases and sales of the trading portfolio and the effect of consolidating FG VIEs, cash inflows from operating activities decreased in
First Quarter 2016
compared with
First Quarter 2015
due primarily to acceleration of claim payments as a means of mitigating future losses, which were partially offset by lower taxes.
Investing activities were primarily net sales (purchases) of fixed-maturity and short-term investment securities. Investing cash flows in
First Quarter 2016
and
First Quarter 2015
include inflows of
$66 million
and
$30 million
for FG VIEs, respectively. In
First Quarter 2015
, the Company sold securities to fund the acquisition of Radian Asset by AGC.
Financing activities consisted primarily of paydowns of FG VIE liabilities and share repurchases. Financing cash flows in
First Quarter 2016
and
First Quarter 2015
include outflows of
$42 million
and
$39 million
for FG VIEs, respectively. Share repurchases in
First Quarter 2016
and
2015
were
$75 million
and
$152 million
, respectively.
From April 1, 2016 through May 4, 2016, the Company repurchased an additional
0.8 million
shares for
$20 million
. As of
March 31, 2016
and May 4, 2016, the Company had remaining authorization to purchase common shares of
$230 million
and
$210 million
, respectively, on a settlement basis. For more information about the Company's share repurchase authorization and the amounts it repurchased in
2016
, see Note 17, Shareholders' Equity, of the Financial Statements.
Commitments and Contingencies
Leases
AGL and its subsidiaries lease office space and certain other items. Future cash payments associated with contractual obligations pursuant to operating leases for office space have not materially changed since December 31, 2015.
137
Table of Contents
Long-Term Debt Obligations
The outstanding principal and interest paid on long-term debt were as follows:
Principal Outstanding
and Interest Paid on Long-Term Debt
Principal Amount
Interest Paid
As of
March 31,
As of
December 31,
First Quarter
2016
2015
2016
2015
(in millions)
AGUS:
7% Senior Notes(1)
$
200
$
200
$
—
$
—
5% Senior Notes(1)
500
500
—
—
Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures(2)
150
150
—
—
Total AGUS
850
850
—
—
AGMH(3):
6
7
/
8
% QUIBS(1)
100
100
2
2
6.25% Notes(1)
230
230
4
4
5.6% Notes(1)
100
100
1
1
Junior Subordinated Debentures(2)
300
300
—
—
Total AGMH
730
730
7
7
AGM(3):
AGM Notes Payable
11
12
0
0
Total AGM
11
12
0
0
Total
$
1,591
$
1,592
$
7
$
7
____________________
(1)
AGL fully and unconditionally guarantees these obligations
(2)
Guaranteed by AGL on a junior subordinated basis.
(3)
Principal amounts vary from carrying amounts due primarily to acquisition method fair value adjustments at the AGMH acquisition date, which are accreted or amortized into interest expense over the remaining terms of these obligations.
7
% Senior Notes issued by AGUS.
On May 18, 2004, AGUS issued
$200 million
of
7
% senior notes due 2034 for net proceeds of
$197 million
. Although the coupon on the Senior Notes is
7
%, the effective rate is approximately
6.4
%, taking into account the effect of a cash flow hedge.
5%
Senior Notes issued by AGUS.
On June 20, 2014, AGUS issued
$500 million
of
5%
Senior Notes due 2024 for net proceeds of $495 million. The notes are guaranteed by AGL. The net proceeds from the sale of the notes were used for general corporate purposes, including the purchase of common shares of AGL.
Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures issued by AGUS.
On December 20, 2006, AGUS issued
$150 million
of Debentures due 2066. The Debentures pay a fixed
6.4%
rate of interest until December 15, 2016, and thereafter pay a floating rate of interest, reset quarterly, at a rate equal to
three
month London Interbank Offered Rate ("LIBOR") plus a margin equal to
2.38%
. AGUS may select at
one
or more times to defer payment of interest for
one
or more consecutive periods for up to
ten
years. Any unpaid interest bears interest at the then applicable rate. AGUS may not defer interest past the maturity date.
6 7/8
% QUIBS issued by AGMH.
On December 19, 2001, AGMH issued
$100 million
face amount of
6 7/8
% QUIBS due December 15, 2101, which are callable without premium or penalty.
138
Table of Contents
6.25
% Notes issued by AGMH.
On November 26, 2002, AGMH issued
$230 million
face amount of
6.25
% Notes due November 1, 2102, which are callable without premium or penalty in whole or in part.
5.6
% Notes issued by AGMH.
On July 31, 2003, AGMH issued
$100 million
face amount of
5.6
% Notes due July 15, 2103, which are callable without premium or penalty in whole or in part.
Junior Subordinated Debentures issued by AGMH.
On November 22, 2006, AGMH issued
$300 million
face amount of Junior Subordinated Debentures with a scheduled maturity date of December 15, 2036 and a final repayment date of December 15, 2066. The final repayment date of December 15, 2066 may be automatically extended up to
four
times in
five
-year increments provided certain conditions are met. The debentures are redeemable, in whole or in part, at any time prior to December 15, 2036 at their principal amount plus accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption or, if greater, the make-whole redemption price. Interest on the debentures will accrue from November 22, 2006 to December 15, 2036 at the annual rate of
6.4%
. If any amount of the debentures remains outstanding after December 15, 2036, then the principal amount of the outstanding debentures will bear interest at a floating interest rate equal to
one
-month LIBOR plus
2.215%
until repaid. AGMH may elect at
one
or more times to defer payment of interest on the debentures for
one
or more consecutive interest periods that do not exceed
ten
years. In connection with the completion of this offering, AGMH entered into a replacement capital covenant for the benefit of persons that buy, hold or sell a specified series of AGMH long-term indebtedness ranking senior to the debentures. Under the covenant, the debentures will not be repaid, redeemed, repurchased or defeased by AGMH or any of its subsidiaries on or before the date that is
twenty
years prior to the final repayment date, except to the extent that AGMH has received proceeds from the sale of replacement capital securities. The proceeds from this offering were used to pay a dividend to the shareholders of AGMH.
Recourse Credit Facility
In connection with the acquisition of AGMH, AGM agreed to retain the risks relating to the debt and strip policy portions of the leveraged lease business. The liquidity risk to AGM related to the strip policy portion of the leveraged lease business is mitigated by the strip coverage facility described below.
In a leveraged lease transaction, a tax-exempt entity (such as a transit agency) transfers tax benefits to a tax-paying entity by transferring ownership of a depreciable asset, such as subway cars. The tax-exempt entity then leases the asset back from its new owner.
If the lease is terminated early, the tax-exempt entity must make an early termination payment to the lessor. A portion of this early termination payment is funded from monies that were pre-funded and invested at the closing of the leveraged lease transaction (along with earnings on those invested funds). The tax-exempt entity is obligated to pay the remaining, unfunded portion of this early termination payment (known as the “strip coverage”) from its own sources. AGM issued financial guaranty insurance policies (known as “strip policies”) that guaranteed the payment of these unfunded strip coverage amounts to the lessor, in the event that a tax-exempt entity defaulted on its obligation to pay this portion of its early termination payment. AGM can then seek reimbursement of its strip policy payments from the tax-exempt entity, and can also sell the transferred depreciable asset and reimburse itself from the sale proceeds.
Currently, all the leveraged lease transactions in which AGM acts as strip coverage provider are breaching a rating trigger related to AGM and are subject to early termination. However, early termination of a lease does not result in a draw on the AGM policy if the tax-exempt entity makes the required termination payment.If all the leases were to terminate early and the tax-exempt entities do not make the required early termination payments, then AGM would be exposed to possible liquidity claims on gross exposure of approximately
$1.1 billion
as of
March 31, 2016
. To date, none of the leveraged lease transactions that involve AGM has experienced an early termination due to a lease default and a claim on the AGM policy. It is difficult to determine the probability that AGM will have to pay strip provider claims or the likely aggregate amount of such claims. At
March 31, 2016
, approximately
$1.4 billion
of cumulative strip par exposure had been terminated since 2008 on a consensual basis. The consensual terminations have resulted in no claims on AGM.
On July 1, 2009, AGM and Dexia Crédit Local S.A., acting through its New York Branch (“Dexia Crédit Local (NY)”), entered into a credit facility (the “Strip Coverage Facility”). Under the Strip Coverage Facility, Dexia Crédit Local (NY) agreed to make loans to AGM to finance all draws made by lessors on AGM strip policies that were outstanding as of November 13, 2008, up to the commitment amount, which is currently
$495
million.
Fundings under this facility are subject to certain conditions precedent, and their repayment is collateralized by a security interest that AGM granted to Dexia Crédit Local (NY) in amounts that AGM recovers – from the tax-exempt entity, or from asset sale proceeds – following its payment of strip policy claims. On June 30, 2014, AGM and Dexia Crédit Local (NY)
139
Table of Contents
agreed to shorten the duration of the facility. Accordingly, the Strip Coverage Facility will terminate upon the earliest to occur of an AGM change of control, the reduction of the commitment amount to
$0
in accordance with the terms of the facility, and June 30, 2024 (rather than the original maturity date of January 31, 2042).
The Strip Coverage Facility’s financial covenants require that AGM and its subsidiaries maintain:
•
a maximum debt-to-capital ratio of
30%
; and
•
a minimum net worth of
75%
of consolidated net worth as of July 1, 2009, plus, beginning June 30, 2015 and on each anniversary of such date, an amount equal to the product of (i)
25%
of the aggregate consolidated net income (or loss) for the period beginning July 2, 2009 and ending on June 30, 2014 and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the commitment amount as of the relevant calculation date and the denominator of which is
$1 billion
.
The Company was in compliance with all financial covenants as of
March 31, 2016
.
The Strip Coverage Facility contains restrictions on AGM, including, among other things, in respect of its ability to incur debt, permit liens, pay dividends or make distributions, dissolve or become party to a merger or consolidation. Most of these restrictions are subject to exceptions. The Strip Coverage Facility has customary events of default, including (subject to certain materiality thresholds and grace periods) payment default, bankruptcy or insolvency proceedings and cross-default to other debt agreements.
As of
March 31, 2016
, no amounts were outstanding under this facility, nor have there been any borrowings during the life of this facility.
Committed Capital Securities
Each of AGC and AGM have issued $200 million of CCS pursuant to transactions in which AGC CCS or AGM’s Committed Preferred Trust Securities (the “AGM CPS”), as applicable, were issued by custodial trusts created for the primary purpose of issuing such securities, investing the proceeds in high-quality assets and providing put options to AGC or AGM, as applicable. The put options allow AGC and AGM to issue non-cumulative redeemable perpetual preferred securities to the trusts in exchange for cash. For both AGC and AGM, four initial trusts were created, each with an initial aggregate face amount of $50 million. The Company does not consider itself to be the primary beneficiary of the trusts for either the AGC or AGM CCS and the trusts are not consolidated in Assured Guaranty's financial statements.
The trusts provide AGC and AGM access to new capital at their respective sole discretion through the exercise of the put options. Upon AGC's or AGM's exercise of its put option, the relevant trust will liquidate its portfolio of eligible assets and use the proceeds to purchase the AGC or AGM preferred stock, as applicable. AGC or AGM may use the proceeds from such sale of its preferred stock to the trusts for any purpose, including the payment of claims. The put agreements have no scheduled termination date or maturity. However, each put agreement will terminate if (subject to certain grace periods) specified events occur.
AGC Committed Capital Securities.
AGC entered into separate put agreements with four custodial trusts with respect to its CCS in April 2005. The AGC put options have not been exercised through the date of this filing. Initially, all of AGC CCS were issued to a special purpose pass-through trust (the “Pass-Through Trust”). The Pass-Through Trust was dissolved in April 2008 and the AGC CCS were distributed to the holders of the Pass-Through Trust's securities. Neither the Pass-Through Trust nor the custodial trusts are consolidated in the Company's financial statements. Income distributions on the Pass-Through Trust securities and CCS were equal to an annualized rate of one-month LIBOR plus 110 basis points for all periods ending on or prior to April 8, 2008. Following dissolution of the Pass-Through Trust, distributions on the AGC CCS are determined pursuant to an auction process. On April 7, 2008 this auction process failed, thereby increasing the annualized rate on the AGC CCS to one-month LIBOR plus 250 basis points. Distributions on the AGC preferred stock will be determined pursuant to the same process. AGC continues to have the ability to exercise its put option and cause the related trusts to purchase AGC Preferred Stock.
140
Table of Contents
AGM Committed Capital Securities.
AGM entered into separate put agreements with four custodial trusts with respect to its CCS in June 2003. The AGM put options have not been exercised through the date of this filing. AGM pays a floating put premium to the trusts, which represents the difference between the commercial paper yield and the winning auction rate (plus all fees and expenses of the trust). If an auction does not attract sufficient clearing bids, however, the auction rate is subject to a maximum rate of one-month LIBOR plus 200 basis points for the next succeeding distribution period. Beginning in August 2007, the AGM CCS required the maximum rate for each of the relevant trusts. AGM continues to have the ability to exercise its put option and cause the related trusts to purchase AGM Preferred Stock.
Investment Portfolio
The Company’s principal objectives in managing its investment portfolio are to support the highest possible ratings for each operating company; to manage investment risk within the context of the underlying portfolio of insurance risk; to maintain sufficient liquidity to cover unexpected stress in the insurance portfolio; and to maximize after-tax net investment income.
The Company’s fixed-maturity securities and short-term investments had a duration of 5.3 years as of
March 31, 2016
and 5.4 years as of
December 31, 2015
. Generally, the Company’s fixed-maturity securities are designated as available-for-sale. For more information about the Investment Portfolio and a detailed description of the Company’s valuation of investments see Note 10, Investments and Cash, of the Financial Statements.
Fixed-Maturity Securities and Short-Term Investments
by Security Type
As of March 31, 2016
As of December 31, 2015
Amortized
Cost
Estimated
Fair Value
Amortized
Cost
Estimated
Fair Value
(in millions)
Fixed-maturity securities:
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
$
5,417
$
5,776
$
5,528
$
5,841
U.S. government and agencies
379
405
377
400
Corporate securities
1,473
1,525
1,505
1,520
Mortgage-backed securities(1):
RMBS
1,222
1,239
1,238
1,245
CMBS
531
556
506
513
Asset-backed securities
821
811
831
825
Foreign government securities
280
276
290
283
Total fixed-maturity securities
10,123
10,588
10,275
10,627
Short-term investments
459
459
396
396
Total fixed-maturity and short-term investments
$
10,582
$
11,047
$
10,671
$
11,023
____________________
(1)
Government-agency obligations were approximately
52%
of mortgage backed securities as of
March 31, 2016
and
54%
as of
December 31, 2015
, based on fair value.
141
Table of Contents
The following tables summarize, for all fixed-maturity securities in an unrealized loss position as of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, the aggregate fair value and gross unrealized loss by length of time the amounts have continuously been in an unrealized loss position.
Fixed-Maturity Securities
Gross Unrealized Loss by Length of Time
As of March 31, 2016
Less than 12 months
12 months or more
Total
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Loss
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Loss
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Loss
(dollars in millions)
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
$
58
$
0
$
87
$
(1
)
$
145
$
(1
)
U.S. government and agencies
7
0
—
—
7
0
Corporate securities
78
(2
)
122
(15
)
200
(17
)
Mortgage-backed securities:
RMBS
123
(5
)
182
(15
)
305
(20
)
CMBS
7
0
5
0
12
0
Asset-backed securities
456
(13
)
—
—
456
(13
)
Foreign government securities
91
(4
)
53
(5
)
144
(9
)
Total
$
820
$
(24
)
$
449
$
(36
)
$
1,269
$
(60
)
Number of securities(1)
110
82
185
Number of securities with other-than-temporary impairment
12
6
18
Fixed-Maturity Securities
Gross Unrealized Loss by Length of Time
As of December 31, 2015
Less than 12 months
12 months or more
Total
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Loss
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Loss
Fair
Value
Unrealized
Loss
(dollars in millions)
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
$
316
$
(10
)
$
7
$
0
$
323
$
(10
)
U.S. government and agencies
77
0
—
—
77
0
Corporate securities
381
(8
)
95
(15
)
476
(23
)
Mortgage-backed securities:
RMBS
438
(8
)
90
(14
)
528
(22
)
CMBS
140
(2
)
2
0
142
(2
)
Asset-backed securities
517
(10
)
—
—
517
(10
)
Foreign government securities
97
(4
)
82
(7
)
179
(11
)
Total
$
1,966
$
(42
)
$
276
$
(36
)
$
2,242
$
(78
)
Number of securities(1)
335
71
396
Number of securities with other-than-temporary impairment
9
4
13
___________________
(1)
The number of securities does not add across because lots of the same securities have been purchased at different times and appear in both categories above (i.e. Less than 12 months and 12 months or more). If a security appears in both categories, it is counted only once in the total column.
142
Table of Contents
Of the securities in an unrealized loss position for 12 months or more as of
March 31, 2016
,
eleven
securities had an unrealized loss greater than
10%
of book value. The total unrealized loss for these securities as of
March 31, 2016
was
$26 million
. The Company has determined that the unrealized losses recorded as of
March 31, 2016
are yield related and not the result of other-than-temporary impairment.
Changes in interest rates affect the value of the Company’s fixed-maturity portfolio. As interest rates fall, the fair value of fixed-maturity securities generally increases and as interest rates rise, the fair value of fixed-maturity securities generally decreases. The Company’s portfolio of fixed-maturity securities consists primarily of high-quality, liquid instruments.
The amortized cost and estimated fair value of the Company’s available-for-sale fixed-maturity securities, by contractual maturity, are shown below. Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties.
Distribution of Fixed-Maturity Securities
by Contractual Maturity
As of March 31, 2016
Amortized
Cost
Estimated
Fair Value
(in millions)
Due within one year
$
469
$
470
Due after one year through five years
1,654
1,719
Due after five years through 10 years
2,195
2,320
Due after 10 years
4,052
4,284
Mortgage-backed securities:
RMBS
1,222
1,239
CMBS
531
556
Total
$
10,123
$
10,588
The following table summarizes the ratings distributions of the Company’s investment portfolio as of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
. Ratings reflect the lower of the Moody’s and S&P classifications, except for bonds purchased for loss mitigation or other risk management strategies, which use Assured Guaranty’s internal ratings classifications.
Distribution of
Fixed-Maturity Securities by Rating
Rating
As of
March 31, 2016
As of
December 31, 2015
AAA
11.4
%
10.8
%
AA
58.6
59.0
A
17.3
17.6
BBB
1.0
0.9
BIG(1)
11.4
11.4
Not rated
0.3
0.3
Total
100.0
%
100.0
%
____________________
(1)
Comprised primarily of loss mitigation and other risk management assets. See Note 10, Investments and Cash, of the Financial Statements.
The investment portfolio contains securities and cash that are either held in trust for the benefit of third party reinsurers in accordance with statutory requirements, invested in a guaranteed investment contract for future claims payments, placed on deposit to fulfill state licensing requirements, or otherwise restricted in the amount of
$300 million
and
$283 million
as of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, respectively, based on fair value. The investment portfolio also contains securities that are held in trust by certain AGL subsidiaries for the benefit of other AGL subsidiaries in accordance with
143
Table of Contents
statutory and regulatory requirements in the amount of
$1,550 million
and
$1,411 million
as of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, respectively, based on fair value.
The fair value of the Company’s pledged securities to secure its obligations under its CDS exposure totaled
$308 million
and
$305 million
as of
March 31, 2016
and
December 31, 2015
, respectively.
Liquidity Arrangements with respect to AGMH’s former Financial Products Business
AGMH’s former financial products segment had been in the business of borrowing funds through the issuance of guaranteed investment contracts ("GICs") and medium term notes and reinvesting the proceeds in investments that met AGMH’s investment criteria. The financial products business also included the equity payment undertaking agreement portion of the leveraged lease business, as described further below in “—Leveraged Lease Business.”
The GIC Business
Until November 2008, AGMH, through its financial products business, offered GICs to municipalities and other market participants. The GICs were issued through certain non-insurance subsidiaries of AGMH. In return for an initial payment, each GIC entitles its holder to receive the return of the holder’s invested principal plus interest at a specified rate, and to withdraw principal from the GIC as permitted by its terms. AGM insures the payment obligations on all these GICs.
The proceeds of GICs were loaned to AGMH’s former subsidiary FSA Asset Management LLC ("FSAM"). FSAM in turn invested these funds in fixed-income obligations (the “FSAM assets”).
AGM’s insurance policies on the GICs remain in place, and must remain in place until each GIC is terminated, even though AGMH no longer holds any ownership interest in FSAM or the GIC issuers.
In June 2009, in connection with the Company's acquisition of AGMH from Dexia Holdings Inc., Dexia SA, the ultimate parent of Dexia Holdings Inc., and certain of its affiliates, entered into a number of agreements intended to mitigate the credit, interest rate and liquidity risks associated with the GIC business and the related AGM insurance policies. Some of those agreements have since terminated or expired, or been modified. In addition to the surviving agreements described below, AGM benefits from a guaranty jointly and severally issued by Dexia SA and Dexia Crédit Local S.A. to AGM that guarantees the payment obligations of AGM under its insurance policies related to the GIC business, and an indemnification agreement between AGM, Dexia SA and Dexia Crédit Local S.A. that protects AGM from other losses arising out of or as a result of the GIC business.
To support the primary payment obligations under the GICs, each of Dexia SA and Dexia Crédit Local S.A. are party to a put contract. Pursuant to the put contract, FSAM may put an amount of its FSAM assets to Dexia SA and Dexia Crédit Local S.A. in exchange for funds that FSAM would in turn make available to meet demands for payment under the GICs. The amount that could be put varies depending on the type of trigger event in question. To secure their obligations under this put contract, Dexia SA and Dexia Crédit Local S.A. are required to post eligible highly liquid collateral having an aggregate value (subject to agreed reductions and advance rates) equal to at least the excess of (i) the aggregate principal amount of all outstanding GICs over (ii) the aggregate mark-to-market value of FSAM’s assets.
As of
March 31, 2016
, approximately 31.6% of the FSAM assets (measured by aggregate principal balance) were in cash or were obligations backed by the full faith and credit of the United States.
As of
March 31, 2016
, the aggregate accreted GIC balance was approximately
$1.7 billion
, compared with approximately $10.2 billion as of December 31, 2009. As of
March 31, 2016
, and with respect to the FSAM assets, the aggregate accreted principal was approximately
$2.5 billion
, the aggregate market value was approximately
$2.3 billion
and the aggregate market value after agreed reductions was approximately $1.6 billion. Cash and positive derivative value exceeded the negative derivative values and other projected costs by approximately $161 million. Accordingly, as of
March 31, 2016
, the aggregate fair market value of the assets supporting the GIC business (disregarding the agreed upon reductions) plus cash and positive derivative value exceeded by nearly $0.8 billion the aggregate principal amount of all outstanding GICs and certain other business and hedging costs of the GIC business. Even after applying the agreed upon reductions to the fair market value of the assets, the aggregate value of the assets supporting the GIC business plus cash and positive derivative value exceeded the aggregate principal amount of all outstanding GICs and certain other business and hedging costs of the GIC business. Accordingly, no posting of collateral was required under the primary put contract.
144
Table of Contents
To provide additional support, Dexia Crédit Local S.A. provides a liquidity commitment to FSAM to lend against FSAM assets under a revolving credit agreement. As of
March 31, 2016
the commitment totaled $1.3 billion, of which approximately $0.8 billion was drawn. The agreement requires the commitment remain in place, generally until the GICs have been paid in full.
Despite the put contract and revolving credit agreement, and the significant portion of FSAM assets comprised of highly liquid securities backed by the full faith and credit of the United States, AGM remains subject to the risk that Dexia SA and its affiliates may not make payments or securities available (i) on a timely basis, which is referred to as “liquidity risk,” or (ii) at all, which is referred to as “credit risk,” because of the risk of default. Even if the Dexia entities have sufficient assets to pay all amounts when due (either under the GICs, or under the guarantee, the put contract and the revolving credit agreement), one or more rating agencies may view negatively the ability or willingness of Dexia SA and its affiliates to perform under their various agreements, which could negatively affect AGM’s ratings.
If Dexia SA or its affiliates do not fulfill their contractual obligations, the GIC issuers may not have the financial ability to pay upon the withdrawal of GIC funds or post collateral or make other payments in respect of the GICs, thereby resulting in claims upon the AGM financial guaranty insurance policies. If AGM is required to pay a claim due to a failure of the GIC issuers to pay amounts in respect of the GICs, AGM is subject to the risk that the GICs will not be paid from funds received from Dexia SA and its affiliates before it is required to make payment under its financial guaranty policies or that it will not receive the guaranty payment at all.
A downgrade of the financial strength rating of AGM could trigger a payment obligation of AGM in respect to AGMH's former GIC business. Most of the GICs insured by AGM allow for the withdrawal of GIC funds in the event of a downgrade of AGM, unless the relevant GIC issuer posts collateral or otherwise enhances its credit. Most GICs insured by AGM allow for the termination of the GIC contract and a withdrawal of GIC funds at the option of the GIC holder in the event of a downgrade of AGM below a specified threshold, generally below A- by S&P or A3 by Moody's, with no right of the GIC issuer to avoid such withdrawal by posting collateral or otherwise enhancing its credit. Each GIC contract stipulates the thresholds below which the GIC issuer must post eligible collateral, along with the types of securities eligible for posting and the collateralization percentage applicable to each security type. These collateralization percentages range from 100% of the GIC balance for cash posted as collateral to, typically, 108% for asset-backed securities. FSAM is expected to have sufficient eligible and liquid assets to satisfy any expected withdrawal and collateral posting obligations resulting from future rating actions affecting AGM.
The Medium Term Notes Business
In connection with the acquisition of AGMH, Dexia Crédit Local S.A. agreed to fund, on behalf of AGM, 100% of all policy claims made under financial guaranty insurance policies issued by AGM in relation to the medium term notes issuance program of FSA Global Funding Limited. Such agreement is set out in a Separation Agreement, dated as of July 1, 2009, between Dexia Crédit Local S.A., AGM, FSA Global Funding and Premier International Funding Co., and in a funding guaranty and a reimbursement guaranty that Dexia Crédit Local S.A. issued for the benefit of AGM. Under the funding guaranty, Dexia Crédit Local S.A. guarantees to pay to or on behalf of AGM amounts equal to the payments required to be made under policies issued by AGM relating to the medium term notes business. Under the reimbursement guaranty, Dexia Crédit Local S.A. guarantees to pay reimbursement amounts to AGM for payments it makes following a claim for payment under an obligation insured by a policy it has issued. Notwithstanding Dexia Crédit Local S.A.’s obligation to fund 100% of all policy claims under those policies, AGM has a separate obligation to remit to Dexia Crédit Local S.A. a certain percentage (ranging from 0% to 25%) of those policy claims. AGM, the Company and related parties are also protected against losses arising out of or as a result of the medium term note business through an indemnification agreement with Dexia Crédit Local S.A. As of
March 31, 2016
, FSA Global Funding Limited had approximately $705 million of medium term notes outstanding.
Leveraged Lease Business
Under the Strip Coverage Facility entered into in connection with the acquisition of AGMH, Dexia Credit Local (NY) agreed to make loans to AGM to finance all draws made by lessors on certain AGM strip policies issued in connection with the leveraged lease business. AGM may request advances under the Strip Coverage Facility without any explicit limit on the number of loan requests, provided that the aggregate principal amount of loans outstanding as of the date of the request may not exceed the commitment amount. The leveraged lease business, the AGM strip policies and the Strip Coverage Facility (including the commitment amount) are described further under “Commitments and Contingencies-Recourse Credit Facility" above.
145
Table of Contents
ITEM 3.
QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” for an updated sensitivity analysis for credit derivatives and expected losses on contracts accounted for as insurance. There were no material changes in market risk since
December 31, 2015
.
ITEM 4.
CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
Assured Guaranty’s management, with the participation of AGL’s President and Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, is responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as such term is defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Exchange Act) that are effective in recording, processing, summarizing and reporting, within the time periods specified in the Securities and Exchange Commission’s rules and forms, information required to be disclosed by AGL in the reports that it files or submits under the Exchange Act and ensuring that such information is accumulated and communicated to management, including the President and Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosures.
Management of the Company, with the participation of its Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, evaluated the effectiveness of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures as of
March 31, 2016
. Based on their evaluation as of
March 31, 2016
covered by this Form 10-Q, the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer have concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective.
146
Table of Contents
PART II.
OTHER INFORMATION
ITEM 1.
LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
The Company is subject to legal proceedings and claims, as described in the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended
December 31, 2015
, and in Note 14 to the Consolidated Financial Statements, Commitments and Contingencies – Legal Proceedings. During the three months ended
March 31, 2016
, the following developments occurred in respect of the Company's legal proceedings:
On November 28, 2011, Lehman Brothers International (Europe) (in administration) ("LBIE") sued AG Financial Products Inc. ("AGFP"), an affiliate of AGC which in the past had provided credit protection to counterparties under credit default swaps. AGC acts as the credit support provider of AGFP under these credit default swaps. LBIE's complaint, which was filed in the Supreme Court of the State of New York, alleged that AGFP improperly terminated nine credit derivative transactions between LBIE and AGFP and improperly calculated the termination payment in connection with the termination of 28 other credit derivative transactions between LBIE and AGFP. Following defaults by LBIE, AGFP properly terminated the transactions in question in compliance with the agreement between AGFP and LBIE, and calculated the termination payment properly. AGFP calculated that LBIE owes AGFP approximately $29 million in connection with the termination of the credit derivative transactions, whereas LBIE asserted in the complaint that AGFP owes LBIE a termination payment of approximately $1.4 billion. On February 3, 2012, AGFP filed a motion to dismiss certain of the counts in the complaint, and on March 15, 2013, the court granted AGFP's motion to dismiss the count relating to improper termination of the nine credit derivative transactions and denied AGFP's motion to dismiss the counts relating to the remaining transactions. On February 22, 2016, AGFP filed a motion for summary judgment on the remaining causes of action asserted by LBIE and on AGFP's counterclaims. LBIE’s administrators disclosed in an April 10, 2015 report to LBIE’s unsecured creditors that LBIE's valuation expert has calculated LBIE's damages in aggregate for the
28
transactions to range between a minimum of approximately
$200 million
and a maximum of approximately
$500 million
, depending on what adjustment, if any, is made for AGFP's credit risk and excluding any applicable interest. Notwithstanding the range calculated by LBIE's valuation expert, the Company cannot reasonably estimate the possible loss, if any, that may arise from this lawsuit.
On May 28, 2014, Houston Casualty Company Europe, Seguros y Reseguros, S.A. (“HCCE”) notified Radian Asset that it was demanding arbitration against Radian Asset in connection with housing cooperative losses presented to Radian Asset by HCCE under several years of quota-share surety reinsurance contracts. Through November 30, 2015, HCCE had presented AGC, as successor to Radian Asset, with approximately
€15 million
in claims. In January 2016, Assured Guaranty and HCCE settled all the claims related to the Spanish housing cooperative losses.
During 2008,
nine
putative class action lawsuits were filed in federal court alleging federal antitrust violations in the municipal derivatives industry, seeking damages and alleging, among other things, a conspiracy to fix the pricing of, and manipulate bids for, municipal derivatives, including GICs. These cases have been coordinated and consolidated for pretrial proceedings in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York as
MDL 1950, In re Municipal Derivatives Antitrust Litigation,
Case No. 1:08-cv-2516 (“MDL 1950”). On September 22, 2015, the remaining parties to the putative class action reported to the MDL 1950 Court that settlements in principle had been reached, and a motion for preliminary approval of those putative class claims was filed on February 24, 2016. The parties have reported that final settlement with those remaining defendants would resolve the putative class case. The settlement fairness hearing for those putative class cases is scheduled for July 8, 2016. The Company cannot reasonably estimate the possible loss, if any, or range of loss that may arise from these lawsuits.
ITEM 1A.
RISK FACTORS
Please refer to “Risk Factors" under Part I, “Item 1A. Risk Factors” of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended
December 31, 2015
. There have been no material changes to the risk factors disclosed in such Annual Report on Form 10-K during the three months ended
March 31, 2016
.
147
Table of Contents
ITEM 2.
UNREGISTERED SALES OF EQUITY SECURITIES AND USE OF PROCEEDS
Issuer’s Purchases of Equity Securities
The following table reflects purchases of AGL common shares made by the Company during
First Quarter 2016
.
Period
Total
Number of
Shares
Purchased
Average
Price Paid
Per Share
Total Number of
Shares Purchased as
Part of Publicly
Announced Program (1)
Maximum Number (or Approximate Dollar Value)
of Shares that
May Yet Be
Purchased
Under the Program(2)
January 1 - January 31
1,776,387
$
24.57
1,776,387
$
11,384,707
February 1 - February 29
482,215
$
23.61
482,215
$
250,000,000
March 1 - March 31
780,326
$
25.63
780,326
$
230,000,012
Total
3,038,928
$
24.69
3,038,928
____________________
(1)
After giving effect to repurchases since the beginning of 2013 through May 4, 2016, the Company has repurchased a total of
61.7
common shares for approximately
$1,504
million, excluding commissions, at an average price of
$24.36
per share. On February 24, 2016, the Company's Board of Directors approved a $250 million share repurchase authorization. As of May 4, 2016,
$210 million
of total capacity remained from the authorization, on a settlement basis.
(2)
Excludes commissions.
ITEM 6.
EXHIBITS.
See Exhibit Index for a list of exhibits filed with this report.
148
Table of Contents
SIGNATURES
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this Report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned thereunto duly authorized.
ASSURED GUARANTY LTD.
(Registrant)
Dated May 5, 2016
By:
/s/ ROBERT A. BAILENSON
Robert A. Bailenson
Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial and
Accounting Officer and Duly Authorized Officer)
149
Table of Contents
EXHIBIT INDEX
Exhibit
Number
Description of Document
10.1
Director Compensation Summary*
10.2
Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of April 12, 2016, among Assured Guaranty Corp., Cultivate Merger Sub, Inc. and CIFG Holding Inc.
31.1
Certification of CEO Pursuant to Exchange Act Rules 13A-14 and 15D-14, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
31.2
Certification of CFO Pursuant to Exchange Act Rules 13A-14 and 15D-14, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
32.1
Certification of CEO Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes- Oxley Act of 2002
32.2
Certification of CFO Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes- Oxley Act of 2002
101.1
The following financial information from Assured Guaranty Ltd.’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2015 formatted in XBRL: (i) Consolidated Balance Sheets at September 30, 2015 and December 31, 2014; (ii) Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Three and Nine Months ended September 30, 2015 and 2014; (iii) Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the Three and Nine Months ended September 30, 2015 and 2014 (iv) Consolidated Statement of Shareholders’ Equity for the Nine Months ended September 30, 2015; (v) Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Nine Months ended September 30, 2015 and 2014; and (vi) Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
* Management contract or compensatory plan
150